7ST6 Ba 470 76
7ST6 Ba 470 76
7ST6 Ba 470 76
70
SIPROTEC® 7ST6
Numerical overhead contact line protection for AC traction power supply
siemens.com/rail-electrification
Preface
Contents
SIPROTEC
Introduction 1
Functions 2
Numerical Overhead Mounting and Commissioning 3
Contact Line Protection for
AC Traction Power Supply Technical Data 4
7ST6
Appendix A
V4.70 Literature
Glossary
Manual
Index
E50417-G1176-C251-A6
Note
For safety purposes, please note instructions and warnings in the Preface.
Purpose of this This manual describes the functions, operation, mounting, and placing into service of device
Manual 7ST6. In particular, one will find:
• Information on how to configure the device scope and a description of the device functions and
setting options;
• Instructions for mounting and commissioning;
• Compilation of the technical specifications;
• Summary of the most significant data for the experienced user in the Appendix.
General information about design, configuration, and operation of SIPROTEC 4 devices are given
in the SIPROTEC 4 System Description.
Target Audience Protection engineers, commissioning engineers, personnel concerned with adjustment, checking,
and service of selective protective equipment, automatic and control facilities, and personnel of
electrical facilities and power plants.
Validity of the This manual is valid for: SIPROTEC® 4 Numerical Overhead Contact Line Protection for AC
Manual Traction Power Supply 7ST6 ; Firmware version V4.70.
Indication of Con-
This product complies with the directive of the Council of the European Communi-
formity ties on the approximation of the laws of the Member States relating to electromag-
netic compatibility (EMC Council Directive 89/336/EEC) and concerning electrical
equipment for use within specified voltage limits (Low-voltage directive 2006/95
EEC).
This conformity is proved by tests conducted by Siemens AG in accordance with
Article 10 of the Council Directives in agreement with the generic standards
EN61000-6-2 and EN 61000-6-4 for the EMC directive, and with the standard EN
60255-6 for the low-voltage directive.
This device is designed and produced for industrial use.
The product conforms with the international standard of the series IEC 60255 and
the German standard VDE 0435.
Additional Support Should you have any further questions regarding the SIPROTEC 4 system please contact your
local Siemens distributor.
http://www.siprotec.de
Should you experience any problems in using SIPROTEC 4, please contact our Hotline
E-mail: support.energy@siemens.com
Instructions and The warnings and notes contained in this manual serve for your own safety and for an ap-
Warnings propriate lifetime of the device. Please observe them!
The following indicators and standard definitions are used:
DANGER!
indicates that death, severe personal injury or substantial property damage can result if
proper precautions are not taken.
Warning
indicates that death, severe personal injury or substantial property damage can result if
proper precautions are not taken.
Caution
indicates that minor personal injury or property damage can result if proper precautions are
not taken. This particularly applies to damage on or in the device itself and consequential
damage thereof.
Note:
indicates information about the device or respective part of the instruction manual which is
essential to highlight.
WARNING!
Hazardous voltages are present in this electrical equipment during operation.
Death, severe personal injury or substantial property damage can result if the device is not
handled properly.
Only qualified personnel shall work on and in the vicinity of this equipment. The personnel must
be thoroughly familiar with all warnings and maintenance procedures of this manual as well as the
safety regulations.
Successful and safe operation of the device is dependent on proper transportation, storage,
mounting and assembly and the observance of the warnings and instructions of the unit manual.
In particular, the general installation and safety regulations for work in power current plants (e.g.
ANSI, IEC, EN, DIN, or other national and international regulations) must be observed.
Typographic and To designate terms which refer in the text to information of the device or for the device, the
Graphical Conventions following fonts are used:
Parameter names
Designators of configuration or function parameters which may appear word-for-word in the
display of the device or on the screen of a personal computer (with DIGSI), are marked in
bold letters of a monospace font. The same goes for the titles of menus.
1234A
Parameter addresses have the same character style as parameter names. Parameter ad-
dresses in overview tables contain the suffix A, if the parameter is only available using the
option Display additional settings.
Parameter Conditions
Possible settings of text parameters, which may appear word-for-word in the display of the
device or on the screen of a personal computer (with operation software DIGSI), are addi-
tionally written in italics. The same goes for the options of the menus.
„Annunciations“
Designators for information, which may be output by the relay or required from other devices
or from the switch gear, are marked in a monospace type style in quotation marks.
Deviations may be permitted in drawings and tables when the type of designator can be obviously
derived from the illustration.
External binary input signal with number (binary input, input indica-
tion)
External binary output signal with number (device indication)
Besides these, graphical symbols are used according to IEC 60617-12 and IEC 60617-13 or
symbols derived from these standards. Some of the most frequently used are listed below:
AND gate
OR gate
1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
2 Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
4.10 Synchronism and Voltage Check (optional or depending on device version) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
A Appendix. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Literature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
1.3 Characteristics 22
The SIPROTEC® 4 7ST6, Numerical Overhead Contact Line Protection for AC Traction Power
Supply, is equipped with a powerful 32-bit microprocessor. All tasks are processed numerically,
from acquisition of measured values up to commands to the circuit breakers. Figure 1-1 shows the
basic structure of the 7ST63.
There are two different device versions, 7ST61 and 7ST63, which differ mainly by the size of their
housing and the number of available inputs and outputs.
7ST63 housing size 1/1 * 19“ with graphic display, control keys, 38 BI and 36 BO
Analog Inputs The measuring inputs (MI) convert the currents and voltages coming from the transformers and
adapt them to the level appropriate for the internal processing of the device. Depending on the
version, the device is equipped with up to 3 current and voltage inputs.
Figure 1-1 Hardware structure of the numerical overhead contact line protection 7ST63
The IA input amplifier group allows high impedance connection for analog input values and con-
tains filters optimized with regard to bandwidth and processing speed for measured value pro-
cessing.
In the analog/digital converter unit, the analog input values are sampled, digitized and supplied to
the microcomputer system.
Microcomputer Apart from processing the measured values, the microcomputer system µC also executes the
System actual protection and control functions. They especially consist of:
• Filtering and conditioning of the measured values
• Continuous monitoring of the measured values
• Monitoring of the pickup conditions for the individual protective functions
• Scanning of limit values and time sequences
• Control of signals for logic functions
• Deciding on trip and close commands
• Storage of indications, fault data and fault values for fault analysis purposes
• Management of the operating system and its functions, e.g. data memory, real-time clock, com-
munication, interfaces, etc.
Binary Inputs and Binary inputs and outputs from and to the computer system are routed via the I/O modules (inputs
Outputs and outputs). The computer system obtains the information from the system (e.g remote resetting)
or the external equipment (e.g. blocking commands). Additional outputs are mainly commands
that are issued to the switching devices and indications for remote signalling of events and states.
Front Elements Optical indicators (LEDs) and a front LC display provide information on the function of the device
and indicate events, states and measured values.
Integrated control and numeric keys in conjunction with the LCD facilitate local interaction with the
local device. All information of the device can be accessed using the integrated control and
numeric keys. The information includes protective and control settings, operating and fault indica-
tions, measured values and settings (see also Chapter 2 and SIPROTEC® 4 System Description,
Order No. E50417-H1176-C151).
Devices with control functions also allow station control on the front panel.
Serial Interfaces Via the serial interface in the front panel the communication with a personal computer using the
operating program DIGSI® is possible. This ensures convenient operation of all device functions.
The service interface can also be used for communication with a personal computer using DIGSI®.
This interface is particularly well suited in case of hard wiring between the devices and the PC or
in case of an operation via modem.
All device data can be transmitted to a central evaluating unit or control center through the serial
system (SCADA) interface. This interface may be provided with various physical transmission
modes and different protocols to suit the particular application.
An additional interface is designed for time synchronization of the internal clock by means of ex-
ternal synchronization sources.
Power Supply These described functional units are supplied by a power supply PS with the necessary power in
the different voltage levels. Brief supply voltage dips which may occur on short circuits in the aux-
iliary voltage supply of the power system are usually bridged by a capacitor (see also Technical
Data, Chapter 4).
The SIPROTEC® 4 7ST6, Numerical Overhead Contact Line Protection for AC Traction Power
Supply, is a selective and fast protection device for overhead contact lines with single- and multi-
ended infeeds.
The device incorporates the functions which are normally required for the protection of an over-
head contact line section and is therefore capable of universal application.
Protective Elements The basic function of the device is the recognition of the distance to the fault with distance protec-
tion measurement. It is supplemented by a range of other protection functions:
When switching to a faulted line section, an undelayed trip signal can be output.
In the event of a failure of the measured voltages due to a fault in the secondary circuits (e.g. trip
of the voltage transformer mcb or a fuse) the device can automatically revert to an emergency op-
eration with an integrated time overcurrent protection (emergency time overcurrent protection),
until the measured voltage again becomes available. There is an additional 3-stage definite/in-
verse time overcurrent protection operating in parallel to, and independent of, the distance protec-
tion. This time overcurrent protection has three current-independent stages and one current-de-
pendent stage. For inverse time overcurrent protection, several curves of different standards are
provided. The stages can be combined in any way. Moreover, a high-speed overcurrent protection
function with a tripping time of less than 2 ms is integrated.
Most short-circuit functions work in conjunction with an integrated automatic reclose function
which is designed for 8 reclosing attempts. Before reclosure, the validity of the reclosure can be
checked by voltage and/or synchronism check by the device (this can be ordered as an option).
Beside the short-circuit protection functions described above, the device offers additional protec-
tion functions such as multiple-stage overvoltage and undervoltage protection, circuit breaker
failure protection, and thermal overload protection, which protects the overhead contact line from
excessive heating due to overloads. The fault locator supports fast location of the fault after a
short-circuit. The inrush restraint feature is used for a clear distinction between operating and fault
conditions during switching operations. The defrosting protection feature provides high-sensitivity
detection of short-circuits during defrosting of the overhead contact line.
Control Functions Depending on the ordered variant the device provides control functions which can be accom-
plished for activating and deactivating switchgear via the integrated operator panel, the system
interface, binary inputs and a personal computer with the operating software DIGSI®. The status
of the primary equipment can be transmitted to the device via auxiliary contacts connected to
binary inputs. The present status (or position) of the primary equipment can be displayed on the
device, and used for interlocking or plausibility monitoring. The number of the primary equipment
to be switched is limited by the binary inputs and outputs available in the device or the binary
inputs and outputs allocated for the switch position indications. Depending on the primary equip-
ment being controlled, one binary input (single point indication) or two binary inputs (double point
indication) may be used for this process. The capability of switching primary equipment can be
restricted by a setting associated with switching authority (Remote or Local), and by the operating
mode (interlocked/non-interlocked, with or without password request). Processing of interlocking
conditions for switching (e.g. switching error protection) can be established with the aid of integrat-
ed, user-configurable logic functions.
Indications and The operational indications provide information about conditions in the power system and the
Measured Values; device itself. Measurement quantities and resulting computed values can be displayed locally and
Fault Recording communicated via the serial interfaces.
Device indications can be assigned to a number of LEDs on the front cover (allocatable), can be
externally processed via output contacts (allocatable), linked with user-definable logic functions
and/or issued via serial interfaces.
During a fault (system fault) important events and changes in conditions are saved in fault logs
(Event Log or Trip Log). Instantaneous fault values are also saved in the device and may be ana-
lysed subsequently.
Communication Serial interfaces are available for the communication with operating, control and memory systems.
1.3 Characteristics
• Complete galvanic and reliable separation between internal processing circuits from the mea-
surement, control, and power supply circuits by analog input transducers, binary inputs and
outputs and the DC/DC or AC voltage converters
• Complete scope of functions which are normally required for the protection of a line feeder
• Simple device operation using the integrated operator panel or a connected personal computer
with operator guidance
Distance Protection • Distance protection function with three zones (Z1, Z2, and Z3), high measuring accuracy and
the ability to adapt to the given system conditions
• for the direction characteristic settable to “forward“, “non-directional“, ”forward extended“, “re-
verse“;
• Combined tripping characteristic with separate setting of reach (absolute impedance value Z),
angle and load limitation (resistance R);
• Adaptation to different switching states of the overhead contact line during operation is ensured
by the changeover function of the impedance stages
• A Wrong Phase Coupling Protection can be realized optionally with an additional WPC-zone.
Time Overcurrent • Full non-directional time overcurrent protection function (definite/inverse time) with three
Protection stages (very high set current stage I>>>, high set current stage I>>, overcurrent stage I>)
High Current • Very short tripping times (<2 ms) when the tripping threshold is exceeded
Switch-onto-Fault
• Faults can be tripped as early as the first zero crossing of the current (in 16.7 Hz systems)
Protection (option-
al)
Emergency Time • Single-stage emergency time overcurrent protection (I> time overcurrent protection)
Overcurrent Protec-
• Instantaneous tripping when switching onto a fault;
tion
• Inrush restraint feature to prevent overfunctioning during the inrush phase
• Two undervoltage stages for the overhead contact line (U<<, U<)
Thermal Overload • Determination of the overhead contact line temperature by creating a thermal profile of the
Protection object to be protected
Defrosting Protec- • Differential protection for defrosting current with configurable characteristic
tion
• Back-up protection with two-stage definite-time overcurrent protection
Inrush Restraint • Distinction between operating and fault condition by harmonics analysis
(optional)
• Possibility of blocking selected protection functions
• Verification of the synchronous conditions or de-energized state also possible before disposi-
tive closing of the circuit breaker, with separate limit values
Fault Locator (op- • Start by tripping command or dropout of the pickup, even with high-current switch-onto-fault
tional) protection
User Defined Func- • Freely programmable combination of internal and external signals for the implementation of
tions (optional) user-defined logic functions
Breaker Control • Switchgear can be activated and de-activated manually via local control keys (7ST63), the pro-
grammable function keys, via the system interface (e.g. SITRAS ® SCS), or via the operating
interface (using a personal computer and the DIGSI® software);
• Feedback on switching states via the circuit breaker auxiliary contacts (for commands with
feedback)
• Plausibility monitoring of the circuit breaker positions and interlocking conditions for switching.
Monitoring Func- • Availability of the device is greatly increased because of self-monitoring of the internal mea-
tions surement circuits, power supply, hardware, and software
Further Functions • Battery buffered real time clock, which may be synchronized via a synchronization signal (e.g.
DCF77, IRIG B via satellite receiver), binary input or system interface
• Fault event memory (trip log) for the last 8 network faults (faults in the power system), with real
time stamps
• Fault recording and data transfer for fault recording for a maximum time range of 15 s
• Statistics: Counter with the trip commands issued by the device, as well as recording of the
current-time integrals, the fault current data and accumulation of the interrupted fault currents
• Communication with control center possible via serial interfaces (depending on the ordering
variant), optionally via data line, modem or fibre optics;
• Commissioning aids such as connection and direction checks as well as circuit breaker test
functions
Based on the following information, it can also be determined which of the provided functions
should be used.
2.1 General 26
2.1 General
A few seconds after the device is switched on, the initial display appears in the LCD. Depending
on the device version either measured values (four-line display, device type 7ST61) or a single-
phase switching diagram of the feeder status (graphic display, device type 7ST63) is displayed in
the 7ST6.
Configuration of the device functions are made via the DIGSI® software from your PC. The proce-
dure is described in detail in the SIPROTEC® 4 System Description, Order No. E50417-H1176-
C151. Entry of password No. 7 (for setting modification) is required to modify configuration set-
tings. Without the password, the settings may be read, but may not be modified and transmitted
to the device.
The function parameters, i.e. settings of function options, threshold values, etc., can be entered
via the keypad and display on the front of the device, or by means of a personal computer con-
nected to the front or service interface of the device utilising the DIGSI® software package. The
level 5 password (individual parameters) is required.
The 7ST6 relay contains a series of protective and additional functions. The hardware and firm-
ware provided is designed for this scope of functions. In addition the command functions can be
matched to the system conditions. Individual functions can be activated or deactivated during the
configuration procedure. The interaction of functions may also be modified.
The available protective and additional functions must be configured as Enabled or Disabled. For
some functions a choice between several alternatives is possible, as described below.
Functions configured as Disabled are not processed by the 7ST6. There are no indications, and
corresponding settings (functions, limit values) are not displayed during setting.
Note
The functions and default settings available depend on the order variant of the device.
Enabling/disabling The protection functions can partly be enabled and disabled via different sources, namely:
of Functions • Parameterisation (Para)
• Binary Input (BI)
• System Interface (SI)
A function is disabled as soon as it is switched off by one of the three sources. In order to enable
a function again, it must be switched on by all sources by which it had been switched off.
The on or off state via binary input remains after a restart. After an initial start this state is pre-
defined as "on".
The following table presents an overview of the activation or blocking of functions. Details are set
out in the respective function description.
ON/OFF Blocking
Function BI SI Para BI SI Para
Distance Protection x - x x - -
High Speed Overcurrent x - x - - -
Protection
Overcurrent Protection x - x - - -
Emergency Overcurrent x - x - - -
Protection
Voltage protection - - x - - -
Thermal Overload x - x - - -
Protection
Defrosting Protection x x x x x x
Inrush Restraint - - - - - -
Fault locator - - - - - -
Breaker Failure Protection x - x - - -
Trip circuit supervision - - x - - -
IT Function x - x - - -
Synchro-check x - x x - -
Automatic Reclosure x x x x - -
Function
Teleprotection - - x - - x
Configuration of Configuration settings can be entered by using a PC and the software program DIGSI® and trans-
Functional Scope ferred via the operating interface of the device or via the service interface on the rear. Operation
using DIGSI® is described in the SIPROTEC® 4 System Description, order no. E50417-H1176-
C151.
Entry of password No. 7 (for setting modification) is required to modify configuration settings.
Without the password, the settings may be read, but may not be modified and transmitted to the
device.
The functional scope with the available options is set in the Functional Scope dialog box to match
plant requirements.
Special Character- Most settings are self-explaining. The special cases are described below.
istics
If use of the setting group changeover function is desired, address 103 Grp Chge OPTION should
be set to Enabled. In this case, up to four different groups of settings may be changed quickly and
easily during device operation (see also Subsection 2.1.4). Only one setting group may be select-
ed and used if the setting is Disabled.
The impedance characteristic valid for distance protection is selected under address 113
DISTANCE CURVE. You can choose between distance protection with combined tripping charac-
teristic and distance protection with polygonal tripping characteristic (see Section 2.2).
The available protection and supplementary functions can be configured as Enabled or Disabled.
When ordering devices, please note that the basic device version does not offer the full scope of
functions. The table below shows which functions are provided in the basic device version, and
which must be ordered separately if required:
2.1.1.3 Settings
2.1.2 Device
The device requires some general information. This may be, for example, the type of indication to
be issued in the event a power system fault occurs.
The recording of indications masked to local LEDs, and the maintenance of spontaneous indica-
tions, can be made dependent on whether the device has issued a trip signal. This information is
then not output if during a system disturbance one or more protection functions have picked up,
but no tripping by the 7ST6 resulted because the fault was cleared by a different device (e.g. on
another line). These indications are then limited to faults in the line to be protected.
The figure below illustrates the creation of the reset command for stored indications. When the
relay drops out, stationary conditions (fault display Target on PU / Target on TRIP; Trip / No Trip)
decide whether the new fault will be stored or reset.
Figure 2-1 Creation of the reset command for the memory of LED and LCD displays
The most important data of a fault event can be displayed automatically after the fault has oc-
curred (see also „Fault indications“ in Section 2.19.1 „Ancillary Functions“).
Fault Indications Pickup of a new protective function generally turns off any previously lit LEDs, so that only the
latest fault is displayed at any time. It can be selected whether the stored LED displays and the
spontaneous indications on the display appear upon renewed pickup, or only after a renewed trip
signal is issued. In order to enter the desired type of display, select the submenu Device in the
SETTINGS menu. At address 610 FltDisp.LED/LCD the two alternatives Target on PU and Target
on TRIP („No trip - no flag“) are offered.
For devices with graphical display use parameter 615 Spont. FltDisp. to specify whether or not a
spontaneous indication will appear automatically on the display (YES) or not (NO). For devices
with text display such indications will appear after a system fault by any means.
You can set at address 620 T Backlight on how long the display backlight will remain on after an
activiation by signal „>Light on“.
2.1.2.4 Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under Additional Set-
tings.
The device requires certain basic data regarding the protected equipment, so that the device will
be compatible with its desired application. This comprises e.g. nominal system data, nominal data
of transformers, polarity ratios and their physical connections, in certain cases circuit breaker
properties, and similar. Furthermore, there are a number of settings associated with all functions
rather than a specific protection, control or monitoring function. These data can normally only be
changed from a PC running DIGSI® and are discussed in this subsection.
General In DIGSI® double-click on Settings to display the relevant selection. A dialog box with the tabs
General, Transformer data, System data, Voltage transformers and Circuit breaker will open under
Power System Data 1, in which you can configure the individual parameters. Thus, the following
subsections are structured accordingly.
At address 245 BI CONTROL you specify the control of the binary inputs for the zone/catenary
changeover (Edge/Level).
Transformer Data In address 201 CT Starpoint the polarity of the current transformers must be stated. This setting
determines the measuring direction of the device (forwards = line direction).
The measured value connections can be found in the Appendix under A.3.
At address 202 CT PRIMARY you set the primary rated CT current (overhead contact line cur-
rent). The secondary rated current is set in address 203 CT SECONDARY.
At addresses 204 Unom PRIMARY and 205 Unom SECONDARY, information is entered regarding
the primary and secondary current ratings of the current transformers.
It is important to ensure that the rated secondary current of the current transformer matches the
rated current of the device, otherwise the device will incorrectly calculate primary data.
Correct entry of the primary data is a prerequisite for the correct computation of operational mea-
sured values with primary magnitude. If the settings of the device are performed with primary
values using DIGSI®, these primary data are an indispensable requirement for the fault-free oper-
ation of the device.
Transformer Data At address 206 IF CT STARPOINT the polarity of the current transformers (negative feeder cur-
for Auto-transform- rent) must be stated. This setting determines the measuring direction of the device (forwards =
er Systems line direction).
The measured value connections can be found in the Appendix under A.3.
At address 207 IF CT PRIMARY you set the primary rated CT current (negative feeder current).
At addresses 209 UF PRIMARY and 210 UF SECONDARY, information regarding the primary and
secondary voltage ratings of the voltage transformers (negative feeder voltage) is entered.
In the parameter CURRENT I1, I2 (address 213) you specify which current will be fed to the pro-
tection functions for evaluation. If you want the summation current to be processed by the protec-
tion functions, set address 213 to Sum I1, I2. The vectors of the overhead contact line current and
the negative feeder current are added.
Note
If at address 213 the parameter CURRENT I1, I2 is set to Sum I1, I2, the setting of jumper X600
on the C-I/O 13 board must be changed for the summation for the high-speed overcurrent protec-
tion! The default setting of this jumper on delivery is „without summation“!
Transformer Data In address 211 IX CT STARPOINT the polarity of the current transformers (defrosting current)
for Defrosting must be stated. This setting determines the measuring direction of the device (forwards = line di-
rection).
At address 212 IX CT PRIMARY you set the primary rated CT current (defrosting current).
Transformer Data If in the Functional Scope of the device the synchro-check function = Enabled (address 135) has
for Synchro-check been configured, the following parameters must be set in the P.System Data 1:
At address 215 Uline/Uref you set the matching factor for the different transformers of the over-
head contact line Vline and of the reference voltage Vref.
System Data The permissible rated frequencies depend on the device variant: 16.7 Hz or 25 to 60 Hz. In the
second variant, the rated frequency can be changed at address 230 Rated Frequency; options are
25 Hz, 50 Hz and 60 Hz.
The 7ST6 device supports several line sections with different reactance per unit length character-
istics for the conversion of a fault impedance into a fault distance. The number of line sections with
different reactance per unit length characteristics can be set in address 234 No. SECTIONS and
235 No.SECTIONS REV. The settings that you apply here determine the setting parameters for
the reactance per unit length characteristics that will be shown in the P.System Data 2 in the setting
sheet .
Address 236 Distance Unit allows to determine the unit of length (km or Miles) for the fault location
indications. This parameter is not relevant if no fault detection is available. Changing the length
unit will not result in an automatic conversion between the systems. Such conversions must be
entered at the appropriate addresses.
Circuit Breaker At address 239 T-CB close the operating time of the connected circuit breaker is set for the CLOSE
command. This operating time will be taken into account by the Sync. Check function when closing
the circuit breaker.
At address 237 the operating time of the circuit breaker T CB BREAKTIME is set for the TRIP
command. This time is taken into account for tripping to determine the duration of the current-time
integral.
In address 240 the minimum trip command duration TMin TRIP CMD is set. This setting applies
to all protective functions that initiate tripping. It also determines the length of the trip pulse when
a circuit breaker trip test is initiated via the device. Each trip command is extended by at least the
time set here. This time must be chosen to ensure a reliable tripping of the breaker. This parameter
can only be altered with DIGSI® under Additional Settings.
In address 241 the maximum close command duration TMax CLOSE CMD is set. This applies to
all close commands issued by the device. It also determines the length of the close command
pulse when a circuit breaker test cycle is issued via the device. It must be chosen to ensure that
the circuit breaker can always close reliably. There is no risk in setting this time too long, as the
close command will in any event be terminated following a new trip command from a protection
function. This parameter can only be altered with DIGSI® under Additional Settings.
The 7ST6 allows a circuit breaker test during operation by means of a tripping and a closing
command entered on the front panel or via DIGSI®. The duration of the trip command is set as
explained above. Address 242 T-CBtest-dead determines the duration from the end of the trip
command until the start of the close command for this test. It should not be less than 0.1 s.
At address 243 TEST CB CIRCUIT you can choose the trip circuits in which a circuit breaker test
is to be performed. For an initial test, you should test both breaker circuits individually and one
after the other in order to achieve a maximum of security.
2.1.3.2 Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under Additional Set-
tings.
The table indicates region-specific presettings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corre-
sponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
Up to four different setting groups can be created for establishing the device's function settings.
During operation, the user can locally switch between setting groups using the operator panel,
binary inputs (if so configured), the operator and service interface from a personal computer or via
the system interface. For reasons of safety, it is not possible to change between setting groups
during a power system fault.
A setting group includes the setting values for all functions that have been selected as Enabled
during configuration (see Section 2.1.1.2). In 7ST6 devices, four independent setting groups (A to
D) are available. Whereas setting values and options may vary, the selected scope of functions is
the same for all groups.
Setting groups enable the user to save the corresponding settings for each application. When they
are needed, settings may be loaded quickly. All setting groups are stored in the relay. Only one
setting group may be active at a given time.
General If multiple setting groups are not required. Group A is the default selection. Then, the rest of this
section is not applicable.
If multiple setting groups are desired, the setting group change option must be set to Grp Chge
OPTION = Enabled in the relay configuration of the functional scope (Section 2.1.1.2, address
103). Now the 4 setting groups A to D are available. They are configured individually as required
in the following. To find out how to proceed, how to copy and to reset settings groups to the delivery
state, and how to switch between setting groups during operation, please refer to the SIPROTEC
4 System Description.
Two binary inputs enable changing between the 4 setting groups from an external source.
Important setting Please note that the parameters to enable/disable the distance protection zones:
note
are global parameters and have the same value in all parameter groups. The last write operation
of these parameters in one group will overwrite the value of these parameters in all groups. This
is a difference to all other zone-relevant parameters, which are local to a parameter group and can
be set differently for each setting group. This characteristic of the relay must be considered in
order to obtain the desired behaviour.
Scenario 1
The project requires a single set up and parameter 103 is set to “disabled”.
Scenario 2
The project requires different parameter groups. All groups make use of the same distance pro-
tection zones but with different zone-settings for the different zones.
In this case the active / inactive zones are set globally, typically during the set up of the first pa-
rameter group. During the setting of the other parameters group, the parameters 1301, 1321,
1331, 1341, 1361 and 1381 are left unchanged. The zone boundaries and all other parameters
are set independently for each zone in each parameter group.
Scenario 3
The project requires different parameters group and also a different number of active zones in the
different groups. For example in group A zone one and two are active, while in group B only zone
one is active; groups C and D are not used.
In order to obtain the desired behavior, the following procedure must be adopted:
1. Identify the setting group with the maximum number of active zones, in this case group A.
2. Activate all zones which are active in the setting group identified in step 1 in all setting groups.
In this case activate both zone one and zone two.
3. Inhibit the zones which are active but not used in the current parameter group by setting the
tripping time to infinity (), or to a value bigger than the delay of the "latest" zone. In this example
this implies setting the tripping time of zone two to infinity (or to a finite value bigger than the value
in zone one) in group B.
4. Repeat step 3 for all setting groups. In this example, no further action is required, since groups
C and D are not used.
It is also important to notice, that setting the zones one and two as active in group A and then
setting zone two as disabled in group B would not lead to the desired behavior. In fact, because
of the global character of the zone enabling/disabling parameters, the final result would be to have
zone one active in both groups and zone two disabled in both groups.
2.1.4.3 Settings
The general protection data (P.System Data 2) include settings associated with all functions rather
than a specific protection, monitoring or control function. In contrast to the P.System Data 1 as dis-
cussed before, these can be changed over with the setting groups and can be configured via the
operator panel of the device.
System Data The parameters of System Data are only accessible if address 138 Fault Locator has been set to
Enabled in the functional scope.
Depending on the settings under P.System Data 1, you set the reactance per unit length character-
istics for up to 5 line sections in the P.System Data 2 under . These values are needed for conver-
sion of the fault impedance into a fault distance.
The reactance per unit length characteristic X´ is entered as a secondary value. At address 1110
X1 you set the secondary reactance per unit length characteristic for the 1st line section in /km
if the unit length set under System Data is km (address 236, see Subsection 2.1.3.1).
At address 1111 d1 you set the corresponding line length of the 1st line section. The device needs
these values for conversion of the fault impedance into a fault distance.
At address 1160 X1 you set the secondary reactance per unit length characteristic for the 1st line
section in /mile if the unit length set under System Data is Miles (address 236, see Subsection
2.1.3.1).
At address 1161 d1 you set the corresponding line length of the 1st line section. The device needs
these values for conversion of the fault impedance into a fault distance.
Manual Close At address 1150 SI Time Man.Cl you set the action time (seal-in time) for the manual close signal.
The parameter SI Time Man.Cl can only be altered with DIGSI® under Additional Settings.
At address 1151 SYN.MAN.CL you specify whether a synchro-check (with Sync-check) will be per-
formed in case of a manual closure or not (w/o Sync-check).
2.1.5.2 Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under Additional Set-
tings.
The table indicates region-specific presettings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corre-
sponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
The 7ST6 numerical overhead contact line protection is equipped with a fault recording function.
The instantaneous values of the measurement quantities i (overhead contact line current) and u
(overhead contact line voltage) are recorded in all variants of the 7ST6 device.
In devices with 3 measuring inputs (3xI, 3xU), the instantaneous value of the measurement quan-
tity iX (defrosting current) is recorded as well.
In protection devices with the maximum scope of functions, the following instantaneous values are
additionally recorded:
Furthermore, the following r.m.s. values of the defrosting protection are recorded:
ir Restraint current
The 7ST6 works with an automatic frequency correction, i.e. the sampling interval is automatically
adapted to frequency changes. The table below shows the sampling rates and sampling intervals
for the individual rated frequencies:
Table 2-1 Sampling rates and sampling intervals of the available rated frequencies
Rated frequency Sampling rate Sampling interval
[Hz] [ms]
16.7 48 1.25
25 32 1.25
50 16 1.25
60 16 1.04
For a fault, the data are stored for an adjustable period of time, but no more than 5 seconds per
fault. A total of 8 records can be saved within 15 s. The fault record memory is automatically
updated with every new fault, so no acknowledgment for previously recorded faults is required.
The storage of fault values can be started by pickup of a protection function, as well as via binary
input and via the serial interface.
The data can be retrieved via the serial interfaces by means of a personal computer and evaluated
with the protection data processing program DIGSI® and the graphic analysis software SIGRA 4.
The latter graphically represents the data recorded during the system fault and calculates addi-
tional information such as the impedance or r.m.s. values from the measured values. A selection
may be made as to whether the currents and voltages are represented as primary or secondary
values. Binary signal traces (marks) of particular events, e.g. „fault detection“, „tripping“ are also
represented.
If the device has a serial system interface, the fault recording data can be passed on to a central
device via this interface. The data is evaluated by applicable programs in the central device. Cur-
rents and voltages are referred to their maximum values, scaled to their rated values and prepared
for graphic representation. Binary signal traces (marks) of particular events, e.g. „fault detection“,
„tripping“ are also represented.
In the event of transfer to a central device, the request for data transfer can be executed automat-
ically and can be selected to take place after each fault detection by the protection, or only after a
trip.
General Other settings pertaining to fault recording (waveform capture) are found in the submenu Oscil-
lographic Fault Records submenu of the Settings menu. Waveform capture makes a distinc-
tion between the trigger instant for an oscillographic record and the criterion to save the record
(address 402 WAVEFORMTRIGGER). This parameter can only be altered using DIGSI at Addi-
tional Settings. Normally the trigger instant is the device pickup, i.e. the pickup of an arbitrary
protective function is assigned the time. The criterion for saving may be both the device pickup
(Save w. Pickup) or the device trip (Save w. TRIP). A trip command issued by the device can also
be used as trigger instant (Start w. TRIP), in this case it is also the saving criterion.
An oscillographic fault record includes data recorded prior to the time of trigger, and data after the
dropout of the recording criterion. Usually this is also the extent of a fault recording (address 403
WAVEFORM DATA = Fault event). If automatic reclosure is implemented, the entire system dis-
turbance — possibly with several reclose attempts — up to the ultimate fault clearance can be
stored (address 403 WAVEFORM DATA = Pow.Sys.Flt.). This facilitates the representation of the
entire system fault history, but also consumes storage capacity during the auto reclosure dead
time(s). This parameter can only be altered with DIGSI at Additional Settings.
The actual storage time begins at the pre-fault time PRE. TRIG. TIME (address 411) ahead of the
reference instant, and ends at the post-fault time POST REC. TIME (address 412) after the
storage criterion has reset. The maximum recording duration to each fault MAX. LENGTH is set
at address 410.
The fault recording can also be triggered via a binary input, via the keypad on the front of the
device or with a PC via the operation or service interface. The storage is then dynamically trig-
gered. The length of the fault recording is set in address 415 BinIn CAPT.TIME (maximum length
however is MAX. LENGTH, address 410). Pre-fault and post-fault times will be included. If the
binary input time is set for , then the length of the record equals the time that the binary input is
activated (static), or the MAX. LENGTH setting in address 410, whichever is shorter.
Note
Please note that in case of changing one or more of these parameters the existing fault records
are deleted.
2.1.6.3 Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under Additional Set-
tings.
The type of characteristics used for the distance protection is specified in the Functional Scope
under parameter 113 DISTANCE CURVE. Combined or polygonal tripping characteristics are
available.
The distance protection requires several enable signals. These enable signals ensure that the dis-
tance protection works only with measurement signals that allow precise measurement of the im-
pedance. The enabling of the distance protection is also influenced by a number of control signals
which allow a dynamic enabling or blocking of this function. The figure below shows a cutout of
the control logic that is responsible for enabling the function.
The distance protection can be switched on or off by parameter settings, or via a binary input.
Switching the function on or off via the binary inputs „>Dis.prot. on“ (FNo. 3601) and „>Dis.prot.off“
(FNo. 3602) is done with edge triggering. The distance protection can also be dynamically blocked
via the binary input „>BLOCK Distance“ (FNo. 3603).
The distance protection is equipped with an overcurrent pickup function. For precise impedance
measurement, the current signal must have a minimum amplitude. This minimum amplitude can
be set with parameter 1202 Minimum Iph>. For more information on this setting please refer to the
setting notes.
The enabling of the distance protection incorporates the trip signal of the miniature circuit breaker
of the voltage transformer circuit 361 „>FAIL:Feeder VT“; this prevents spurious tripping of the dis-
tance protection in case of a measuring voltage failure.
When the indication 3653 „Dist. ACTIVE“ is active, all conditions for enabling the distance protec-
tion are fulfilled.
With this tripping characteristic, the curves are constituted by one circle segment and several
straight lines.
The radius „Z“ of the circle segment defines the reach of the associated tripping zone. The circle
segment is limited by the directional straight lines „“ and „“.
In addition, an area „ + R“ can be cut from the circle segment in order to adapt the tripping char-
acteristic better to the load impedance.
This allows a better distinction between fault and load range, and an improved behaviour of the
protection function is the presence of arc faults and close-up faults with transformer saturation.
For each single curve, the direction characteristic can be selected independently; options are „For-
ward“, „Forward extended“, „Reverse“ and „Non-directional“.
The setting „Forward extended“ has the same curve as the forward setting. In addition, the curve
for close-up faults is extended to non-directional. This extension takes place if the secondary
voltage has a value of less than 1 V, and the absolute value of the measured impedance is within
the tripping zone.
With this tripping characteristic, the curves are constituted by several straight lines.
The straight line in parallel to the R axis defines the largest reactance present in the tripping area,
and thus the range of the tripping zone.
The straight line in parallel to the X axis defines the limitation of the tripping area in R direction.
The tripping area is also limited by the directional straight lines. In addition, an area is cut from the
polygon to exclude the load impedances area from the tripping area.
This allows a better distinction between fault and load range, and a better behaviour of the protec-
tion function is the presence of arc faults and close-up faults with transformer saturation.
For each single curve, the direction characteristic can be selected independently; options are For-
ward, Reverse and Non-directional.
An extra characteristic „Forward extended“ is available for the detection of close-up faults. This
characteristic differs from the „Forward“ characteristic by the circle „Z“. The characteristic „For-
ward extended“ is only active if the secondary voltage is <1 V and the absolute value of the mea-
sured impedance is within the associated tripping zone. The radius of the circle „Z“ is dependent
on the supply voltage and the impedance of the series-connected power system.
The figure below shows the tripping characteristic of the polygonal characteristic.
In highly loaded, long overhead contact lines, when energizing with high loads or load currents at
the end of long supply zones, the load impedances can be as high as the short-circuit impedances,
so that an impedance comparison alone is no longer sufficient.
In order to distinguish between such operating states and short-circuits, the tripping characteris-
tics Z2 and Z3 have two grading times which can be set independently.
The long grading time must be set to a value that is higher than the duration of a startup procedure.
The short grading time is the delay time of the tripping characteristic from the grading coordination
chart.
In order to distinguish between short-circuits and energization, the 7ST6 devices are equipped
with a short-circuit detection that uses the criteria „I/t“ and „U/t“. In case of an overload, the
gradients of current (I/t) and voltage (U/t) are considerably smaller than in case of a short-
circuit. For the definition of these threshold values, the load variations, which are a function of the
distance between the feeding point and the vehicle, must be taken into account.
You can set parameter Rel. T2K at address 1210 for zone 2 and Rel. T3K at address 1220 for zone
3 to determine whether the criteria di/dt and du/dt are to be combined via „AND“ or via „OR“. Refer
to Figure 2-6.
You can set the pickup sensitivity for di/dt against the present load current (energization current)
to ensure the sensitivity for short-circuit detection with small current values and, simultaneously,
prevent false tripping during energization with relatively large current values. For zone 2 this is pa-
rameter di/dt Z2 at address 1343 for the initial value Rest. di/dt Z2 at address 1211 for the slope in
dependence on the load current or di/dt Z3 at address 1363 and Rest. di/dt Z3 at 1221 for zone 3.
See following picture.
If parameter Rest. di/dt Z2 at address 1211 or Rest. di/dt Z3 at address 1221 is set to 0, the settings
for di/dt remain without restraint.
3755
Dis Pickup Z2
dI a 13892
I ˂, a>b
dt b & Dis PU Z2di/dt
1343 di/dt
i/dt Z2
di OR du 3925
>1 & Dis Flt.Z2K
di AND du
3926
& & Dis Flt.Z2L
dU
U ˂8 a
dt a>b
b
1344 du/dt Z2
1363 di/dt
i/dt Z3
dU
˂8 a
dt a>b
b
1364 du/dt Z3
3653
Dis. ACTIVE
1343 di/dt Z2
=0
1
0 & 1251 Rel. Z2K
>0
di AND du 3909
& Dis. T2K active
1344 du/dt Z2 di OR du
=0
1 1
0
>0
1363 di/dt Z3
=0
1
0 & 1253 Rel. Z3K
>0
di AND du 13804
& Dis. T3K active
1364 du/dt Z3 di OR du
=0
1
0
>0
The short-circuit detection logic provides the signals „Dis. T2K active“ (FNo. 3909) and „Dis. T3K
active“ (FNo. 13804). These signals are used for switchover of the tripping times of the zones Z2
and Z3. If these signals are active, the tripping times T2K (FNo. 1346) or T3K (FNo. 1366) respec-
tively of the associated zone are activated. Indications inform the user which criterion for short-
circuit detection has picked up.
After enabling distance measurement, the system compares the measured impedance with the
limit values of the set zones.
Tripping is carried out if the zone is enabled and the impedance is part of that zone when the cor-
responding time stage expires. The general criteria for enabling a zone are described in Subsec-
tion 2.2.1 „Enabling the Distance Protection“.
Zone Z1 is always enabled when the auto reclose function of the device is not active.
With the auto reclose function activated, either zone Z1, Z1B or Z1L is enabled, depending on the
current cycle of the AR function.
The zones Z2 and Z3 have each two different tripping times. The indications „Dis. T2K active“
(FNo. 3909) and „Dis. T3K active“ (FNo. 13804) are used to control which of the two tripping times
is effective for each stage. These signals are provided by the short-circuit detection function.
In zone Z2, the short tripping time T2K becomes effective, and the indication „Dist.Flt.Z2K“ (FNo.
3925) is generated.
In the presence of an overload, the long tripping time T2L becomes effective in zone Z2, and the
indication „Dist.Flt.Z2L“ (FNo. 3926) is generated.
Similar tripping times and indications also exist for zone Z3.
In addition, the 7ST6 device has one zone that is activated when a circuit breaker is manually
closed. The enable logic of the is described separately in Subsection 2.2.7. „Tripping Character-
istic for Manual Close“.
The zones Z1B and Z1L, which are only available in combination with the function Auto Reclose,
are also described separately in Subsection 2.2.6. „Tripping Characteristic for Manual Reclose“.
The figure below shows the logic for generating the pickup and trip signals of the independent
zones.
The logic for providing the direction signals and the general pickup and trip are shown separately
in the figure below.
'LVW=
'LV38=%
25 'LV3,&.83
'LV38=/
'LV3LFNXS=
'LVW)OW=.
'LVW)OW=/
'LV38=.
'LV38=/
'LV7ULS=
'LV75,3=%
25 'LV*HQ7ULS
'LV75,3=/
'LV7ULS=.
'LV7ULS=/
'LV75,3=.
'LV75,3=/
'LV7ULS380&
'LV75,30&=25
The distance protection zones described in this subsection are only available if the function Auto
Reclose is available in the device.
The controlled zone Z1B is usually applied as an overreaching zone. The logic is shown in Figure
2-10. It may be activated via various internal and external functions. The binary inputs for external
activation of Z1B of the distance protection are „>BLK 1.AR-cycle“ and „>BLOCK AR“. The former
can, for example, be from an external teleprotection device, and only affects Z1B of the distance
protection. The latter affects both overreaching stages. The Auto Reclose can also be controlled
by an external protection device. The control signals for this arrive at the binary inputs „>AR Start“
and „>Trip for AR“.
In the initial state, with the Distance prot. switched on and the Auto Reclose operative, zone Z1B is
enabled.
With the function Auto Reclose switched off or not operative, zone Z1 is enabled.
Before the 2nd reclosure cycle, the enable for zone Z1B is reset after the dead time has expired,
and the enable for zone Z1L is set with start of the blocking time and the CLOSE command. The
pickup starts all action times which are enabled for initiation.
When the 1st action time has expired but the 2nd action time is still running, the zone enabling
switches from zone Z1B to zone Z1L. An exception to this is the last reclosure cycle. If all reclosure
attempts were unsuccessful, zone Z1 is enabled prior to the last configured reclosure cycle.
Direction Determi- If you switch a deenergized line that is faulty line to a live busbar, the direction of faults close to
nation on Closing the location of the voltage transformer is difficult to determine, because the measuring voltage re-
quired for correct direction determination is missing. If the voltage transformer is installed towards
the line, no stored voltage is available.
With such local faults, the distance protection always assumes a fault in FORWARD direction. This
allows instantaneous tripping, regardless of the set characteristic. The criterion for a non-direction-
al trip in zone 1 on switching to a short-circuit is the fault voltage. With a secondary voltage of less
than 1 V a non-directional trip command is issued.
Processing of the To make undelayed tripping possible on switching of a faulted line, the control-discrepancy switch
Manual Close can use a binary input to issue the manual close command to the overhead contact line protection
Signal system. To do so, the external signal „>Manual Close“ must be configured to a binary input. The
figure below shows the logic diagram for this.
The parameter 1232 SOTF zone can be used to determine whether the instantaneous tripping after
manual closing is valid for the Overreach Zone provided for this purpose, or for the general pickup
of the distance protection. The function can also be disabled with this parameter. The Overreach
Zone has its own characteristic curve parameters. The binary signal „>Manual Close“ activates this
mechanism by its rising edge for a duration that can be set with the parameter 1150 SI Time
Man.Cl. The manual close function is thus independent of the duration of the signal present at the
binary input.
To adapt the protection to different switching states of the overhead contact line during operation,
the device is equipped with a changeover function of the impedance stages for zone Z1, zone Z2
and zone Z3 via binary inputs, a control system or the operator control panel.
Depending on the selected type of characteristic curve, this function switches the parameters for
the reach of these zones to an alternative value.
With combined characteristics, the Z Stroke or Z Stroke Reverse parameters are then used for
these stages instead of the Z parameters. Likewise, the X Stroke or X Stroke Reverse parameters
instead of the X parameters are used for polygonal characteristics. For the characteristics, the R
Stroke or R Stroke Reverse parameters are used instead of the R parameters.
The active control source for this changeover is selected with the parameter 1205 CHANGE
ZONE; setting options are Binary Input, Protocol, Setting or Blocked.
The control sources Binary Input and Protocol can continue to be operated, even if they are not
activated. However, the status Zx or Zx Stroke set in this way will not take effect until the associ-
ated control source is selected again (see Figure 2-12).
For zone changeover by Protocol the commands 13811 through 13813 "Distance Zone Zx Stroke
ON" are provided.
With Binary Input the changeover of Z1, Z2 and Z3 is performed via the binary input indications
FNo. 3900 and 3901, 3902 and 3903, or 3906 and 3907, ">Dist. Zone Zx stroke is active" and
">Dist.: Zone Zx is active".
The binary inputs also allow to switch the setting CHANGE ZONE to Protocol when the binary
input 365 „>Ctrl Select.“= „>Select: Control by BI or SYS interface“ is activated.
With the setting Setting the changeover is performed with the parameters 1302 Zone Sel. Z1, 1342
Zone Sel. Z2 and 1362 Zone Sel. Z3. These parameters are masked out if a different control source
is selected.
The figure below shows the logic of the zone changeover, with zone Z1 as an example.
2.2.9 Teleprotection
Purpose of telepro- Short-circuits that occur beyond the first distance zone on the protected line can only be cleared
tection selectively by the distance protection after a delay time. On line sections that are shorter than the
smallest sensible distance setting, faults can also not be selectively cleared instantaneously.
To achieve non-delayed and selective tripping on 100% of the line length for all faults by the dis-
tance protection, distance protection function can exchange and process information with the op-
posite line end by means of teleprotection and can use this information further. This will be done
in a conventional way by using the send output „Dis Sig.Send“ (FNo. 17100) and the receive input
„>Dis Receive“ (FNo. 4004).
Teleprotection A transfer trip via pickup is available as the signal transmission process. It operates in an under-
scheme reaching manner, i.e. tripping can be accelerated, but is never enabled first. Tripping can also be
blocked depending on the set operating mode.
Transmission For signal transmission, at least one transmission channel is needed for each direction. Conven-
chanels tional transmission media are used for this purpose, e.g. fiber-optic connections, audio frequen-
cymodulated high-frequency channels over communications cables, power-line carrier transmis-
sion or microwave radio. The Siemens SWT 3000 teleprotection device can be used, for example.
In the event of disruptions along the transmission link, the receive logic can be blocked by a binary
input signal „>Dis Rec.Fault“ (FNo. 4005). When this signal is received, a corresponding response
is brought about depending on the set operating mode (for details, see "Functional description").
During emergency definite time-overcurrent protection, the teleprotection option is out of service,
with the exception of the echo function.
Functional descrip- The teleprotection function is activated or deactivated via the parameter 1250 SigMod (by selecting
tion an operating mode).
Operating modes:
Mode Z1 - Intertrip on pickup Z1/Z1’
Mode Z2 - Intertrip on pickup Z2/Z2’
Mode Z3 - Blocking on pickup Z3/Z3’
The teleprotection mode Z1 can be used whenever lines are extremely short and therefore a
setting to 85% of the line section length makes a selective interruption not possible. In this case,
the zone Z1/Z1' must be delayed with time T1 so that it does not trip quickly independently of the
receive signal. Additional, zone Z1/Z1' has to be set to higher than 100 % (overreaching) of the
line section.
An intertrip signal is sent to the remote end in the event of a fault in the zone Z1/Z1' in the forwards
direction. Regardless of a delay time set there, the signal received there leads to tripping if the
protection under consideration has also picked up in zone Z1/Z1'.
Figure 2-15 Logic diagram of the intertrip via pickup, mode Z1 (one line end)
Sequence
In the event of pickup of distance protection in the zone Z1/Z1' set to overreaching (over 100 %
line section length) in forwards direction, the intertrip signal FNo. 17100 „>Dis Sig.Send” is gener-
ated independently of a set delay time T1.
Tripping is without delay (before a set delay time T1 has elapsed) in the event of activation of the
binary input 4004 „>Dis Receive” and a distance protection pickup in zone Z1/Z1'.
Tripping is without delay (before a set delay time T1/T1' has elapsed) in the event of activation of
the binary input 4005 „>Dis Rec. Fault” and the existence or arrival of pickup in the distance pro-
tection zone Z1/Z1'.
The teleprotection mode Z2 can be used if, in the case of classic protective time gradinmg (zone
Z1 without delay up to approx. 85 % of line section length, zone Z2 delayed and overreaching),
tripping in quick-operating time has to take place for operational reasons. This is why, in the Z2
mode, it is possible to already send a intertrip signal on pickup of zone Z2/Z2'. To prevent over-
functioning, the protection in the opposite line end station reacts with immediate tripping only if a
short-circuit there (pickup of Zone Z2K) has been detected.
Figure 2-16 Logic diagram of the intertrip via pickup, mode Z2 (one line end)
Sequence
In the event of a distance protection pickup in zone Z2/Z2' set to over 100 % line sectionlength in
forwards direction, the intertrip signal FNo. 17100 „>Dis Sig.Send” is generated independently of
a set delay time T2L/T2K. Via the parameter 1400 SigMod Z2 Send, it is possible to set whether a
send signal is always to be generated regardless of a short-circuit or an overload (pickup
Z2L/Z2K) or only in the event of a short-circuit (pickup Z2K).
Tripping is without delay (before a set delay time T2K has elapsed) in the event of activation of the
binary input 4004 „>Dis Receive” and pickup in the distance protection zone Z2K/Z2'K (shortcircuit
detected).
All set delay times elapse normally in the event of activation of the binary input 4005 „>Dis Rec.
Fault” and the existence or arrival of pickup in the distance protection zone Z2/Z2'.
The teleprotection mode Z3 can be used whenever setting to 85 % of the line section length and
t hus selective interruption is not possible for operational reasons. In this case, the zone Z1/Z1' is
set to over 100 % of the line section length and delayed by time T1. Nevertheless, to enable se-
lective interruption of faults which occur beyond the neighboring station but are still detected as
Z1 faults due to the overreaching zone Z1/Z1', response of the zone Z3/Z3' in the reverse direction
at the remote station can be used to block zone Z1/Z1' pickup.
Sequence
In the event of distance protection pickup in the zone Z3/Z3' in reverse direction, the intertrip signal
FNo. 17100 „>Dis Sig.Send” is generated independently of a set delay time T3.
In the event of activation of the binary input 4004 „>Dis Receive” and a pickup of the distance pro-
tection zone Z1/Z1', it is blocked immediately and thus tripping is suppressed (see Figure 2-14,
17104 Disblk Z1).
Tripping is without delay (before a set delay time T1/T1' has elapsed) in the event of activation of
the binary input 4005 „>Dis Rec. Fault” and the existence or arrival of pickup in the distance pro-
tection zone Z1/Z1'.
Echo function In cases in which distance protection is not active due to emergency definite time-overcurrent pro-
tection operation or due to an already opened circuit-breaker, when activating the binary input
4004 „>Dis Receive” a signal can be generated by the echo function to inform the sender about
the staus of the remote station and to enable a required reaction there. Therefore, the signal 4067
„>Dis EchoSend” is generated by the echo function, if it has been activated via the parameter 1402
Echo. To detect an open circuit-breaker, for instance a circuit-breaker auxiliary contact has to be
connected via a binary input to signal 4602 „>CB open”.
A generated signal 4067 „>Dis EchoSend” will stay activated for 500 ms due to a internal impulse
stretching mechanism. Therefore a secure identification at the opposite end of the line is assured.
Starting from firmware release 4.70 the devices 7ST612 and 7ST632 provide an additional dis-
tance protection zone expressly designed for the realization of a wrong phase coupling protection.
This additional distance protection zone, which can be enabled or disabled according to the cus-
tomer´s protection philosophy, is aimed at detecting a double-sided out of phase feeding of the
protected line. An example is given in Figure 2-19, where a traction power supply system is fed
directly from a three phase grid.
L1
L2
L3
Transformer Transformer
A B
Contact Line
Track
Section A Section B
Figure 2-19 Direct feeding of the overhead contact line from a three phase system
In normal operation, different electrification sections are fed from different phases of the three
phase grid in order to reduce unbalance. The two electrification sections are separated by a
neutral section or an air gap. Locomotives and trains are required to open the main circuit breaker
before entering the neutral section and to keep the circuit breaker open until they have left the
neutral section. If, however, the main circuit breaker is closed while crossing the neutral section,
the pantograph might create an arc and connect both electrification sections.
A second operational case, in which a coupling of electrification sections might happen, is during
emergency operation. In particular, when a substation goes out of service, both electrification sec-
tions can be coupled by closing a coupler. This operation is only permitted when one of the elec-
trification sections is deenergized. If the coupling is inadvertently performed when both electrifica-
tion sections are energized, a short circuit is created.
The function of the wrong phase coupling protection is to identify these short circuits as fast as
possible and to trip the circuit breaker in the shortest possible time. Unlike the usual distance pro-
tection zones, the wrong phase coupling is not based on a direction decision. Because of the
phase difference of the two feeding voltages, the measured impedance displays a phase shift
compared to the total impedance of the overhead contact line. For this reason, the WPC-zone is
situated in a different part of the impedance coordinate-plan than the usual distance protection
zones.
For the protection devices in electrification section A we have following equivalent circuit:
7ST6
I Z LA Connector Z LB
Section A Section B
U 0 e j 0 U 0 e j
U
XA XB
Track
Figure 2-20 Equivalent circuit model for the wrong phase coupling
: Phase shift between the voltage sources, in this example = 120o
XA, XB : Reactance of the transformers at the feeding points
We can now calculate the impedance measured by the 7ST6 basing on the equivalent circuit
model.
Z
Z LA Z LB 1 e j jX A
1 e j
Figure 2-21 Equation (1)
Exactly like the other distance zones, the WPC-zone trip command can be delayed by a settable
time T WPC (Addr. 1392).
The WPC-zone can be interlocked with the transformer in-rush detection by setting the parameter
RUSH DIS>=Z2 (Addr. 2301) to Yes.
The pickup of the WPC-zone is only released if the voltage is smaller than Umax WPC (Addr.
1397). If the voltage is bigger, then no pickup is possible.
If the value of Zmin WPC is set bigger than Zmax WPC or the value of Alpha WPC is set bigger
than Beta WPC then a set-up error is detected and the WPC zone is disabled. In these cases, the
signals (WPC Error Z or WPC Error Ang) will be sent.
On
1 Inactive
Yes
1 No
13946 &
INRUSH detected
1202 Iph>
I > Iph>
I 16043
Dist. PU WPC
X
1392 T WPC
16044
Tripping
Area &
AND T 0 Dist. T WPC
WPC WPC ß
Zmax
16045
WPC WPC a
Zmin Dist. TRIP WPC
R
Example:
According to equation (1) the short circuit impedance for a wrong phase coupling can be calcula-
ted as:
With this set up, the short circuit impedance lays roughly in the middle of the WPC-zone.
At address 1201 FCT Distance the distance protection function can be switched ON or OFF. At
address 113 DISTANCE CURVE the characteristic types Quadrilateral and Combined can be se-
lected (see Subsection 2.1.1.2). This setting is valid for all characteristics of the distance protec-
tion.
Minimum Current The minimum phase current is set in address 1202 Minimum Iph>. The minimum current for fault
detection Minimum Iph> is set a little (approx. 10 %) below the minimum short-circuit current that
may occur.
Load Area For the description of the parameters of the load range in this section, general designations will
be used. Table 2-2 shows the assignment of these designations to the concrete parameters of a
zone.
On long, highly loadable lines there is a risk of the load impedance rising as high as the tripping
area of the distance protection. In order to avoid spurious pickup of the distance protection during
the transfer of high powers, the load range can be set so as to exclude such spurious capture due
to overloads. This load range has been taken into account for the description of the tripping char-
acteristics (see margin headings „Combined Characteristics“ and „Polygonal Characteristics“).
The R value is set somewhat (approx. 10 %) below the minimum expected load impedance. The
minimum load impedance results when the maximum load current and minimum operating voltage
exist.
Example:
ILMax = 784 A
This value can be entered as a primary value when parameterizing with a PC and DIGSI®. Con-
version to secondary quantities is:
Primary: RL = 14.63 or
Secondary: RL = 97.53 .
The spread angle of the load range „“ must be greater (approx. 10°) than the maximum arising
load angle (corresponding to the minimum power factor cosMin ).
Calculation example:
cosMin = 0.63
max = 51°
Grading Coordina- It is recommended to initially create a grading coordination chart for the entire galvanically inter-
tion Chart connected system. This diagram should reflect the line lengths with their primary reactances X´ in
/km. For the reach of the distance zones, the reactance X is the deciding quantity.
The first zone Z1 is usually set to cover 85 % of the protected line without any trip time delay (i.e.
T1 = 0.00 s). The protection clears faults in this range without additional time delay, i.e. the tripping
time is the relay basic operating time.
The tripping time of the higher zones is sequentially increased by one time grading margin. The
grading margin must take into account the circuit breaker operating time including the spread of
this time, the resetting time of the protection equipment as well as the spread of the protection
delay timers. Typical values are 0.2 s to 0.4 s. The reach is selected to cover up to approximately
80 % of the zone with the same set time delay on the shortest neighbouring feeder.
When using a personal computer and DIGSI® to apply the settings, these can be optionally
entered as primary or secondary values. In the case of parameterization with secondary quanti-
ties, the values derived from the grading coordination chart must be converted to the secondary
side of the current and voltage transformers. In general:
Accordingly, the reach for any distance zone can be specified as follows:
where:
Calculation example:
s (length) = 35 km
For the first zone, a setting of 85 % of the line length should be applied, which results in primary:
or secondary:
Determination of An impedance vector is also used to determine the direction of the short-circuit. Usually similar to
Direction the distance calculation, ZL is used. However, depending on the "quality" of the measured values,
different computation techniques are used. Immediately after fault inception, the short-circuit
voltage is disturbed by transients. The voltage memorized prior to fault inception is therefore used
in this situation. If there is neither a current measured voltage nor a memorised voltage available
which is sufficient for measuring the direction, the "forward reverse" direction is selected. In prac-
tice this can only occur when the circuit breaker closes onto a de-energised line, and there is a
fault on this line (e.g. closing onto an earthed line).
Figure 2-24 shows the theoretical steady-state characteristic. In practice, the position of the direc-
tional characteristic when using the memorized voltage is dependent on both the source imped-
ance and the load transferred across the line prior to fault inception. If the direction is determined
from the current voltage, the position of the directional characteristic with double infeed and a high
fault resistance is also dependent on both the source impedance and the load transferred across
the line prior to fault inception. Accordingly the directional characteristic includes a safety margin
with respect to the limits of the first quadrant in the R–X diagram. This safety margin is defined by
the parameters Beta () and Gamma (). Normally the default settings of these parameters need
not be changed. For highly loaded overhead contact lines, the use of network calculation software
is recommended to determine the setting values.
Combined Charac- If the distance protection is to have impedance curves with combined characteristic, set address
teristics 113 DISTANCE CURVE=Combined.
For the description of the characteristic parameters in this section, general designations will be
used. Table 2-2 shows the assignment of these designations to the actual parameters of a zone.
The reach of the characteristic is set with the parameter Z. Here you set the absolute value of the
balance point impedance, without taking into account an arc resistance for the zone. For more in-
formation on setting the reach, please refer to margin heading „Grading Coordination Chart“.
The load range is set with the parameters for the minimum load impedance RL and the spread
angle of the load range Alpha (). For more information on setting the load range parameters,
please refer to margin heading „Load Range“.
The safety margins of the directional characteristic are set in the parameters Beta () and
Gamma ( ) (see margin heading „Determination of Direction“).
Note
For all three distance zones to function correctly, the following conditions must imperatively be met
for each characteristic:
<
R < Z cos
R Z cos
– 180°
Polygonal Charac- If the distance protection is to have impedance characteristics with polygonal characteristic, set
teristics address 113 DISTANCE CURVE=Quadrilateral.
For the description of the characteristic parameters in this section, general designations will be
used. Table 2-2 shows the assignment of these designations to the actual parameters of a zone.
The reach of the characteristic is set with the parameter X. Here you set the balance point reac-
tance for the zone. For more information on setting the reach, please refer to margin heading
„Grading Coordination Chart“.
The load range is set with the parameters for the minimum load impedance RL and the spread
angle of the load range Alpha (). For more information on setting the load range parameters,
please refer to margin heading „Load Range“.
The safety margins of the directional characteristic are set in the parameters Beta () and Gamma
(). (see margin heading „Determination of Direction“).
Note
For all three distance zones to function correctly, the following conditions must imperatively be met
for each characteristic:
<
– 180°
R X/tan
Independent Zones The table below shows the assignment of the general characteristic parameters to the concrete
setting values for the independent zones:
Table 2-2 Assignment of setting parameters for the independent zones of the distance pro-
tection
In each zone, different values for reach and minimum load impedance can be set in forward and
reverse direction.
The setting parameters marked with „reverse“ (e.g. Z1 Reverse) are only visible if you have set
„non-directional“ for the distance stage of the corresponding zone.
Dependent Zones These parameters are only available in combination with the auto reclose function, i.e. if you have
set address 133 Auto Reclose to Enabled during the configuration of the functional scope.
For tripping within the first AR cycle, zone Z1B instead of zone Z1 is used. For the second and the
following cycles, zone Z1L is used. Zone Z1 is activated if the AR function is blocked, or in the last
cycle of the AR.
The impedance characteristics for the AR zones Z1B and Z1L must have the same characteristic
type (combined, polygonal) and the same angle parameters (, , ) as zone Z1. Therefore, these
parameters cannot be set for the AR zones. They are normally set to at least 120 % of the line
length. The delay times are set in accordance with the type of application, usually to zero or a very
small delay.
Furthermore, these zones do not have alternative parameters for the reach and the minimum load
impedance (see Table 2-3).
Overreach Zone, If the circuit breaker is manually closed onto a short circuit, the distance protection can issue an
Manual Close instantaneous trip command.
The parameter SOTF zone (address 1232) can be used to determine the zone(s) for which instan-
taneous tripping following manual closing applies. With the setting SOTF zone= PICKUP, tripping
occurs with the zones described above. When the protection trips on closing onto a fault, the in-
dication „Dis TRIP PU MC“ is output. With the setting SOTF zone=Overreach Zone the ZOR zone
is temporarily enabled.
The overreach zone ZOR is a zone which can be activated for a settable time SI Time Man.Cl in
case of a manual closure. This setting of the parameter SI Time Man.Cl (address1150) is only pos-
sible with DIGSI® under Additional Settings (see Subsection 2.1.5.1). This zone is provided for
protection of the entire line by instantaneous tripping. It has therefore the same settings as zone
Z1B.
Table 2-3 Assignment of setting parameters for the dependent zones of the distance protec-
tion
Dependent Parameter Setting Parameter Forwards Setting Parameter Reverse
Zone
Zone Z1B Z Z1B (Addr.1325) Z1B Reverse (Addr.1328)
X1B (Addr.1324) X1B Reverse (Addr.1327)
RL R1B (Addr.1323) R1B Reverse (Addr.1326)
Mode Op. Mode Z1B (Addr.1321*)
Zone Z1L Z Z1L (Addr.1335) Z1L Reverse (Addr. 1338)
X1L (Addr.1334) X1L Reverse (Addr. 1337)
RL R1L (Addr.1333) R1L Reverse (Addr.1336)
Mode Op. Mode Z1L (Addr.1331*)
Overreach Z ZOR (Addr.1384) ZOR Reverse (Addr.1390)
Zone XOR (Addr.1383) XOR Reverse (Addr.1389)
RL ROR (Addr.1382) ROR Reverse (Addr.1388)
Mode Op. Mode ZOR (Addr.1381*)
* please see also section 2.1.4.2
The setting parameters marked with „reverse“ (e.g. Z1B reverse) are only visible if you have set
„non-directional“ for the distance stage of the corresponding zone.
Inrush Blocking If the protection zone of the device includes power transformers, tripping may be caused by the
inrush effect when switching in transmission lines operating at weak load or no load.
With such a constellation, you should activate the blocking of the distance protection by inrush de-
tection. To do so, set under address 2301 Inrush DIS >=Z2=YES. This blocks the zones Z2 and Z3
in case of detection of an inrush.
Startup Stages In highly loaded, long overhead contact lines, the operating currents may be as high as or even
higher than the possible short-circuit currents.
As a result the operating impedances in the backup zones Z2 and Z3 may temporarily be located
within the tripping polygon. The startup stage has the task of distinguishing between operational
events such as startup procedures, and short-circuits.
The zones Z2 and Z3 have each two different grading margins. The grading margins T2K (ad-
dress 1346) and T3K (address 1366) are activated on detection of a short-circuit. These grading
margins must be set according to the grading coordination chart.
The grading margins T2L (address 1347) and T3L (address 1367) are activated in case of an over-
load. These margins must be set according to the overload carrying capacity of the overhead
contact line.
The distinction between an overload and a short-circuit relies on the fact that in case of an over-
load the difference between the phasors of the currently measured current and of the current mea-
sured two cycles ago is much less than in case of a short-circuit. This current difference is defined
by the parameters di/dt Z2 (address 1343) and di/dt Z3 (address 1363) referred to the rated cur-
rent.
The change of the value of the current and the voltage are also taken into consideration for the
decision. For the release of the grading time TxK, the current must increase and the voltage de-
crease.
Set this current rise rate to approx. 10% more than the maximum value occurring in operation. If
you do not want to use this criterion for a particular stage, set „“.
In addition to the current rise rate criterion, voltage dips are used to distinguish between overloads
and short-circuits. The criterion is the difference between the voltage phasors of the currently
measured voltage and the voltage measured two cycles ago.
For the parameters du/dt Z2 (address 1344) and du/dt Z3 (address 1364) a value referred to the
rated voltage must be specified. As soon as one of the set thresholds is exceeded, a short-circuit
is detected. Set this voltage dip rate to approx. 10% more than the maximum value occurring in
operation.
The criterion for the voltage dip rate is only activated when the minimum voltages set in the pa-
rameters Dead VoltThr Z2 (address 1345) and Dead VoltThr Z3 (address 1365) are undershot. Set
here the maximum possible voltage dip for each stage in operation, with a safety margin of approx.
10%.
Calculation example:
15 kV infeed with the following impedance from the infeed point to the location of the voltage trans-
former: Z = (2 + j 7) (corresponds to e.g. 23.5 km Re200 with amplification line one-track at 50
Hz, or 29 km Re330 two-track without return-line cable and amplification line)
From the above values, the following minimum voltage in operation results:
By setting the du/dt or di/dt parameters to 0, the grading margin T2K or T3K is released; at the
same time the timers T2L and T3L are blocked. This blocking is signalled by the indication „Dis.
T2K active“ or „Dis. T3K active“.
By setting the du/dt or di/dt parameters to infinite, the corresponding parts of the short-circuit de-
tection are disabled.
By setting the di/dt and du/dt parameter to " ", the stage T2L (T3L) is always activated. With
another setting than " " the indications "Z2(Z3)di/dt active" or "Z2(Z3)du/dt active" are output.
Note
The setting of ““ is equally possible in DIGSI via “oo“ or directly at the device via “..“.
Teleprotection The teleprotection function can only operate if one of the possible operation modes has been se-
lected during configuration. Depending on the operation mode, only setting-characteristic param-
eters will be displayed. If the teleprotection function is not required set parameter 1250
SigMod=Off.
Wrong Phase Before setting up the WPC-zone, it is necessary to calculate the approximate position of the wrong
Coupling Protec- phase coupling short circuits in the impedance plane. This can be done using Equation (1) see
tion Figure 2-21. The WPC-zone shall be positioned this way that obtained impedances lay roughly in
the middle of the WPC-zone.
2.2.12 Settings
The table indicates region-specific presettings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corre-
sponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
The 7ST6 device has an integrated time overcurrent protection function. This function can be used
as a backup overcurrent protection which works independently of the other protection and moni-
toring functions, including distance protection. The back-up time overcurrent protection could for
instance be used as the only short-circuit protection if the voltage transformers are not yet avail-
able when the feeder is initially commissioned.
General The time overcurrent protection has three stages for each phase current:
• Two overcurrent stages with a definite time characteristic (O/C with DT),
• One overcurrent stage with definite-time or inverse-time characteristic (selectable)
These three stages are independent of each other and are freely combinable. Instantaneous trip-
ping can be set in all stages when the protected line is switched onto a fault. If some stages are
not needed, those not needed can be deactivated by setting the pickup value to .
The time overcurrent protection can be switched on or off by parameter settings, or via binary
inputs. The figure below shows the control logic:
Definite Time Very The current of the overhead contact line are numerically filtered and compared with the setting
High Set Current I>>>. Currents above the associated pickup value are detected and signalled. After expiry of the
Stage I>>> associated time delay T I>>> a trip command is issued. The dropout value is approximately 5 %
less than the pickup value, but at least 1.8 % of the rated current, below the pickup value.
Figure 2-26 Pick-up and tripping logic of the definite time overcurrent stages
Figure 2-26 shows the logic diagram of the definite-time overcurrent stages.
The function block „Switch onto fault“ is common to all stages. The parameter O/C SOTF Trip (ad-
dress 2603) specifies whether instantaneous tripping of this stage via the binary input „>Manual
Close“ (FNo. 356) is possible (YES) or not possible (NO).
Furthermore, all stages can be blocked by the inrush restraint function. This blocking can be
switched on (YES) or off (NO) in the parameter Inrush O/C. A blocking signal generates the indi-
cation „O/C Rush blk“.
Definite Time High- The logic of the high-set current stage I>> is the same as that of the I>>> stage. The two stages
set Current Stage differ only in their parameters for the current threshold and the delay time. The parameter I>> is
I>> used for the current threshold, and the parameter T I>> for the delay time. In all other respects
Figure 2-26 applies.
Definite Time Over- This stage is available if the parameter CURVE O/C is set to Definite Time only. By default this
current Stage I> stage is available. The logic of the time overcurrent stage I> is the same as that of the I>> stage.
The parameter I> is used for the current threshold, and the parameter T I> for the delay time. In
all other respects Figure 2-26 applies.
Inverse-Time Over- The inverse-time overcurrent stage is available if the parameter CURVE O/C is set to TOC ANSI
current Stage Ip or TOC IEC. This parameter is also used to make a preselection of the characteristics available in
the inverse-time overcurrent stage. This stage differs from the definite-time overcurrent stage I>
by its current-dependent delay time characteristic. The delay time of the stage is the delay time
associated with the applied current in the selected characteristic. Selectable characteristics are
shown in the Technical Data in Section 4.3. The pickup current is set in the parameter IP. The
delay time of the characteristic is calculated with the multiplier set in the parameter T IP or D IP.
Like all other stages, the inverse-time overcurrent stage has a logic for switching onto fault and
can be blocked by the inrush restraint feature. A blocking signal generates the indication „O/C
Rush blk“.
The following figure shows the logic diagram. In the configuration notes (Subsection 2.3.2) the dif-
ferent setting addresses are elaborated upon.
Figure 2-27 Pick-up and tripping logic of the inverse time overcurrent stages
Switching onto a The internal line energization detection can be used to achieve quick tripping of the circuit breaker
Fault in case of an earth fault. The time overcurrent protection then issues an instantaneous trip com-
mand.
Pickup Logic and The pickup signals of the individual stages are OR-combined and cause the indication „O/C
Tripping Logic PICKUP“ to be output when one stage picks up.
Likewise, the trip signals of the individual stages are OR-combined. Tripping of one stage causes
the indication „O/C TRIP“ to be output.
General The time overcurrent protection is only effective and accessible if address 126 Back-Up O/C has
been set to during the configuration of the functional scope. If the function is not required, Disabled
is to be set.
In order to be effective, the time overcurrent protection function must also be switched ON in
address 2601 OverCurrent. The time overcurrent protection operates independently of the other
protection functions, i.e. as a backup time overcurrent protection. In address 2601 the time over-
current protection can also be switched OFF.
The I>>> stage (address 2605), the I>> stage (address 2608) and the I> stage (address 2614) to-
gether create a three-stage characteristic.
The very high-set current stage (I>>> stage) and the high-set current stage (I>> stage) operate
always as a definite-time overcurrent protection.
The overcurrent stage (I> stage) may operate either as a definite-time overcurrent protection (ad-
dress 2602 CURVE O/C=Definite Time) or as an time overcurrent protection with current-depen-
dent characteristic (address 2602 CURVE O/C=TOC IEC).
If some stages are not needed, those not needed can be deactivated by setting the pickup value
to . If you set one assigned time stage to , the delay time cannot expire. As a result, the trip
indications are suppressed but not the pickup indications.
In case of switching onto a fault, the protection should trip instantaneously. To do so, set in address
2603 O/C SOTF Trip=YES. If the pickup threshold is exceeded when switching onto a fault, the
delay time set for the function is bypassed, and the time overcurrent protection issues an instan-
taneous trip command.
The time overcurrent protection is blocked by the inrush restraint function if address 2302 Inrush
O/C is set to YES.
Definite Time Very With the parameter I>>> (address 2605) the pickup threshold of the very high set current stage is
High-set Current specified.
Stage I>>>
When using a personal computer and DIGSI® to apply the settings, these can be optionally
entered as primary or secondary values. If secondary quantities are used, all currents must be
converted to the secondary side of the current transformers.
The delay time of the very high set current stage T I>>> is set in address 2606.
The delay set is in addition to the pickup time which does not include the operating time (measur-
ing time).
High-set Current With the parameter I>> (address 2608) the pickup threshold of the high-set current stage is spec-
Stage I>> ified.
When using a personal computer and DIGSI® to apply the settings, these can be optionally
entered as primary or secondary values. If secondary quantities are used, all currents must be
converted to the secondary side of the current transformers.
The delay time of the very high set current stage T I>> is set in address 2609.
The delay set is in addition to the pickup time which does not include the operating time (measur-
ing time).
Overcurrent Stage If the overcurrent stage is to be operated as a definite-time overcurrent protection, address 2602
I> in Definite-time CURVE O/C must be set to Definite Time.
Overcurrent Protec-
For the setting of the current pickup value, I> (address 2614), the maximum operating current is
tion
most decisive. Pickup due to overload should never occur, since the device in this operating mode
operates as fault protection with correspondingly short tripping times and not as overload protec-
tion. Therefore, the pickup value is set to about 20 % above the maximum expected overload.
When using a personal computer and DIGSI® to apply the settings, these can be optionally
entered as primary or secondary values. If secondary quantities are used, all currents must be
converted to the secondary side of the current transformers.
The time delay T I> (address 2615) results from the time grading schedule designed for the net-
work. If implemented as emergency overcurrent protection, shorter tripping times are advisable
(one grading time step above the fast tripping stage), as this function is only activated in the case
of the loss of the local measured voltage.
The delay set is in addition to the pickup time which does not include the operating time (measur-
ing time).
Overcurrent Stage If the overcurrent stage is to be operated as an inverse-time stage with IEC characteristics,
IP in Inverse-time address 2602 CURVE O/C must be set to TOC IEC.
Overcurrent Protec-
With IEC characteristics, the following characteristics are available in address 2611 IEC Curve:
tion with IEC Char-
acteristics Normal Inverse (inverse, type A according to IEC 60255-3),
For the setting of the pickup value IP (address 2617), the following must be observed: Pickup only
occurs at a current which is approximately 10 % above the set value. The dropout threshold is the
setting value.
The time multiplier T IP (address 2618) derives from the time grading schedule set for the network.
Overcurrent Stages If the overcurrent stage is to be operated as an inverse-time stage with ANSI characteristics,
IP in Inverse-time address 2602 CURVE O/C must be set to TOC ANSI.
Overcurrent Protec-
With ANSI characteristics, the following characteristics are available in address 2612 ANSI Curve:
tion with ANSI Char-
acteristics Inverse,
Short Inverse,
Long Inverse,
Moderately Inv.,
Very Inverse,
Definite Inv..
For the setting of the pickup value IP (address 2617), the following must be observed: Pickup only
occurs at a current which is approximately 10 % above the set value. The dropout threshold is the
setting value.
The time multiplier D IP (address 2619) derives from the time grading schedule set for the network.
2.3.3 Settings
The table indicates region-specific presettings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corre-
sponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
In railway networks, close-in faults can lead to very high short-circuit currents. The high-speed
overcurrent protection issues in very short time the trip command to the circuit breaker. This is ad-
vantageous especially with low power system frequencies (long cycles) since it allows to quench
the arc as quickly as possible.
The high-speed overcurrent protection can be switched on or off by parameter settings, or via
binary inputs. The figure below shows the control logic:
Figure 2-28 Control logic of the instantaneous high-speed overcurrent protection function
The instantaneous value of the overhead contact line current, or the sum of the overhead contact
line current and the current of the negative feeder (2.1.3.1), is compared with the setting I HS O/C
(address 2404).
When the settable delay time T HS O/C has expired, a trip command is issued.
The high-speed overcurrent protection has a fixed dropout delay which prevents that the stage
that has picked up drops out at the instant of the current zero crossing before the set delay time
has elapsed.
The figure below shows the pickup/trip logic of the high-speed overcurrent function.
General The high-speed overcurrent protection is only effective and accessible if address 124 FCT HS O/C
has been set to Enabled during the configuration of the functional scope.
In order to be effective, the high-speed overcurrent protection function must also be switched ON
in address 2401 = HS O/C. The high-speed overcurrent protection function works independently
of other protection functions; it is an ancillary function of the distance protection. In address 2401
the function can also be switched OFF.
The high-speed overcurrent protection function normally cooperates with the high-speed relay
outputs BO1 and BO2. Therefore, the trip command from the high-speed overcurrent protection
function („HS O/C TRIP“) is permanently masked to these relay outputs, the indication „HS O/C
TRIP (M)“ (FNo. 13815) is generated. Under address 2408 HS O/C TRIP it can be determined
whether a trip command will be output only to BO1 (single-channel) or to BO1 and BO2 (dual-
channel).
I HS O/C The high-speed overcurrent protection function works with instantaneous values. In auto-trans-
former systems, the summated current of the overhead contact line current and the negative
feeder current will be evaluated.
The threshold I HS O/C (address 2404) is set as an RMS value. The setting value is converted
internally to the peak current value, and used for threshold comparison. Depending on the phase
angle of the voltage on fault inception, the short-circuit current can be superimposed by a decaying
DC component. The peak value of the short-circuit current can be increased at most by the inrush
current factor in comparison to a short-circuit current without offset. In order to prevent that the
high-current instantaneous tripping function picks up in the presence of offset currents with an
RMS value below the set threshold, the setting value I HS O/C (address 2404) must be multiplied
with the inrush current factor . The value thus calculated is the setting value. The least favourable
condition is assumed here, i.e. the RMS value of the expected fault current is multiplied by factor 2.
If the stage is not needed, it can be deactivated by setting the pickup value to .
T HS O/C In address 2405 you set the delay time T HS O/C for enabling the trip condition when the pickup
threshold of the high-speed overcurrent protection function is exceeded.
The delay time T HS O/C takes into account the measuring time and the operating time of the
binary outputs, and thus characterises the actual time between exceeding the threshold and
issuing the binary output signal to BO1 and BO2. For very fast trip command times, this stage is
undelayed, i.e. set to 0.000 s. If the stage is set to , it continues to issue pickup indications, but
the output of trip indications and thus of trip commands is suppressed.
2.4.3 Settings
The table indicates region-specific presettings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corre-
sponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
2.5.1 General
Whereas the distance protection can only function correctly if the measured voltage signals are
available to the device, the emergency overcurrent protection only requires the currents.
The emergency overcurrent protection function is activated automatically, and only if the distance
protection is ineffective (emergency operation). Emergency operation supersedes in this case the
distance protection as a short-circuit protection.
The emergency overcurrent protection is effective if one of the following conditions is fulfilled (see
Figure 2-30):
• Tripping of the voltage transfomer MCB
• Pickup of the internal measuring voltage monitoring, e.g. by a short-circuit or an interruption of
the voltage transformer secondary circuit (see also Section 2.16.3„Fuse Failure Monitor“, in
Section 2.16), or
• Distance protection is switched off or ineffective.
Emergency Over- The emergency overcurrent protection has a time overcurrent stage with current-independent trip
current Protection time. Undelayed tripping can be set when the protected line is switched onto a fault. If the stage
is not needed, it can be disabled (in address 2702).
The current of the overhead contact line, or in auto-transformer systems optionally the summated
overhead contact line current and the negative feeder current, are numerically filtered and com-
pared with the setting I Emerg. O/C.
Currents above the associated pickup value are detected and signalled. After expiry of the asso-
ciated time delay T Emerg. O/C a trip command is issued.
The dropout value is approximately 5 % less than the pickup value, but at least 1.8 % of the rated
current, below the pickup value.
The figure below shows the logic diagram of the emergency overcurrent protection function.
Figure 2-31 Pick-up and tripping logic of the backup O/C protection
General The emergency overcurrent protection is only effective and accessible if address 127 FCT Emerg.
O/C has been set to Enabled during the configuration of the functional scope. If the function is not
required, FCT Emerg. O/C = Disabled is to be set.
In order to be effective, the emergency overcurrent protection function must also be switched ON
in address 2701 Emerg. O/C. The emergency overcurrent protection operates independently of
other protection functions. It is automatically activated when the distance protection is not opera-
tive. In address 2701 the time overcurrent protection can also be switched OFF.
In case of switching onto a fault, the protection should trip instantaneously. To do so, set in address
2702 SOTF Emerg. O/C=YES. If the pickup threshold is exceeded when switching onto a fault, the
delay time set for the function is bypassed, and the emergency overcurrent protection issues an
instantaneous trip command.
The emergency time overcurrent protection can be blocked by the inrush restraint feature if Inrush
O/C BU=YES is set in address 2303. The default setting for this parameter is Inrush O/C BU=.
When the inrush restraint is activated, at least one power system cycle must elapse after fault in-
ception before the pickup signal of the emergency overcurrent protection can be generated.
I Emerg. O/C In address 2705 you specify the pickup threshold I Emerg. O/C of the emergency overcurrent pro-
tection.
When using a personal computer and DIGSI® to apply the settings, these can be optionally
entered as primary or secondary values. If secondary quantities are used, all currents must be
converted to the secondary side of the current transformers.
T Emerg. O/C In address 2706 you set the delay time T Emerg. O/C of the emergency overcurrent protection.
The set times are pure additional delays which do not include the inherent operating time of the
protection.
2.5.4 Settings
The table indicates region-specific presettings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corre-
sponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
Voltage protection has the function to protect electrical equipment against undervoltage and over-
voltage. Both operational states are unfavourable as overvoltage might e.g. cause insulation prob-
lems or undervoltage might cause stability problems.
Both the overvoltage and the undervoltage protection in the 7ST6 use the overhead contact line
voltage U. The voltage protection functions can be combined as desired, and can be separately
switched on and off. Each voltage protection function is two-stage, i.e. it is provided with two
threshold settings each with the appropriate times delay.
Abnormally high voltages often occur e.g. on long overhead contact lines under low load condi-
tions, especially in auto-transformer systems with several auto-transformers along the line, in is-
landed systems when generator voltage regulation fails, or after full load shutdown of a generator
and with the generator disconnected from the system. The undervoltage protection can be ap-
plied, for example, for disconnection or load shedding tasks in a system. Furthermore, this protec-
tion scheme can detect menacing stability problems. With induction machines undervoltages have
an effect on the stability and permissible torque thresholds.
The figure below shows the logic diagram of the overvoltage protection.
With the parameter 3701 OVERVOLTAGE the overvoltage protection can be switched ON or OFF.
The indication „OVER. OFF“ is output when the function is switched on/off. The overvoltage pro-
tection is blocked as soon as the signal „Dis. PICKUP“ is activated.
Both stages of the overvoltage protection have a separately settable grading margin for the TRIP
command of their respective stage.
The figure below shows the logic diagram of the undervoltage protection.
With the parameter 3711 UNDERVOLTAGE the undervoltage protection can be switched ON or
OFF. The indication „UNDER. OFF“ is output when the function is switched on/off.
The undervoltage protection is blocked when at least one of the signals „Dis. PICKUP“ or „Failure
Umeas“ is active. The signal „Failure Umeas“ prevents the undervoltage protection from picking up
when the measuring voltage fails. The undervoltage protection is also blocked when the current
drops below a set threshold of 0.05 In .
The voltage protection can only operate if the parameter O/U VOLTAGE (address 137) has been
set to during the configuration of the functional scope.
Note
For overvoltage protection it is particularly important to observe the setting hints: The overvoltage
level must never be set to less than an undervoltage level. This would put the device immediately
into a state of permanent pickup which cannot be reset by any measured value operation. As a
result, the device would remain out of service!
Overvoltage The overvoltage stages can be switched ON or OFF in address 3701 OVERVOLTAGE. The set-
tings of the voltage threshold and the timer values depend on the type of application.
To detect steady-state overvoltages on long lines carrying no load, set the U> stage (address 3705)
to at least 5 % above the maximum stationary phase-earth voltage expected during operation. Ad-
ditionally, a high dropout to pickup ratio is required (address 3706 U> Reset = 0.95 = presetting).
The delay time T U> (address 3707) should be a few seconds so that overvoltages with short du-
ration may not result in tripping.
The U>> stage (address 3702) is provided for high overvoltages with short duration. Here an ap-
propriately high pickup value is set, e.g. 1.5 times the rated voltage. 0.1 s to 0.2 s are sufficient for
the time delay T U>> (address 3704).
Undervoltage The undervoltage stages can be switched ON or OFF in address 3711 UNDERVOLTAGE. This
undervoltage protection function has two stages.
The U< stage (address 3715) operates with the longer set time T U< (address 3716) for minor un-
dervoltages. It must not be set to more than the undervoltage permissible in operation.
For greater voltage dips, the U<< stage (address 3712) with the delay T U<< (address 3713) takes
effect.
The settings of the voltages and times depend on the application; therefore, general setting rec-
ommendations are not possible. For load shedding, for example, the values are often determined
by a priority grading coordination chart.
In case of stability problems, the permissible undervoltages and their duration must be observed.
With induction machines undervoltages have an effect on the permissible torque thresholds.
If the voltage transformers are located on the line side, the measuring voltages will be missing
when the line is disconnected. In order to ensure that the undervoltage stages do not pick up or
remain picked up in such cases, the undervoltage protection is blocked when the current drops
below a preset threshold of 0.05 In. As soon as a significant current level (I > 0.05 In) is measured
on the line, the line is assumed to be energized, and the blocking of the undervoltage protection
is reset.
2.6.4 Settings
The thermal overload protection prevents damage to the overhead contact line caused by thermal
overloading. It is based on the principle of creating a thermal model of the overhead contact line
on the basis of the current load and the ambient temperature. Where no ambient temperature
sensing is provided, a fixed value can be used instead of an ambient temperature measurement.
General The thermal overload protection can be switched on or off by parameter settings, or via binary
inputs. The figure below shows the control logic:
When overload protection is disabled, the thermal replica will also be reset.
The device calculates the overtemperature in accordance with a single-body thermal model,
based on the following differential equation:
with
CHANGE TO CAT – Parameter for catenary changeover; used for modifying the
characteristic where there is more than one contact line
The solution of this equation is in steady-state operation an e-function whose asymptote rep-
resents the final temperature T Rise. The overtemperature is proportional to the square of the
contact line current. When the overtemperature reaches the first settable temperature threshold
TEMP ALARM, which is below the overtemperature = tripping overtemperature, a warning alarm
is given in order to allow a preventive load reduction. When the second temperature threshold, i.e.
the final overtemperature or tripping temperature, is reached, the protected object is disconnected
from the network. Reclosing is prevented until the temperature has dropped again below TEMP
CLOSE. The figure below shows the pickup and trip logic of the overload protection.
The ambient temperature is taken only once per substation with a separate device that has its
own, galvanically separated power supply and its own housing. A Pt100 temperature sensor is
used for this purpose. This device delivers at its output a load-independent current (4-20 mA TD
input) which can be looped through up to 20 connected 7ST6 devices via an isolating amplifier.
The ambient temperature sensing feature is available for the temperature ranges between -30°C
and +55°C and between -55° and +55°C.
A failure of the ambient temperature sensing, e.g. because of a wire break of the Pt100 sensor, a
defective device or a voltage failure, is detected by the main protection equipment by comparison
with defined current values in the current loop.
After each update of the ambient temperature sensing, the device checks whether the current is
in the permissible operating range. If this is not the case, a malfunction of the ambient temperature
sensing is assumed, and the last valid ambient temperature is kept. In addition, the indication
„Fail.TEMPSENS“ (FNo. 158) is output.
If the ambient temperature sensing is already disturbed on power-up of the protection relay, the
ambient temperature set at address 4215 AMB.TEMP. is used for the calculation, and the indica-
tion „Fail.TEMPSENS“ (FNo. 158) is output, too.
The parameter MIN TEMP PRESET (address 4216) is provided for line sections where the tem-
perature is higher than at the location of the ambient temperature sensing (e.g. tunnels in winter:
ambient temperature = -15°C, tunnel temperature = 8°C). In such a case, a lower threshold must
be set for the used ambient temperature (e.g. MIN TEMP PRESET= 8°C).
Where the continuous current carrying capacity of the catenary assembly depends on the switch-
ing state, the current carrying capacity of up to 3 different switching states can be processed.
The thermal model can be matched to the current switching state by parameter settings, by the
control system or through the system interface.
The active control source for this changeover is selected with the parameter 4202 CAT
CHANGEOVER; setting options are Binary Input, Protocol, Setting or Blocked.
The control sources Binary Input and Protocol can continue to be operated, even if they are not
activated. However, the catenary factor - CAT1, CAT2 or CAT3 - set in this way will not take effect
until the associated control source is selected again (see logic diagram 2-37).
For a changeover via Protocol, the commands 13827 to 13829 „O/C Cat1/2/3ON“ are provided.
With the setting Binary Input, changeover between the catenaries CAT1, CAT2 and CAT3 is per-
formed using the binary input indications „>Cat.1 active“ (FNo. 6605), „>Cat.2 active“ (FNo. 6604)
and „>Cat.3 active“ (FNo. 6603). The binary inputs can also be used for changeover with the
setting Protocol, if the binary input „>Ctrl Select.“ (FNo. 365) „>Select: Control by BI or SYS inter-
face“ is activated.
With the setting Setting the changeover is performed with the parameter 4210 CHANGE TO CAT.
This parameter is masked out when another control source is selected. If CHANGE TO CAT =
CAT1 active, the catenary factor „1“ (for 1 catenary) is assumed. With CHANGE TO CAT = CAT2
active or CHANGE TO CAT = CAT3 active, the factor set in parameter 4211 CAT2 or 4212 CAT3
applies.
The figure below shows the control logic of the catenary changeover:
General A prerequisite for the application of the thermal overload function is that during the configuration
of the functional scope in address 142 Therm.Overload = Enabled was set. The function can be
turned ON or OFF in address 4201 Ther. OVER LOAD.
When overload protection is disabled, the thermal replica will also be reset.
Time Constant The thermal time constant is set at address 4203 TAU. This is also provided by the manufacturer.
Please note that the time constant must be set in minutes. Quite often other values for determining
the time constant are stated which can be converted into the time constant as follows:
Example:
Permissible current for application time other than 1 s, e.g. for 0.5 s
Limit Current The limit current factor is set in address 4204 k ITRise. It is determined by the relation between the
Factor k ITRise permissible thermal continuous current and this rated current:
The permissible continuous current is at the same time the current at which the e-function of the
overtemperature has its asymptote. Manufacturers of electrical machines usually state the permis-
sible continuous current. If no data are available, k ITRise is set to 1.2 times the rated current of
the protected object. For conducting lines, the permissible continuous current depends on the
cross section, the insulation material, the design and the way they are laid, and can be derived
from the relevant tables. Please note that the overload capability of electrical equipment relates to
its primary current. This has to be considered if the primary current differs from the rated current
of the current transformers.
Example:
Temperature Limits In address 4207 TEMP ALARM the temperature threshold for the thermal alarm stage is set.
When the set temperature threshold is exceeded, an alarm is output that can be used for automat-
ic functions or for logging.
In address 4209 O/L Stage 2 is set, if a second alarm is output on reaching the second temperature
threshold or if the protected device is disconnected from the network. The temperature threshold
for the second thermal stage is set in address 4206 TEMP TRIP/WARN2.
Note
The second temperature stage TEMP TRIP/WARN2 (address 4206) must always be set higher
than the thermal alarm stage TEMP ALARM (address 4207)!
In address 4208 TEMP CLOSE the closing temperature is set. If the contact line was tripped by
the thermal overload protection, the line is reclosed as soon as the temperature drops below the
value TEMP CLOSE set here, provided that the thermal automatic reclosure function is activated
(address 3450 AUTO-TH-AR = ON, see Section 2.12).
Catenary Change- In address 4202 CAT CHANGEOVER you select the control source for catenary changeover. Cat-
over enary changeover is possible via binary input, via protocol or via parameters.
Ambient Tempera- If ambient temperature sensing is not configured, or disturbed when the protection is switched on,
ture Sensing a fixed value is specified in address 4215 AMB.TEMP. instead of the measured ambient tempera-
ture (see Section 2.1.1.2). The set AMB.TEMP. is then used for calculating the overhead contact
line temperature.
In address 4216 MIN TEMP PRESET a lower limit is set for the ambient temperature used for cal-
culating the overhead contact line temperature. If you set MIN TEMP PRESET=, the parameter
is ineffective.
With the internal input indication (tag) „ResetThermRepl“ (FNo. 13826) the temperature model can
be reset. A reset of the temperature model is equivalent to setting the contact line temperature to
ambient temperature.
2.7.5 Settings
The circuit breaker failure protection provides rapid back-up fault clearance, in the event that the
circuit breaker fails to respond to a trip command from a protective function of the local circuit
breaker.
General Whenever a protection function issues a trip command to the circuit breaker, this is simultaneous
sent to the breaker failure protection (Figure 2-38). The breaker failure protection consists of two
stages. Two time stages tBF1 (address 3904) and tBF2 (address 3905) are started in it. The timers
run as long as a trip command is present and current continues to flow through the breaker poles.
Figure 2-38 Simplified function diagram of circuit breaker failure protection with current flow
monitoring
Normally, the breaker will open and interrupt the fault current. The current monitoring stage quickly
resets (typically 1/2 cycle of the power system frequency) and stops the timers tBF1 (address
3904) and tBF2 (address 3905).
If the trip command is not carried out (breaker failure case), current continues to flow. When the
delay time for the backup trip element tBF1 (address 3904) has elapsed, a TRIP command for the
backup trip element is generated. If this TRIP command, also, fails to interrupt the short-circuit cur-
rent, the breaker failure protection issues a further TRIP command to the higher-level circuit
breakers after the delay time tBF2 (address 3905) has elapsed.
The reset time of the feeder protection is not relevant because the breaker failure protection itself
recognizes the interruption of the current.
Current Flow Moni- The current detected by the device is filtered by numerical filters so that only the fundamental
toring wave is evaluated.
Special features recognize the instant of current interruption. With sinusoidal currents, the current
interruption is recognized after approx. half a cycle of the power system frequency. With aperiodic
DC current components in the fault current and/or in the current transformer secondary circuit after
interruption (e.g. current transformers with linearized core), or saturation of the current transform-
ers caused by the DC component in the fault current, it can take one AC cycle before the interrup-
tion of the primary current is reliably detected.
Initiation If the breaker failure protection is intended to be initiated by further external protection devices, it
is recommended, for security reasons, to connect two starting criteria to the device. Therefore, the
trip command of the external protection should not be directly connected to the binary input
„>BrkFail extSRC“ (FNo. 1431). For such an application, create a CFC chart, combine in this chart
the general device pickup and the trip command of the external protection by an AND gate and
wire the output of that gate to the signal „>BrkFail extSRC“ (FNo. 1431).
Nevertheless, it is possible to initiate the breaker failure protection in single-channel mode should
a separate release criterion not be available.
When the trip signal appears from any internal or external feeder protection and the current flow
criterion (according to Figure 2-38) is present, the breaker failure protection is initiated and the cor-
responding delay times are started.
The figure below shows the control logic of the circuit breaker failure protection.
Figure 2-39 Pick-up and tripping logic of the breaker failure protection
Delay Times When the initiate conditions are fulfilled, the associated timers tBF1 (address 3904) and tBF2 (ad-
dress 3905) are started. The circuit breaker pole(s) must open before the associated time has
elapsed. The device detects that the circuit breaker has opened when the current drops below the
dropout threshold I> BF (address 3902).
With two-stage breaker failure protection, the trip command of the overhead contact line protection
is usually repeated, after a first time stage, to the feeder circuit breaker, often via a second trip coil
or set of trip coils, if the breaker has not responded to the original trip command. The signal 1471
„BrkFailure TRIP“ is provided for this trip command repetition. A second time stage monitors the
response to this repeated trip command and trips the breakers of the relevant bus-bar section with
the signal 1484 „B/F s.ordProt“, if the fault has not yet been cleared after this second time.
General The breaker failure protection can only operate if it has been set as Enabled during configuration
of the functional scope (address 139 BREAKER FAILURE).
Circuit Breaker The breaker failure protection is switched ON or OFF at address 3901 FCT BreakerFail.
Failure Protection
The current threshold I> BF (address 3902) should be selected such that the protection will
operate with the smallest expected short-circuit current. A setting of 10% below the minimum fault
current for which breaker failure protection must operate is recommended. On the other hand, the
value should not be set lower than necessary.
Single-stage With single-stage operation, the adjacent circuit breakers (i.e. the breakers of the busbar zone
Breaker Failure Pro- and, if applicable, the breaker at the remote end) are tripped after a delay time tBF2 (address 3905)
tection following initiation, should the fault not have been cleared within this time.
The timer tBF1 (address 3904) is set to in this case, as it is not needed.
You can also use the first stage as the only one. In that case you have to set the time tBF1 (ad-
dress 3904). Set tBF2 (address 3905) to or equal to tBF1 (address 3904). Be sure that the correct
trip commands are assigned to the desired trip relay(s).
The delay times are determined from the maximum operating time of the feeder circuit breaker,
the reset time of the current detectors of the breaker failure protection, plus a safety margin which
allows for any tolerance of the delay timers. The time sequence is illustrated in Figure 2-40. For
sinusoidal currents, the dropout time can be assumed to be less than 3/4 the cycle duration at
rated frequency. If current transformer saturation is anticipated, the time should be set to 1.5 ms.
Figure 2-40 Time sequence example for single-stage breaker failure protection
Two-stage Breaker With two-stage operation, the trip command is repeated after a time delay tBF1 (address 3904) to
Failure Protection the local feeder breaker, normally to a different set of trip coils of this breaker.
If the circuit breaker does not respond to the repeated trip command, the protection trips after a
second delay time tBF2 (address 3905) the adjacent circuit breakers, i.e. those of the busbar or
the affected busbar section and, if necessary, also the circuit breaker at the remote end, if the fault
is not yet eliminated.
The delay times are determined from the maximum operating time of the feeder circuit breaker,
the reset time of the current detectors of the breaker failure protection, plus a safety margin which
allows for any tolerance of the delay timers. The time sequence is illustrated in Figure 2-41. For
sinusoidal currents, the dropout time can be assumed to be less than 3/4 the cycle duration at
rated frequency. If current transformer saturation is anticipated, the time should be set to 1.5 ms.
Figure 2-41 Time sequence example for two-stage breaker failure protection
2.8.3 Settings
The table indicates region-specific presettings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corre-
sponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
The trip supervision function checks whether the circuit breaker has tripped correctly in case of an
external trip or a trip command by an additional current flow monitoring.
After the circuit breaker has tripped, the device checks that no current flows, or only a current
below a certain threshold, once the supervision time has elapsed.
To start this supervision, the TRIP command is detected at the circuit breaker. This command must
be configured to the signal „>Ext. CB Trip“ (FNo.1438).
The maximum duration of the supervision can be set with the parameter T I> CB MAX at address
2922.
If the current flow has not been interrupted 100 ms after a TRIP command has been detected, the
indication „CB Fault“ (FNo. 1491) is output.
This indication is reset before the set supervision has elapsed if the device detects that the current
flow has been interrupted, or if the signal „>Ext. CB Trip“ (FNo.1438) indicates that the external
TRIP signal has been reset.
When this threshold, which is set with the parameter I> CB (address: 2921), is undershot, the
current flow is considered to be interrupted.
The measuring function works with an intelligent method for fast detection of a current interruption.
If the current signal contains decaying aperiodic components caused by the current transformers,
these components are identified as such, and the current interruption is detected.
The figure below shows the logic diagram of the circuit breaker trip supervision.
General The circuit breaker trip supervision is one of the basic functions of the 7ST6 device. This function
cannot be disabled by a configuration parameter.
To activate the function, the indication „>Ext. CB Trip“ (FNo. 1438) must be configured to a binary
input, and this binary input must be connected with the TRIP command of the circuit breaker to be
monitored.
Current Interruption The interruption of the current flow is monitored by a current threshold I> CB (address 2921). Set
this current threshold to a value that is lower than the pickup values of all overcurrent functions.
Supervision Dura- The maximum duration of the trip supervision is set with parameter T I> CB MAX in address 2922.
tion The supervision duration begins on activation of the signal „>Ext. CB Trip“ (FNo.1438).
After the set supervision time T I> CB MAX has elapsed, a signal generated by the trip supervi-
sion „CB Fault“ (FNo.1491) is reset.
2.9.3 Settings
The table indicates region-specific presettings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corre-
sponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
In some models of the 7ST6 device, the basic variant is equipped with the defrosting protection
(3xI, 3xU).
In order to remove icing from overhead contact line systems, unused lines are series-connected
(by the operator) and heated with a low current, if necessary with an interposed resistor.
For sensitive detection of short-circuits during the defrosting, the current flowing into the line and
back are measured in the protection device and processed by a differential protection function.
The differential protection protects 100% of the measuring range.
The characteristic curve of the differential protection can be parameterized. As a backup protec-
tion of the differential protection, a two-stage definite-time overcurrent protection is provided that
monitors the defrosting current.
General
Note
During defrosting, the overhead contact line is in a special switching state. All other protection
functions remain active when the defrosting protection is switched on. The defrosting current can
cause spurious tripping by one or more protection functions (e.g. by the overvoltage protection or
a back-up stage of the distance protection). In such cases, these protection functions must be de-
activated prior to activating the defrosting protection, or to switching on the defrosting current. Use
for this purpose e.g. the settings group change option via a binary input or via the system interface.
In defrosting mode, the overhead contact line must be put into a special switching state. An
example of such a switching state is shown in Figure 2-43. The breakers Q0 (overhead contact
line 1), Q11 and Q9 are closed, breaker Q0 (overhead contact line 2) is open.
Figure 2-43 Simplified operation scheme of the defrosting protection operating on the differen-
tial current principle
In addition to the current transformer in the infeed of the overhead contact line I , which is shared
with the other protection functions, another current transformer is needed for the defrosting current
flowing back. This transformer is connected to the Ix input.
Note
In auto-transformer systems, the negative feeder current IF- is measured as well. If the negative
feeder has its own current transformer, this current need not be considered, as the current IF- is
very low in the special defrosting switching state.
Protection Principle The defrosting protection operates on the differential protection principle. This principle says that
the phases and amplitudes of both measured currents are the same in fault-free condition. The
condition i(t) + ix(t) = 0 is always fulfilled in fault-free condition of the line.
Since different CTs may be used for detection of the currents i(t) and ix(t), such differences must
be taken into account for the calculations. The measured current ix(t) is adapted to the conditions
of i(t) as follows:
where:
and
Due to measuring errors, the condition i(t) + ix(t) = 0 is not wholly fulfilled in fault-free condition.
Therefore, a value greater than zero must be used as tripping threshold. With a high load current,
the differential current is higher than with a low load current. Therefore, a load-dependent tripping
threshold is required. The restraint current is then calculated as follows:
The restraint current is a measure of the current load. The pickup threshold is interpreted as a
function of the restraint current.
From the measured currents, the differential current is determined with the following formula:
Characteristic The pickup criterion is the location of the current operating point in the Id/Is level. A pickup situa-
tion exists if the fault is located above the characteristic shown in Figure 2-44.
k Characteristic slope
The knee-point of the characteristic is determined by the parameters k and Id>. The value for Id>
results from shunt currents which are independent of the defrosting current, and which can occur
in fault-free condition. Such currents can be caused by capacitive leakage currents, or by the mag-
netizing currents of power transformers located upstream of the protected zone. The slope k to be
set results from possible amplitude or angle errors of the current transformers used.
Switching On/Off The defrosting protection can be switched on/off via parameters, binary input or the protocol of the
and Blocking system interface.
Also, the defrosting protection can be dynamically blocked via binary input or via protocol. The
figure below shows the control logic:
Pickup and TRIP A fault detected on the basis of the differential protection characteristic is signalled as a pickup if
Command the defrosting protection is switched on. The pickup is signalled with the indication „Defrost
PICKUP“, and the TRIP command „Defrost TRIP“ is output after the delay time T ID> if the pickup
condition is still present and the defrosting protection is not blocked. The delay time allows to
bridge transient compensation states which occur on switching in the defrosting current, and
which might for a short time cause a pickup of the defrosting current.
Definite-time The defrosting protection is provided with a two-stage definite-time overcurrent protection as
Backup Time Over- backup protection. This backup protection is switched on and off together with the differential pro-
current Protection tection. The stages operate with the fundamental wave component of the defrosting current I. The
stages generate separate indications for pickup and tripping. The figure below shows the logic
diagram of the back-up protection.
Figure 2-47 Pick-up and tripping logic of the backup O/C protection of the defrosting protection
Operational Mea- In some models (3xI, 3xU) the defrosting current Ix is always displayed as an operational mea-
sured Values sured value. It can be shown as a primary, secondary or percent value.
If the defrosting protection is configured, the differential current „Id =“ (FNo. 13968) calculated by
the differential protection, and the restraint current „Ir =“ (FNo. 13969) can be displayed as
percent values.
Fault Recording In some models (3xI, 3xU) the defrosting current Ix is always recorded by the fault recording func-
tion.
If the defrosting protection is configured, the current Ix and the internally calculated currents „Id
=“ (differential current) and „Ir =“ (restraint current) are also recorded by the fault recording func-
tion.
Preconditions When setting the general power system data (Power System Data 1, refer to Section 2.1.3.1) a
number of parameters regarding the measured quantities and the operating mode of the defrost-
ing protection function must be applied.
General The defrosting operation can only operate if address 144 FCT DEFROSTING has been set to
Enabled and the parameter Defrosting is set to ON (address 4301).
The measured values of the differential current „Id =“ and the restraint current „Ir =“ are only
available or will only be calculated if the defrosting parameter Defrosting (address 4301) has been
set to ON.
The defrosting protection can be switched on or off via the binary inputs „>Defrost ON“ (FNo.
13960) and „>Defrost OFF“ (FNo. 13961), or via the system interface. For control via the system
interface, the internal single-point indication „Defrost ON“ (FNo. 13963) is used.
Blocking There are various possibilities for blocking the defrosting protection. If the protection is blocked,
only the TRIP indication „Diff TRIP“ (Fno. 13975) will be blocked. All other indications are output
as before.
The defrosting protection can be blocked locally from the operator panel, using the binary input or
system interface.
For blocking via the system interface or the operator panel, the internal single-point indication
„Defrost block“ (FNo. 13978) is used. For blocking via a binary input, the signal „>BLOCK Defrost“
(FNo. 13962) must be configured to the appropriate binary input.
If defrosting has been blocked from more than one source, the blocking must be reset from all
sources to become ineffective again. When the defrosting protection is blocked, the indication
„Defrost blk“ (FNo. 13965) is output.
Differential Protec- For the differential protection, you must set as pickup current the differential current Id, which is
tion permanently present in normal service. The pickup current 4302 ID> is set somewhat higher (ap-
prox. 20 %) than the maximum differential current Id that is to be expected in normal service.
Note
For the setting of the pickup current, the setting of the differential protection delay must be taken
into account. If the delay of the TRIP signal for the differential protection is set in such a way that
transient states occurring on switching on the defrosting current have not yet entirely decayed, the
pickup current must be set to approx. 10 % more than the maximum transient current that is pos-
sible at this moment.
The slope 4304 k to be set results from possible amplitude or angle errors of the current transform-
ers used.
The trip delay time following a pickup 4303 T ID> is set in such a way that transient states on
switching on the defrosting current have completely decayed after that time. Typical values for
these decay times are about 200 ms. This time constant is reduced by resistances in the current
path.
Backup Protection The backup protection of the defrosting protection function has two definite-time overcurrent
stages. The high-current stage is set to approx. 10 % more than the transient current that is to be
expected when switching on the defrosting current. This current is set at address 4306 IX>>. The
delay of the stage is set at address 4307 T IX>> without delay, or with a short delay of approx.
100 ms.
The pickup value of the overcurrent stage is set at address 4308 IX> to approx. 10 % more than
the expected continuous defrosting current. The delay of the overcurrent stage is set to approx.
100 ms more than the decay times of the transient states that occur when switching on the de-
frosting current.
2.10.3 Settings
The table indicates region-specific presettings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corre-
sponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
When switching in equipment, especially transformers operating at weak load or no load, high
inrush currents may briefly occur which can cause unwanted pickup of protection functions. The
inrush restraint feature allows to recognize such startup conditions. The functions provides signals
that block the protection functions, in order to prevent overfunctioning when switching in trans-
formers.
When switching in transformers, high inrush currents occur, which may amount to a multiple of the
rated transformer current, depending on the switch on moment.
Although the fundamental current is evaluated by filtering of the measured current, overfunction-
ing during energization of the transformer may result if very short delay times are set. In the inrush
current there is a substantial portion of fundamental current depending on the type and size of the
transformer that is being energized.
The inrush restraint function generates an indication „INRUSH detected“ for as long as the inrush
currents persists. This indication informs you that the inrush restraint feature has detected an
inrush current.
With the parameters Inrush DIS >=Z2, Inrush O/C and Inrush O/C BU the blocking of the respec-
tive protection functions can be switched on and off. The figure below shows the logic diagram for
the inrush restraint.
Inrush current contains a relatively large second harmonic component (twice the nominal frequen-
cy) which is nearly absent during a fault current. Numerical filters that carry out a Fourier analysis
of the current are used for the frequency analysis.
As soon as the harmonics content exceeds the value set in 2nd HARM.BLOCK, an inrush current
is detected.
With the parameter Imax InrushRest a maximum current amplitude for using this criterion can be
specified. Above this current amplitude, the detection of inrush currents on the basis of the second
harmonics is blocked. This blocking prevents that the inrush detection feature responds in case of
transformer saturation since transformer saturation, also, causes a large proportion of second har-
monics in the current signal.
The inrush restraint is only necessary if the device is to be used on transformer feeders or on over-
head contact lines in an auto-transformer system. Even in those applications, the inrush restraint
is only needed for protection functions which the inrush current might cause to trip.
Such protection functions are the time overcurrent protection and the distance protection.
With the parameters Inrush DIS >=Z2 (address 2301), Inrush O/C (address 2302) and Inrush O/C
BU (address 2303), the inrush restraint can be set for each protection function separately to YES
(effective) or NO (inrush restraint ineffective). If the inrush restraint has been disabled for all func-
tions, the following parameters are of no consequence.
For the recognition of the inrush current, the portion of second harmonic current content referred
to the fundamental current component can be set in address 2305 2nd HARM.BLOCK. Above this
threshold the inrush blocking is effective. The preset value (15 %) should be sufficient in most
cases. Lower values imply higher sensitivity of the inrush blocking (smaller portion of second har-
monic current results in blocking).
In applications on transformer feeders or overhead contact lines that are terminated on transform-
ers it may be assumed that, if very large currents occur, a short circuit has occurred in front of the
transformer. In the event of such large currents, the inrush restraint is inhibited. This threshold
value which is set in the address 2306 Imax InrushRest, should be larger than the maximum ex-
pected inrush current (RMS value).
In the parameter 2307 SI Time INRUSH the action time of the inrush detection can be specified.
When this time has elapsed, the blocking of protection functions by the inrush restraint feature is
reset, regardless of the second harmonics content of the current.
The indication „INRUSH detected“ signals that an inrush has been detected. This indication can
also be used to block external protection devices during the inrush phase if these external devices
do not have an inrush restraint feature of their own.
2.11.3 Settings
The table indicates region-specific presettings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corre-
sponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
Experience shows that about 85% of the arc faults on overhead contact lines are extinguished au-
tomatically after being tripped by the protection. This means that the line can be connected again.
Reclosure is performed by an automatic reclose function (AR).
The number and length of the reclosure cycles can be set as required by power system conditions.
The actual reclosure happens after the dead time has expired. If the fault still exists after automatic
reclosure (arc has not disappeared, there is a metallic fault), then the auto reclose function will
attempt another reclosure after the repeated TRIP command by one of the protection functions.
The number of reclosure attempts can be set. Ideally, the auto reclose function ends with a suc-
cessful reconnection of the line. If the fault is still present after the configured maximum number
of reclosure attempts, the line is definitely disconnected from the power system. The auto reclose
function goes into the blocked state and signals that the last TRIP command was final.
The auto reclose function can also be started by the thermal overload protection. This protection
prevents thermal overload of the overhead contact line and trips as soon as a threshold tempera-
ture is reached. After cooling off, the line can be reconnected by means of the auto reclose func-
tion.
It is also possible to control the integrated auto reclose function by an external protection device
(e.g. a backup protection). The use of two 7ST6 with auto-reclosure or the use of one 7ST6 with
auto-reclosure and a second protection with its own auto-reclosure are equally possible.
Reclosure is performed by an automatic reclosure circuit (ARC). An example of the normal time
sequence of a double reclosure is shown in the figure below.
Figure 2-49 Timing diagram of a double-shot reclosure with action time (2nd reclosure successful)
The integrated auto reclose function allows up to 8 reclosure attempts. The first two interrupt
cycles may operate with different parameters for action and dead times. The parameters of the
second cycle also apply for the third cycle and onwards.
Selectivity before In order for the automatic reclosure to be successful, all faults on the entire overhead line must be
Reclosure cleared at all line ends simultaneously — as fast as possible. In the distance protection, for exam-
ple, the overreach zone Z1B may be released before the first reclosure. This implies that faults up
to the zone reach limit of Z1B are tripped without delay for the first cycle. A limited unselectivity in
favour of fast simultaneous tripping is accepted here because a reclosure will be performed in any
case. The normal stages of the distance protection (Z1, Z2, etc.) and the normal grading of the
other short-circuit functions are independent of the automatic reclosure function. Figure 2-50
applies for one reclosure cycle.
Figure 2-50 Reach control before first reclosure, using distance protection
The internal auto reclose function determines whether the overreach zone (Z1B for distance pro-
tection) will be decisive for fast tripping. If no reclosure is expected (e.g. circuit-breaker not ready)
the normal grading of the distance protection (i.e. fast tripping only for faults in zone Z1) must
apply to retain selectivity.
If restart in a higher stage is permitted, the auto reclose function can also be used for the back-up
zones. The zone Z1L can in that case be used as an overreaching stage for zone Z2.
If the auto reclose function is only to be used for the overhead contact line that is directly allocated
to the 7ST6 device, the reach of zone Z1L can be set in the same way as the reach of zone Z1B.
Zone Release for In the initial state, with the distance protection switched on and the auto reclose function operative,
the Distance Pro- zone Z1B is released. If the distance protection is switched off or the auto reclose function is not
tection operative, zone Z1 is released.
Before the 2nd reclosure cycle, the enable for zone Z1B is reset after the dead time has expired,
and the enable for zone Z1L is set with start of the blocking time and the CLOSE command.
The pickup starts all action times which are enabled for initiation. When the 1st action time has
expired but the 2nd action time is still running, the zone enabling switches from Z1B to Z1L.
An exception to this is the last reclosure cycle. If all reclosure attempts were unsuccessful, zone
Z1 is enabled prior to the last configured reclosure cycle.
Initiation Initiation of the auto reclose function means storing the first trip signal during a network fault that
was generated by a protection function which operates with the auto reclose function. In case of
multiple reclosure, initiation therefore only takes place once with the first trip command. The de-
tection of the actual circuit breaker position is necessary for the correct functionality of the auto
reclose function.
The initiation is important when the first trip command has not appeared before expiry of an action
time (see margin heading „Action Times, Operating Mode“).
The auto reclose function can be set in such a way that it is only started if the circuit breaker is
ready for at least one TRIP-CLOSE-TRIP cycle when the first trip command is issued (see also
margin heading “Interrogation of Circuit Breaker Ready State“).
For the distance protection and the high-speed overcurrent protection, the user can configure by
parameter settings whether they will cooperate with the auto reclose function or not, i.e. if they will
be able to start the automatic reclosure or not. Starting of the auto reclose function by the thermal
overload protection can also be switched on and off by parameter settings.
The same applies to the trip commands coupled in externally via binary input and/or the trip com-
mands generated by the teleprotection via permissive or intertrip signals.
Action Times It is often desirable to neutralize the ready–for–reclosure–state if the short-circuit condition was
sustained for a certain time, e.g. because it is assumed that the arc has burned in to such an extent
that there is no longer any chance of automatic arc extinction during the reclose dead time. For
reasons of selectivity also (see above), frequently faults with delayed trip should not lead to reclo-
sure.
For the auto reclose function of the 7ST6, one action time can be set for the 1st cycle and one for
the 2nd to 8th cycle.
The action times are always started by the general starting signal (with logic OR combination of
all internal and external protection functions which can start the auto reclose function). If no trip
command is present before the action time expires, the corresponding reclosure cycle is not
carried out.
The user can set separately for the 1st reclosure cycle and the 2nd to 8th cycle whether they are
allowed to be the first cycle. Following the first general pickup, only the action times of those cycles
that are set such that they may start off the recloser are considered since the other cycles are not
allowed to be the first cycle under any circumstances. Using the action times and the start permis-
sion you can control which cycles can be run under different command time conditions.
Example 1: 3 cycles are set. Starting of the auto-reclosure is allowed for at least the first cycle.
The action times are set as follows:
• 1st reclosure: T Action = 0.2 s
• From the 2nd reclosure: T Action = 1 s
Since reclosure is ready before the fault occurs, the first trip of a time overcurrent protection fol-
lowing a fault is fast, i.e. before the end of any action time. The auto reclose function is started as
a result. After unsuccessful reclosure the 2nd cycle would then become active; but the time over-
current protection will not trip in this example until after 0.6 s according to its grading time. The 3rd
cycle with its parameters is therefore now executed. If the trip command appeared more than 1.2
s after the 1st reclosure, there would be no further reclosure.
Example 2: 3 cycles are set. Initiation of the auto-reclosure is only allowed for the first. The action
times are set as in example 1. The first protection trip takes place 0.5 s after pickup. Since the
action time for the 1st cycle has already expired at this time, this cannot start the auto reclose func-
tion. However, the 2nd and 3rd cycles cannot take place because they are not set to initiate. There
is therefore no reclosure, because no initiating at all can take place.
Example 3: 3 cycles are set. Starting of the auto-reclosure is allowed for at least the first two
cycles. The action times are set as in example 1. The first protection trip takes place 0.5 s after
pick-up. Since the action time for the 1st cycle has already expired at this time, it cannot start the
automatic reclosure function but the 2nd cycle, for which initiating is allowed, is activated immedi-
ately. This 2nd cycle therefore starts the automatic reclosure circuit, the 1st cycle is practically
skipped.
Reclosure Block Different events lead to blocking of automatic reclosure. No reclosure is possible for example if it
is blocked via a binary input. If the automatic reclosure has not yet been started, it cannot be
started at all. If a reclosure cycle is already in progress, dynamic blocking takes place (see below).
The first or the other cycles of the auto reclose function can also be blocked separately via a binary
input. In this case the cycle or cycles concerned will be declared as invalid, and skipped in the
sequence of permissible cycles. If blocking takes place while the cycle concerned is already run-
ning, this leads to aborting of the reclosure, i.e. no reclosure takes place even if other valid cycles
have been parameterized.
Internal blocking states restricted to certain time periods are processed during the course of reclo-
sure cycles:
The reclaim time TIME RESTRAINT begins with every automatic reclosure command. If the re-
closure is successful, all the functions of the automatic reclosure return to the idle state at the end
of the reclaim time; a fault after expiry of the reclaim time is treated as a new fault in the power
system. If one of the protection functions causes another trip during that period, the next reclosure
cycle will be started if repeated reclosure has been set. If no more reclosure attempts are permit-
ted, the last reclosure is regarded as unsuccessful in case of another trip during the blocking time.
The automatic reclosure is locked out dynamically.
The dynamic blocking locks the reclosure for the duration of the dynamic blocking time (0.5 s).
This occurs for example after a final tripping or other events which block the auto reclose function
after it has been started. Restarting is blocked for this time. When this time has expired, the auto-
matic reclosure returns to its idle position and is ready to process a new fault in the network.
If the circuit breaker is closed manually (by the control discrepancy switch connected to a binary
input, the local control functions or via one of the serial interfaces), the auto reclose function is
blocked for a manual-close-blocking time T-BLOCK MC. When a trip command is given during
this time, it can be assumed that a metallic short-circuit is present (e.g. closed earthing isolator).
Every trip command within this time is therefore final. With the user definable logic functions (CFC)
further control functions can be processed in the same way as a manual–close command.
Interrogation of A precondition for automatic reclosure following clearance of a short-circuit is that the circuit
Circuit Breaker breaker is ready for at least one TRIP-CLOSE-TRIP-cycle when the automatic reclosure circuit is
Ready started (i.e. at the time of the first trip command). The readiness of the circuit breaker is monitored
by the device using a binary input „>CB Ready“ (FNo. 2730). If no such signal is available, the
circuit breaker interrogation can be suppressed (presetting) as automatic reclosure would other-
wise not be possible at all.
This interrogation usually suffices for a single reclosure scheme. Since, for example, the air pres-
sure or the spring tension for the circuit breaker mechanism drops after the trip, no further interro-
gation should take place.
The time needed by the circuit breaker to regain the ready state can be monitored by the 7ST6.
This monitoring time CB TIME OUT starts as soon as the CB indicates the not ready state. The
dead time may be extended if no readiness is signalled at the end of it. However, if the circuit
breaker does not indicate its ready status for a longer period than the monitoring time, reclosure
is locked out dynamically (see also above under margin heading „Blocking of Auto-reclosure“).
Processing the If the circuit-breaker auxiliary contacts are connected to the device, the reaction of the circuit-
Circuit Breaker breaker is also checked for plausibility.
Auxiliary Contacts
This requires that at least one of the auxiliary contacts is connected to the appropriate binary
inputs „>Brk Aux NC“ (FNo. 4602) and „>Brk Aux NO“ (FNo. 4601). If both auxiliary contacts are
connected, a plausibility check of the switching states is possible. The device checks the position
of the circuit breaker continuously. As long as the auxiliary contacts indicate that the CB is not
closed, the automatic reclosure function cannot be started. This guarantees that a close command
can only be issued if the CB previously tripped (out of the closed state). The valid dead time begins
when the trip command disappears or signals taken from the CB auxiliary contacts indicate that
the CB has opened.
Sequence of a The sequence described below applies for single-shot reclosure. In 7ST6 multiple reclosure (up
Reclose Cycle to 8 shots) is also possible (see below).
If the auto reclose function is ready, the fault protection trips for all faults inside the stage selected
for reclosure. The auto reclose function is then started. When the trip command resets or the
circuit-breaker opens (auxiliary contact criterion) an (adjustable) dead time starts. At the end of
this dead time the circuit breaker receives a close command. At the same time the (adjustable)
reclaim time is started.
If the fault has been eliminated (successful reclosure), the reclaim time expires and all functions
return to their quiescent state. The fault is cleared.
If the fault has not been eliminated (unsuccessful reclosure), the short-circuit protection initiates a
final trip following a protection stage active without reclosure. Any fault during the reclaim time
leads to final tripping.
After unsuccessful reclosure (final tripping) the automatic reclosure is blocked dynamically (see
also above under margin heading „Blocking of Auto-reclosure“).
Multi-shot Reclos- If a fault still exists after a reclosure attempt, further reclosure attempts can be made. Up to 8 re-
ing closure attempts are possible with the automatic reclosure function integrated in the7ST6.
The first two reclosure cycles are independent of each other. Each has separate action and dead
times, and can be blocked separately via binary inputs. The parameters and intervention possibil-
ities of the second cycle also apply to the third cycle and onwards.
The sequence is in principle the same as in the different reclosure programs described above.
However, in this case, if the first reclosure attempt was unsuccessful, the reclosure is not blocked
but the next reclosure cycle begins. When the trip command resets or the circuit-breaker opens
(auxiliary contact criterion), the associated dead time starts. The circuit breaker receives a further
close command after this. At the same time the reclaim time is started.
Until the set maximum number of permissible auto-reclose cycles has been reached, the reclaim
time is reset with every new trip command after reclosure and started again with the next close
command.
If one of the reclosing attempts is successful, i.e. the fault disappeared after reclosure, the block-
ing time expires and the automatic reclosing system is reset. The fault is cleared.
If none of the cycles is successful, the short-circuit protection initiates a final trip after the last per-
missible reclosure, following a protection stage active without auto-reclosure. The auto reclose
function is blocked dynamically (see also above under margin heading „Blocking of Auto-reclo-
sure“).
Interaction with the An activated external or internal synchro-check function may lead to an undesired extension of the
Synchro-check dead time.
To prevent the automatic reclosure system from assuming an undefined state, the extension of the
dead time is monitored. The extension time T-DEAD EXT. is started when the regular dead time
has expired. When it has expired, the auto reclose function is blocked dynamically during 500 ms.
The auto reclose function resumes normal state when the blocking time has expired and new
blocking conditions do not apply.
Controlling the In- If the 7ST6 is equipped with the internal auto reclose function, this can also be controlled by an
ternal Automatic external protection device. This is useful for example for line ends with redundant protection or
Reclosure by an Ex- back-up protection when the second protection is used for the same line end and is to work with
ternal Protection the automatic reclosure function integrated in the 7ST6.
Device
Specific binary inputs and outputs must be considered in this case. It must be decided whether the
internal auto-reclosure is to be controlled by the pickup or by the trip command of the external pro-
tection.
The following inputs and outputs are recommended to be used for the auto reclose function:
Automatic reclosure is controlled by the trip command. The external general pickup signal is only
needed for starting the action times.
If the external protection device has dependent tripping zones, additional binary inputs for zone
control are required.
Figure 2-51 shows as a connection example the interconnection between the internal automatic
reclosure of 7ST6 and an external protection device.
Figure 2-51 Connection of an external protection device to the internal automatic reclosure
function
Thermal Auto- The thermal auto reclose function behaves largely in the same way as the general auto reclose
reclose Function function, but is in part controlled by its own parameters and outputs its own indications.
It differs from the general auto reclose function in the following points:
• The thermal auto reclose function cooperates only with the device-internal thermal overload
protection. In the integrated thermal overload protection, pickup and TRIP coincide; therefore
there are no action times.
• The thermal overload protection does not have multiple stages. Therefore no distinction is
made between the 1st reclosure cycle and the subsequent cycles. As a result, the thermal auto
reclose function has no cycle-specific parameters.
• There is no settable dead time. The dead time is dynamic, and results from the temperature
curve. The reclosure temperature is set in the thermal overload protection.
• Separate parameters exist for switching the thermal auto reclose function on and off. Likewise,
there are separate indications for the status of the thermal auto reclose function.
For circuit breaker supervision, interaction with a synchro-check, the manual-close feature and the
dynamic blocking time, the parameters of the general auto reclose function are used.
General If no reclosure is required on the feeder to which the 7ST6 overhead contact line protection is ap-
plied, e.g. for transformers, the auto reclose function must be removed during configuration of the
device (address 133, see Section 2.1.1.2). The auto reclose function is then totally disabled, i.e.
the automatic reclosure is not processed in the 7ST6. No signals regarding the auto reclose func-
tion are generated, and the binary inputs for the auto reclose function are ignored. All parameters
for setting the auto reclose function are inaccessible and of no significance.
Up to 8 reclosure attempts are allowed with the integrated auto reclose function in the 7ST6. The
number of reclosure attempts is specified in address 3402 No.Recl.. Whereas the settings in the
addresses 3401 to 3434 are common to all reclosure cycles, the individual settings for the first cycle
are made from address 3430 onwards. For the second and all higher cycles, the parameters from
address 3440 are valid.
The auto reclose function can be turned ON or OFF in address 3401 AUTO RECLOSE.
A prerequisite for automatic reclosure taking place after a trip due to a short-circuit is that the
circuit breaker is ready for at least one TRIP-CLOSE-TRIP cycle at the time the automatic reclo-
sure circuit is started, i.e. at the time of the first trip command. The readiness of the circuit breaker
is signalled to the device through the binary input „>CB Ready“ (FNo. 2730). If no such signal is
available, leave the setting in address 3415 CB? 1.TRIP = NO (default setting) because no auto-
matic reclosure would be possible at all otherwise. If circuit breaker interrogation is possible, set
3415 CB? 1.TRIP = YES.
The circuit breaker ready state can also be interrogated by the 7ST6 prior to every reclosure. The
monitoring time CB TIME OUT is set in address 3417. The monitoring time CB TIME OUT is the
same for all reclosure cycles. It starts as soon as the CB indicates the "not ready" state. The time
is set slightly longer than the recovery time of the circuit breaker after a TRIP-CLOSE-TRIP cycle.
If the circuit breaker is not ready again by the time this timer expires, no reclosure takes place, the
automatic reclosure function is blocked dynamically.
Waiting for the circuit breaker to be ready can lead to an increase of the dead times. Interrogation
of a synchronization check (if used) can also delay reclosure. To avoid uncontrolled prolongation
it is possible to set a maximum prolongation of the dead time in this case in address 3421 T-DEAD
EXT.. This prolongation is unlimited if the setting is applied. This parameter can only be altered
with DIGSI® under „ Displaying Additional Settings“. Remember that longer dead times are only
permissible after three-pole tripping when no stability problems arise or when a synchro-check
takes place before reclosure.
The blocking time TIME RESTRAINT (address 3420) defines the time that must elapse, after a
successful reclosing attempt, before the auto reclose function is reset. Re-tripping of a protection
function within this time initiates the next reclose cycle in the event of multiple reclosure; if no
further reclosure is permitted, the last reclosure is treated as unsuccessful. The reclaim time must
therefore be longer than the longest response time of a protective function which can start the au-
tomatic reclosure circuit.
A few seconds are generally sufficient. In areas with frequent thunderstorms or storms, a shorter
reclaim time may be necessary to avoid feeder lockout due to sequential lightning strikes or flash-
overs.
A longer reclaim time should be chosen where circuit breaker supervision is not possible (see
above) during multiple reclosures, e.g. because of missing auxiliary contacts and information on
the circuit breaker ready status. In this case, the reclaim time should be longer than the time re-
quired for the circuit breaker mechanism to be ready.
The blocking duration following Manual-Close detection T-BLOCK MC (address 3423) must guar-
antee the circuit breaker to open and close reliably (0.5 s to 1 s). If a fault is detected by a protec-
tion function within this time after closing of the circuit breaker was detected, no reclosure takes
place and a final trip command is issued. If this is not desired, address 3423 is set to 0.
Address 3416 T-Start MONITOR monitors the reaction of the circuit breaker after a trip command.
If the CB has not opened during this time (from the beginning of the trip command), the automatic
reclosure is blocked dynamically. The criterion for circuit breaker opening is the position of the
circuit breaker auxiliary contact or the disappearance of the trip command. If a circuit breaker
failure protection (internal or external) is used on the feeder, this time should be shorter than the
delay time of the circuit breaker failure protection so that no reclosure takes place if the circuit
breaker fails.
Configuration of This configuration concerns the interaction between the protection and supplementary functions
Auto-Reclosure of the device and the auto reclose function. Here you can select which functions of the device are
to start the auto reclose function, and which not (see Table 2-4).
Address Parameter
3405 AR w/ DIST., i.e. with distance protection
3406 AR w/ HS O/C, i.e. with high-speed overcurrent protection
3407 AR w/ DTT, i.e. with externally coupled trip command
For the functions which are to start the auto-reclosure function, the corresponding address is set
to YES, for the others to NO. The other functions, e.g. overvoltage protection, circuit breaker failure
protection, overcurrent protection, defrosting protection cannot start the automatic reclosure
because reclosure is of little use here.
The thermal overload protection is a special case in this context. It is provided with a separate auto
reclose function, the thermal auto reclosure. This auto reclose function can be switched ON or
OFF with the parameter 3450 AUTO-TH-AR.
1st Reclosure Cycle In address 3430 1.AR: START you set whether this cycle is permitted to start the auto reclose
function (= YES) or not.
The action time 1.AR: T-ACTION (address 3431) is the interval from the pickup of a protection
function within which the trip command must appear in order to start the automatic reclosure. If
the command does not appear until after the action time has expired, there is no reclosure.
The dead time after tripping 1st Recl: Tdead (address 3432) should be long enough for the short-
circuit arc to be extinguished and the surrounding air to be de-ionized so that the reclosure prom-
ises to be successful. The longer the line, the longer is this time due to the charging of the con-
ductor capacitances. The stability of the power system must also be kept in mind. Since the de-
energized line cannot transfer synchronizing energy, only short dead times are allowed. Usual
values are 0.3 s to 0.6 s.
If the device is equipped with a synchronism check (see Section 2.13), a longer time may be tol-
erated under certain circumstances. Longer times are also permitted for lines on which only vehi-
cles with converters are used.
If there is a risk of stability problems in the network during a reclosure cycle, set address 3434
SYN-CHECK to YES. In this case a check is made before every reclosure following tripping
whether the voltages of the feeder and the reference are sufficiently synchronized. This is appli-
cable on condition that either the internal synchronism and voltage check function is available or
that an external device is available for synchronism check. Where no stability problems are to be
expected during the auto-reclosure dead time, set address 3434 to NO.
2nd to 8th Reclo- In address 3440 2nd Recl:START you set whether the 2nd to 8th cycle are permitted to start the
sure Cycle auto reclose function (= YES) or not.
If more than two cycles are set in address 3402, those following the second cycle use the settings
of the second cycle.
The table below shows a summary of the parameters of the 2nd cycle.
CB Ready Interro- If the setting of address 3415 CB? 1.TRIP=YES specifies that the readiness of the circuit breaker
gation at 1st Trip in normal state is to be continuously monitored via the binary input 2730 „>CB Ready“, the auto
reclosure function is statically blocked if the binary input signal drops out. The blocking is reset as
soon as the binary input signal returns. Circuit breaker ready signals that drop out during a power
system fault are checked by monitoring times.
Circuit Breaker If the auto reclose function detects that the circuit breaker is open but that there is no TRIP
Open and TRIP command from any internal or external protection function, the auto reclose function is statically
blocked. This state can occur, for instance, if the circuit breaker was not actuated by the protection
but by the control. A prerequisite for detection of an open circuit breaker is in this case that the
breaker auxiliary contacts are connected to the auto reclose function. The blocking is reset when
the circuit breaker is closed.
If a TRIP command occurs while the auto reclose function is statically blocked, the function passes
to the dynamic blocking state.
Possible Causes of The table below summarizes the possible causes of dynamic blocking:
Dynamic Blocking
Table 2-6 Possible causes of dynamic blocking
TRIP out of Action The interval between the appearance of a pickup signal and the appearance of a TRIP command
Time can be monitored by the action time in addresses 3431 1.AR: T-ACTION and 3441 2-8 Recl:T SI.
The action time starts with the appearance of the pickup signal. If the action time expires without
a TRIP command arriving, each TRIP command in the time between the expiry of the action time
and the reset of the pickup leads to a dynamic blocking of the auto reclose function. The "blocked"
signal starts the dynamic blocking time. The auto reclose function resumes normal state when the
blocking time has expired and new blocking conditions do not apply.
Start Signal Moni- The interval between the appearance of the TRIP command and the opening of the circuit breaker
toring Time Expired is monitored by means of the start signal monitoring time set in address 3416 T-Start MONITOR.
If the time expires before the circuit breaker has opened, the auto reclose function is dynamically
blocked and the dynamic blocking time launched. The auto reclose function resumes normal state
when the blocking time has expired and new blocking conditions do not apply.
Dead Time Exten- The monitoring of the circuit breaker ready signal and the synchro-check may cause undesired
sion Expired extension of the dead time. To prevent the automatic reclosure system from assuming an unde-
fined state, the extension of the dead time is monitored. The extension time (address 3421 T-
DEAD EXT.) is launched when the regular dead time has expired. When it has expired, the auto-
matic reclosure function is blocked dynamically and the dynamic blocking time launched. The auto
reclose function resumes its normal state when the blocking time has expired and new blocking
conditions do not apply.
Circuit Breaker If the setting of address 3415 CB? 1.TRIP specifies that the circuit breaker readiness is to be mon-
Ready Monitoring itored during the dead time, the timer for the circuit breaker ready monitoring (3417 CB TIME
Time Expired / OUT) is launched within the pause when the binary input indication2730 „>CB Ready“ disappears.
Reclaim Time If it expires without the binary input signal returning, the auto reclose function is dynamically
Expired without CB blocked, and the blocking time of 500 ms is launched. The auto reclose function resumes its
CLOSE normal state when the blocking time has expired and new blocking conditions do not apply. If the
reclaim time, plus, where applicable, the CLOSE command time, expires without the circuit
breaker being closed, the auto reclose function is also dynamically blocked.
Blocking by Pickup In the case of a pickup by any of the internal protection functions, the general auto reclose function
in Reverse Direc- can be dynamically blocked in dependence on parameter 3413 AR BLK REVERSE) if the distance
tion protection detects a fault in reverse direction. The auto reclose function resumes normal state
when the blocking time has expired and new blocking conditions do not apply.
Current Limit When the fault current reaches a settable limit I LIMIT BLK (address 3411), a started automatic
Reached reclosure is dynamically blocked. The auto reclose function resumes its normal state when the
blocking time of 500 ms has expired and new blocking conditions do not apply.
Blocking of the If the automatic reclosure function is active (actuated by the thermal overload function) and trips
Thermal Auto another protection function, the auto reclose function is dynamically blocked. The blocking is reset
Reclose Function as soon as the dynamic blocking has expired.
by Pickup of
another Protection
Function
No More Cycles The maximum number of reclosure attempts specified in the settings is reached. If now a TRIP
Possible command is given within the reclaim time, the auto reclose function is dynamically blocked during
500 ms. The auto reclose function resumes its normal state when the blocking time has expired
and new blocking conditions do not apply.
Manual Close The parameter T-BLOCK MC (address 3423) specifies whether the auto reclose function re-
sponds to a manual CLOSE command.
If T-BLOCK MC is set to 0, the auto reclose function does not respond on detecting a manual
CLOSE command. If the parameter T-BLOCK MC is set to 0, the auto reclosure function is dy-
namically blocked on detecting a manual CLOSE command. This is also true if the auto reclose
function has not yet been started, or if it is already statically blocked.
On appearance of the manual CLOSE signal, the manual CLOSE blocking time defined in the pa-
rameter T-BLOCK MC (address 3423) and the dynamic blocking time of 500 ms are launched.
Both times overlap. If the dynamic blocking time is longer than the manual CLOSE blocking time,
the device checks on expiry of the dynamic blocking time whether the blocking can be reset.
If no more blocking conditions apply, the auto reclose function resumes its normal state. If the
manual CLOSE blocking time is still running when the dynamic blocking time has expired, the
blocking is maintained, and the dynamic blocking time relaunched.
TRIP by Breaker If the breaker failure protection issues a TRIP command, the auto reclose function is dynamically
Failure Protection blocked, even if the set maximum number of cycles is not yet reached. The indication „AR
DynBlock“ (FNo. 2785) is output. Here the start signal monitoring time must be matched to the
breaker failure protection. The auto reclose function resumes normal state when the dynamic
blocking time has expired.
Interaction with an The auto reclose functions provides binary input and output signals for interaction with an external
External Protection protection device.
Device
In the functional description of the auto reclose function, a connection example of the auto reclose
function to an external protection device is shown under margin heading „Controlling the Internal
Automatic Reclosure by an External Protection Device“.
Thermal Auto- The thermal auto reclose function is not an autonomous function. It is configured together with the
reclose Function general auto reclose function but can be separately switched ON or OFF with the parameter
AUTO-TH-AR (address 3450). In address 3451 No. of TH-AR, the number of reclosure attempts
is specified for the thermal auto reclose function.
The thermal auto reclose function behaves largely in the same way as the general auto reclose
function, but is in part controlled by its own parameters and outputs its own indications (see margin
heading „Thermal Auto Reclose Function“ in the functional description).
In contrast to the general auto reclose function, there is no settable dead time. The dead time is
dynamic, and results from the temperature curve. A maximum permissible dead time can be
defined with the parameter Tdead TH MAX (address 3456). After this monitoring time has expired,
the thermal auto reclose function is blocked, and an indication is output with „AR TH TO Tdead“
after the dead time has expired. This means that the maximum dead time must be set longer than
the expected time necessary for the line to cool off. The reclosure temperature is set in the
thermal overload protection (see also Subsection 2.7.4).
Separate binary inputs exist for switching the thermal auto reclose function on and off and for
blocking it. Likewise, there are separate indications for the status of the thermal auto reclose func-
tion. For circuit breaker supervision, interaction with a synchro-check, the manual-close feature
and the dynamic blocking time, the parameters of the general auto reclose function are used.
Notes on the Infor- The most important information about automatic reclosure is briefly explained insofar as it was not
mation List mentioned in the following lists or described in detail in the preceding text.
„>BLK 1.AR-cycle“ (FNo. 2742) and „>AR BLK >1st“ (FNo. 13874)
The associated reclosure cycles are blocked. If the blocking state already exists when the auto-
matic reclosure function is initiated, the blocked cycle is not executed and may be skipped. The
same is true if the auto reclose function is started outside the blocked cycle. If the block signal of
a cycle appears while this cycle is being executed (busy) the automatic reclosure function is
blocked dynamically; no further automatic reclosures cycles are then executed.
„AR EN Z1B“ (FNo. 13887), „AR EN Z1L“ (FNo. 13888) and „AR EN Z1“ (FNo. 13886)
If the signal „AR EN Z1B“ is active, the automatic reclosure function is ready for the first reclosure
cycle. An active signal „AR EN Z1L“ indicates that the auto reclose function is ready for a second
or higher cycle. On the other hand, the signal „AR EN Z1“ indicates that the auto reclose function
is in its last cycle, or blocked. For example, external protection functions can use these signals to
release accelerated or overreaching trip stages prior to the corresponding reclose cycle.
The automatic reclosure is not ready for reclosure at the moment. In addition to the reasons men-
tioned above for static blocking, there are also obstructions during the course of the reclose cycles
such as "action time run out" or "last reclaim time running". This information is particularly helpful
during testing because no protection test cycle with reclosure may be initiated during this state.
A blocking via the BI (2703:„>BLOCK AR“) may cause both a static and a dynamic blocking. An
activation of the BI with the auto reclose function in normal state will cause a static blocking. The
blocking is terminated immediately when the binary input has been cleared, and the automatic re-
closure function resumes its normal state.
If the auto reclose function is already running when the blocking arrives, the dynamic blocking
takes effect. In this case, the blocking time defined by the parameter T BLK DYN (address 3422)
is started when the binary input is set. After the time has expired, the function checks whether the
BI is still active. If it is, the auto reclose function passes from dynamic to static blocking. If the
binary input is no longer active when the time has expired and if no new blocking conditions apply,
the automatic reclosure system resumes normal state.
This information appears following starting of the auto reclose function, i.e. with the first trip
command that can start the auto reclose function. If this reclosure was successful (or any in the
case of more than one), this information resets with the expiry of the last reclaim time. If no reclo-
sure was successful or if reclosure was blocked, it ends with the last – the final – trip command.
Measuring request to an external synchronism check device. The information appears at the end
of a dead time subsequent to tripping if a synchronism request is present. Reclosure only takes
place when the synchronism check device has provided the release signal „>Sync.release“
(FNo.2731).
Release of reclosure by an external synchronism check device if this was requested by the output
information „AR Sync.Request“ (FNo. 2865).
2.12.3 Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under Additional Set-
tings.
The synchronism and voltage check function ensures, when switching a line onto a busbar, that
the stability of the network is not endangered. The voltage of the feeder to be energized is com-
pared to the voltage of the busbar (reference voltage) to check conformances in terms of magni-
tude, phase angle and frequency within certain tolerances. Optionally deenergization of the feeder
can be checked before it is connected to an energized busbar (or vice versa).
The synchro check can either be conducted only for automatic reclosure, only for manual closing
(this includes also closing via control command) or in both cases. Different close permission (re-
lease) criteria can also be programmed for automatic and manual closing.
Synchro check is also possible without external matching transformers if a power transformer is
located between the measuring points.
Closing is released for synchronous or asynchronous system conditions. In the latter case the
device determines the time for issuing the close command such that the voltages are identical the
instant the breaker poles make contact.
General For comparing the two voltages, the synchro check uses the overhead line voltage ULine and an
additional reference voltage URef.
Figure 2-53 Connection example of the synchro-check, interaction with the protection function
and the automatic reclosure function
The synchro-check function in the 7ST6 usually operates together with the integrated automatic
reclose, manual close, and the control functions of the relay. It is also possible to employ an ex-
ternal automatic reclosing system. In such a case signal exchange between the devices is accom-
plished via binary inputs and outputs.
When closing via the integrated control function, the configured interlocking conditions may have
to be verified before checking the conditions for synchronism. After the synchronism check grants
the release, the interlocking conditions are not checked a second time.
The synchro check function only operates when it is requested to do so. Various possibilities exist
to this end:
• Measuring request from the external automatic reclosure device. If the internal automatic re-
closing function is set accordingly (one or more reclosing attempts set to synchronism check,
see also Section 2.12.2), the measuring request is accomplished internally. The release condi-
tions for automatic reclosing apply.
• Measuring request from an internal automatic reclosure device. The measuring request must
be injected via the binary input „>Sync. Start AR“ (FNo 2906). The release conditions for auto-
matic reclosing apply.
• Measuring request from the internal manual CLOSE detection. The manual CLOSE detection
of the central function control (Section 2.18.1) issues a measuring request provided this was
configured in the power system data 2 (Section 2.1.5, address 1151 SYN.MAN.CL). This re-
quires the device to be informed of the manual closing via binary input „>Manual Close“ (FNo
356). The release conditions for manual closing apply.
• Request to execute a check synchronism measurement from an external closing command.
Binary input „>Sync. Start MC“ FNo. 2905 fulfills this purpose. Unlike the „>Manual Close“ (see
previous paragraph), this merely affects the measuring request to the synchro check function,
but not other integrated manual CLOSE function such as instantaneous tripping when switch-
ing onto a fault (e.g. overreaching zone for distance protection or accelerated tripping of a time
overcurrent stage). The release conditions for manual closing apply.
• Measuring request from the integrated control function via control keys or via the serial inter-
face using DIGSI ® on a PC or from a control centre. The release conditions for manual closing
apply.
The synchro-check function gives permission for passage „Sync. release“ (FNo. 2951) of the
closing command to the required function. Furthermore a separate closing command is available
as output indication „Sync.CloseCmd“ (FNo. 2961).
The check of the release conditions is limited by an adjustable synchronous monitoring time T-
SYN. DURATION. The configured conditions must be fulfilled within this time. If they are not, the
synchronism will not be checked. A new synchronism check sequence requires a new request.
The device issues indications if, after a request to check synchronism, the conditions for release
are not fulfilled, i.e. if the absolute voltage difference Max. Volt. Diff, the absolute frequency dif-
ference Max. Freq. Diff, or the absolute phase angle difference Max. Angle Diff lie outside the per-
missible limit values. A precondition for these indications is that voltages within the operating
range of the relay are available. When a closing command is handled by the integrated control
function and the conditions for synchronism are not fulfilled, the command is cancelled, i.e. the
control function outputs „CO–“ (refer also to Section 2.19.1).
Operating Modes The closing check procedure can be selected from the following operating modes:
SYNC-CHECK = Release at synchronism, that is, when the critical values Max.
Volt. Diff, Max. Freq. Diff and Max. Angle Diff lie within the set
limits. This parameter is only displayed if you have checked the
“Advanced Settings” checkbox in DIGSI.
Each of these conditions can be enabled or disabled individually; combinations are also possible,
e.g. release if Uref>Uline< or Uref<Uline> are fulfilled. Combination of OVERRIDE with other pa-
rameters is, of course, not reasonable.
The release conditions can be configured individually either for automatic reclosing or for manual
closing or for closing via control commands. You can, for example, allow manual closing and
control closing for synchronism or for de-energized feeder whereas before an automatic reclosing
operation, checking only de-energized conditions at one feeder terminal and afterwards only syn-
chronism at the other.
De-energized For release of the closing command to energize a voltage free line from a live busbar, the following
Switching conditions are checked:
• Is the feeder voltage ULine below the set value Dead Volt. Thr.?
• Is the reference voltage URef above the setting value Live Volt. Thr. but below the maximum
voltage Umax?
• Is the frequency fRef within the permitted operating range fN 3 Hz?
Corresponding conditions apply when switching a live line onto a dead busbar or a dead line onto
a dead busbar.
Switching under Before granting a release for closing under synchronous conditions, the following conditions are
Synchronous checked:
System Conditions • Is the reference voltage URef above the setting value Live Volt. Thr. but below the maximum
voltage Umax?
• Is the feeder voltage ULine above the setting value Live Volt. Thr. but below the maximum
voltage Umax?
• Is the magnitude of the voltage difference |ULine – URef| within the permissible limit Max. Volt.
Diff?
• Are the two frequencies fRef and fLine within the permitted operating range fN 3 Hz?
• Is the frequency difference |fLine – fRef| within the permissible limit Max. Freq. Diff?
• Is the angle difference |Line – ref| within the permissible limit Max. Angle Diff?
To check whether these conditions are observed for a certain minimum time, you can set this
minimum time as T SYNC-STAB. Checking the synchronism conditions can also be confined to a
maximum monitoring time T-SYN. DURATION. This implies that the conditions must be fulfilled
within the time T-SYN. DURATION for the duration of T SYNC-STAB. If this is the case, the closing
release is released.
Switching under Before granting a release for closing under asynchronous conditions, the following conditions are
Asynchronous checked:
System Conditions • Is the reference voltage URef above the setting value Live Volt. Thr. but below the maximum
voltage Umax?
• Is the feeder voltage ULine above the setting value Live Volt. Thr. but below the maximum
voltage Umax?
• Is the magnitude of the voltage difference |ULine – URef| within the permissible limit Max. Volt.
Diff?
• Are the two frequencies fRef and fLine within the permitted operating range f 3 Hz?
• Is the frequency difference |fLine – fRef| within the permissible limit Max. Freq. Diff?
When the check has been terminated successfully, the device determines the next synchronizing
time from the angle difference and the frequency difference. The close command is issued at syn-
chronization time minus the operating time of the circuit breaker.
Preconditions When setting the general power system data (refer to section 2.1.3.1) a number of parameters re-
garding the measured quantities and the operating mode of the synchronism check function must
be applied.
204 Unom PRIMARY Primary rated voltage of the voltage transformers in kV;
230 Rated Frequency The operating range of the synchronism check refers to the
nominal frequency of the power system (fN 3 Hz);
WARNING!
Closing under Asynchronous System Conditions
Closing under asynchronous system conditions requires the closing time of the circuit breaker to
be set correctly in the Power system data 1 (address 239).
General The synchro-check can only operate if it has been set to Enabled during the configuration of the
device scope (address 135 Synchro-Check).
The measured values of the synchro check (636 „Udif=“, 637 „Uline=“, 638 „Uref=“, 647 „fdif=“,
649 „fline=“, 646 „fref=“ and 648 „-diff=“) are only available if the synchro-check has been set
to Enabled.
Different interrogation conditions can be parameterized for automatic reclosure on the one hand
and for manual closure on the other hand. Each closing command is considered a manual reclo-
sure if it was initiated via the integrated control function or via a serial interface.
The general limit values for closure are set in addresses 3501 to 3508. For the automatic reclosure
function, the addresses 3510 to 3519 are also relevant, and for manual closure or control closure
the addresses 3530 to 3539. Moreover, address 3509 is relevant for reclosure via the integrated
control function.
The complete synchronism check function is switched ON or OFF in address 3501 FCT
Synchronism. If switched off, the synchro-check does not verify the synchronization conditions and
release is not granted.
Address 3502 Dead Volt. Thr. indicates the voltage threshold below which the feeder or the busbar
can safely be considered switched off (for checking a de-energized feeder or busbar). The setting
is applied in Volts secondary. This value can be entered as a primary value when parameterizing
with a PC and DIGSI®.
Address 3503 Live Volt. Thr. shows the voltage above it is safe to assume that the feeder or the
busbar is carrying load. It must be set below the anticipated operational undervoltage. The setting
is applied in Volts secondary. This value can be entered as a primary value when parameterizing
with a PC and DIGSI®.
The maximum permissible voltage for the operating range of the synchronism check function is
set in address 3504 Umax. The setting is applied in Volts secondary. This value can be entered as
a primary value when parameterizing with a PC and DIGSI®.
The check of the release conditions through the synchronism check function can be limited to a
configurable synchronous monitoring time T-SYN. DURATION (address 3507). The configured
conditions must be fulfilled within this time. Below that, value reclosure will not be released. If this
time is set to , the conditions will be checked until they are fulfilled or the measuring request is
deactivated.
If the conditions for synchronous operation must be checked to be maintained for a certain dura-
tion, this minimum duration T SYNC-STAB can be set in address 3508.
Synchronism Addresses 3510 to 3519 are relevant to the check conditions before automatic reclosure of the
Conditions for circuit breaker. When setting the parameters for the internal automatic reclosing function (Section
Automatic 2.12.2) it was decided whether the synchronism check should be carried out.
Reclosure
Address 3510 Op.mode with AR determines whether closing under asynchronous system condi-
tions is allowed for automatic reclosure. Set this parameter to with T-CB close to allow asynchro-
nous closing; the relay will then consider the circuit breaker closing time before determining the
correct instant for the close command. Remember that closing under asynchronous system con-
ditions is allowed only if the circuit breaker closing time is set correctly (see above under „Precon-
ditions“)! If you wish to permit automatic reclosure only under synchronous system conditions, set
this address to w/o T-CB close.
The permissible magnitude difference of the voltages is set in address 3511 Max. Volt. Diff. The
setting is applied in Volts secondary. This value can be entered as a primary value when param-
eterizing with a PC and DIGSI®.
The permissible frequency difference between the voltages is set in address 3512 Max. Freq. Diff,
the permissible phase angle difference in address 3513 Max. Angle Diff.
The further release conditions for automatic reclosing are set in addresses 3515 to 3519:
3515 SYNC-CHECK The busbar (URef) and the feeder (ULine) must both be live
(Live Volt. Thr., address 3503); the conditions for synchronism
are checked, i.e. Max. Volt. Diff (address 3511), Max. Freq. Diff
(address 3512) and Max. Angle Diff (address 3513). This pa-
rameter can only be altered with DIGSI® under Additional Set-
tings.
3516 Uref>Uline< The busbar (URef) must be live (Live Volt. Thr., address 3503),
the feeder (ULine) must be dead (Dead Volt. Thr., address
3502);
3517 Uref<Uline> The busbar (URef) must be dead (Dead Volt. Thr., address
3502), the feeder (ULine) must be live (Live Volt. Thr., address
3503);
3518 Uref<Uline< The busbar (URef) and the feeder (ULine) must both be dead
(Dead Volt. Thr., address 3502);
The five possible release conditions are independent of each other and can be combined.
Synchronism Addresses 3530 to 3539 are relevant to the check conditions before manual reclosure and closing
Conditions for via control command of the circuit breaker. When setting the general protection data (Power
Manual Closure System Data 2, Section 2.1.5.1) it was decided in address 1151 whether synchronism and voltage
and Control check should be carried out before manual closing. With the following setting in address
Command SYN.MAN.CL = w/o Sync-check, no checks are performed before manual closing.
For commands through the integrated control (local, DIGSI, serial interface), address 3509 SyncSD
determines whether synchro checks will be performed or not. This address also tells the device to
which switching device of the control the synchronizing request refers. You can select from the
switching devices which are available for the integrated control. Choose the circuit breaker to be
operated via the synchronism check. This is usually the circuit breaker which is operated in case
of manual closing or automatic reclosure. If you set SyncSD = none here, a CLOSE command via
the integrated control will be carried out without synchronism check.
Address 3530 Op.mode with MC determines whether closing under asynchronous system condi-
tions is allowed for manual closing or reclosure via control command. Set this parameter to with
T-CB close to allow asynchronous closing; the relay will then consider the circuit breaker closing
time before determining the correct instant for the close command. Remember that closing under
asynchronous system conditions is allowed only if the circuit breaker closing time is set correctly
(see above under „Preconditions“)! If you wish to permit manual closure or closing via control
command only under synchronous system conditions, set this address to w/o T-CB close.
The permissible magnitude difference of the voltages is set in address 3531 MC maxVolt.Diff. The
setting is applied in Volts secondary. This value can be entered as a primary value when param-
eterizing with a PC and DIGSI®.
The permissible frequency difference between the voltages is set in address 3532 MC
maxFreq.Diff, the permissible phase angle difference in address 3533 MC maxAngleDiff.
The further release conditions for manual reclosing or reclosure via control command are set in
addresses 3535 to 3539.
3535 MC SYNCHR the busbar (URef) and the feeder (ULine) must both be live
(Live Volt. Thr., address 3503); the conditions for synchronism
are checked, i.e. MC maxVolt.Diff (address 3531), MC
maxFreq.Diff (address 3532) and MC maxAngleDiff (address
3533). This parameter can only be altered with DIGSI® under
Additional Settings.
3536 MC Uref>Uline< The busbar (URef) must be live (Live Volt. Thr., address 3503),
the feeder (ULine) must be dead (Dead Volt. Thr., address
3502);
3537 MC Uref<Uline> The busbar (URef) must be dead (Dead Volt. Thr., address
3502), the feeder (ULine) must be live (Live Volt. Thr., address
3503);
3538 MC Uref<Uline< The busbar (UBus) and the feeder (ULine) must both be dead
(Dead Volt. Thr., address 3502);
The five possible release conditions are independent of each other and can be combined.
Note
The closing functions of the device issue individual output indications for the corresponding close
command. Be sure that the output indications are assigned to the correct output relays.
FNo. 2851 „AR Close“ for CLOSE via command of the automatic reclosure,
FNo. 562 „Man.Close Cmd“ for manual CLOSE via binary input,
FNo. 2961 „Sync.CloseCmd“ for CLOSE via synchronism check (not required if synchronism check
releases the other CLOSE commands),
Notes on the Infor- The most important information of the device is briefly explained in so far as it cannot be interpret-
mation List ed in the following information lists or described in detail in the foregoing text.
Binary input which enables direct tripping of the synchronism check with setting parameters for
manual close. This tripping with setting parameter for manual close has always precedence if
binary inputs „>Sync. Start MC“ (FNo. 2905) and „>Sync. Start AR“ (FNo. 2906, see below) are ac-
tivated at the same time.
Measuring request from an internal automatic reclosure device. After this request, the conditions
for automatic reclosure are checked.
Measuring request form the control; evaluated on event-triggered basis and output only when the
control issues a measuring request.
2.13.3 Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under Additional Set-
tings.
The measurement of the distance to a fault is an supplement to the protection functions. Avail-
ability of the line for power transmission within the system can be increased when the fault is
located and cleared faster.
Initiation Condi- The fault locator in the overhead contact line protection 7ST6 is a function which is independent
tions of the distance measurement. It has a separate measured signal memory and dedicated algo-
rithms for determination of the loop reactance and the fault location.
The short-circuit protection merely has to provide a start command to allow the selection of the
best suited time interval for the storage of the measured signals.
The fault locator can be triggered either by the trip command of the short-circuit protection, or by
each fault detection. In the latter case, a fault location calculation is also possible if a different pro-
tection device clears the fault.
For a fault outside the protected overhead contact line, the fault location information is not always
correct, as the measured values can be distorted by, e.g. intermediate infeeds or by loads along
the line.
Determination of The measured value pairs of fault currents and fault voltages are the basis for calculating the im-
the Fault Location pedance.
Filtering of the measured values and the number of impedance calculations are automatically
adapted to the number of measured value pairs provided in the available data window. If a suffi-
cient data window with appropriate measured value pairs could not be determined, the alarm
„Flt.Loc.invalid“ (FNo.1132) is issued.
The evaluation of the measured quantities takes place after the fault has been cleared.
At least three result pairs of R and X are calculated from the stored and filtered measured quan-
tities in accordance with the line equations. The calculated average for X is the fault reactance
which is proportional to the distance to fault.
For the fault locator up to 5 line sections (respectively for forward and reverse direction) with dif-
ferent reactance per unit length characteristics can be defined. Calculation of the fault location is
thus possible even with inhomogeneous line sections. Transformers can be included in determi-
nation of fault location, by parameterizing the line section belonging to the transformer reactance
with length d = 0. The figure below illustrates how the distance to fault is computed from the fault
reactance determined by the fault location calculation.
Figure 2-54 Determination of the distance to fault from the calculated fault reactance
As a result, the fault location works correctly even if there are line sections with different reactance
per unit length characteristics, or transformers, between the protection device and the fault.
Note
The transformers can be included in determination of fault location, by parameterizing the line
section belonging to the transformer reactance with length d = 0.
Note
The precision of the fault locator specified in the Technical Data applies to faults with a sufficiently
long measuring window for calculating the fault location. In case of an instantaneous trip, the pre-
cision of the fault location is necessarily reduced due to the short fault clearance time and the high
harmonics content in the measured current and voltage signals.
Output of the Fault The fault locator issues the following results:
Location • Fault direction (forward / reverse)
• Reactance X in primary and secondary,
• Resistance R in primary and secondary,
• Distance to fault d in kilometres or miles, calculated on the basis of the reactance per unit length
characteristics parameterized for the line sections,
• Distance to fault d in % of the line length.
Note
If the function fault locator is available, the determination of the direction, apart from the distance
protection, can also be executed by the fault locator. The results of both procedures may differ in
rare cases. The direction determination of the fault locator can be more precise due to the longer
measuring window.
Note
The direction indication orientates itself according to the line and is indicated independent from
the direction indication of the distance protection. Depending on the fault location and the config-
ured distance protection zone, it may deviate from the direction indication of the distance protec-
tion.
Fault location in In autotransformer systems classical fault location basing on calculation of reactance and on dis-
autotransformer tance-mapping based on reactance per kilometer do not reach the desired precision. Thus is due
systems to the fact, that the distance-reactance curve in systems with autotransformers is not linear, as
shown in Figure 2-55.
The Siprotec ® 7ST6 provides a special fault location algorithm for systems with autotransformers.
The algorithm allows detecting the fault reactance, the fault distance and the type of fault (over-
head contact line - track or negative feeder - track).
In order to use the fault location in autotransformer systems, the necessary input signals must be
provided. The connection of the signals is shown in Appendix A.3, Figure A-8. Without separate
measurement of contact line and negative feeder currents it is not possible to use the fault locator
in autotransformer systems.
Like the distance protection functionality, the fault locator calculates the impedance of the short
circuit using the voltage between catenary and track (UCL-Track) and the sum of contact line (ICL)
and negative feeder (INF) currents. For the fault location, the reactance X is used.
U CL Track
Z X ImZ
I CL I NF
Figure 2-55 shows the measured reactance X as a function of the distance d of the fault from the
substation for contact line-track faults X(CL-Track) and for negative feeder-track faults X(NF-
Track) in a system with three different sections.
14
12
SecƟon 1 SecƟon 2 2 SecƟon 3
10
8
X/Ohm
X(PF -Rail)
6 X(NF-Rail)
0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
d/km
Figure 2-55 Reactance X as a function of the distance d of the fault from the substation for
contact line-track and negative feeder-track faults
In order to find the correct fault distance, the catenary and negative feeder currents are also eva-
luated. The current-distance curves for contact line-track and negative feeder-track faults are
shown in Figure 2-56.
10000
9000
SecƟon 1 SecƟon 2 SecƟon 3
8000
7000
6000
I/A 5000
IPF
4000 INF
3000
2000
1000
0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
d/km
Figure 2-56 Short circuit current as a function of the fault distance from the substation.
ICL: Current for a contact line-track fault
INF: Current for a negative feeder-track fault
General The fault locator is only effective and available if address 138 Fault Locator was set to Enabled
during configuration. If the function is not required, Disabled is to be set.
Start Condition If the fault location calculation is to be started by the trip command of the protection, set address
3802 START = TRIP.
If the fault location calculation is to be started on each fault detection by the device, set address
3802 START = Reclosing/Trip. In this case the fault location is also calculated if, for example, a dif-
ferent protection device cleared the fault. For a fault outside the protected line, the fault location
information is not always correct, as the measured values can be distorted by e.g. intermediate
infeeds.
Systems with The fault locator for autotransformer systems is only active if the parameter Addr. 138 FAULT
autotransformers LOCATOR = ON and the parameter Addr. 231 AUTOTRANSF. = yes.
The number of sections is set using parameter Addr. 234 SECTIONS, a maximum of 5 sections
can be set up. Each section is described in a dedicated block of parameters. The structure of all
parameters block is the same.
In order to set up the fault locator it is necessary to determine the distance-reactance and dis-
tance-current curves, e.g by simulation or measurement. The reactance curve of each section and
fault type is described by three points. Figure 2-57 shows the reactance-distance curve for the first
section of a simulated autotransformer system.
2
Adr. 6103 X1 NF Begin.
Figure 2-57 Parameters for the input of the reactance in a section of an autotransformer
system
The length of the first section is set under Addr. 1111 d1. The first input point of the curve is always
at the beginning of the section (distance = 0). The reactances of both fault types can be set using
following parameters:
The distance for the second measurement point is set using parameter Addr. 6110 d1 Middle. This
value is valid for both fault types. The position of the middle point should be chosen so that a suf-
ficient distance from the beginning and end of the section is given. The reactances corresponding
to the middle point are set up using the following parameters:
The third measurement point is always at the end of the section. This point is also the first mea-
surement point for the next section. In this way, it is not necessary to set up measurement data for
the first point of the next section. The reactances corresponding to the end point are set up using
the following parameters:
The distance-current curves for each section are described using three or optionally four points.
For contact line - track faults the current ICL is used, while for negative feeder track faults the
current INF.is used.
8000
0
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20
Adr. 6120 d1 MP2 = 4km Adr. 6110 d1 Middle = 10km d/km Adr. 6111 d1 = 20km
The default procedure for current description is to use four points. If only three points shall be
used, then parameter Addr. 6120 d1 MP2 should be set to infinity (. If, on the contrary, a fourth
measuring point is used, then the parameter should be set to describe the distance between the
middle point 2 and the beginning of the section. For an optimal approximation of the current func-
tions, the middle point 2 should be set so to maximize the change in the slope of the distance-
current curves before and after it.
The short circuit currents for both types of faults are set using following parameters:
The parameters for the following sections of the autotransformer system have a similar structure.
It shall be noticed, that the reactance and current values for the point at the beginning of the
section coincide with the values at the end of the preceding section and are not specified sepa-
rately.
Note:
In some cases where the fault lays in a particularly flat zone of the distance-reactance curve a
precise fault location might not be possible, since small measurement errors can lead to big dis-
tance deviations.
Note:
A distinction between different types of fault might be impossible where the reactance-distance or
the current-distance curves are particularly flat. This effect might be especially strong at the end
of the electrification section where the fault currents are particularly small.
2.14.3 Settings
Via two different procedures the It function makes information available, which enables an opti-
mised determination of the service period of the circuit breaker by means of an adequately precise
determination of the circuit breaker load. By means of the It procedure the circuit breaker load on
opening of the main breaker contacts up to arc deletion is determined, apart from the determina-
tion of the fault current at the time of trip command. A reliable statement with regard to the re-
maining lifespan of the main breaker contacts can be made by means of the 2P-procedure when
taking operating cycle diagrams into consideration.
The summation of the fault current-time integrals from opening of the breaker main contact up to
arc deletion is a simple and reliable indicator of the extent of contact wear in a circuit breaker.
The two-point procedure (2P-procedure) determines the fault current on opening of the breaker
main contact and calculates the remaining lifespan under consideration of the manufacturer-spe-
cific data (operating cycle diagrams) of the circuit breaker.
These procedures, summarised under the term It function, thus make it possible to plan the main-
tenance work on the circuit breaker within the framework of service and maintenance more effi-
ciently.
General The circuit breaker load is proportional to the current-time integral over the time between the
opening of the breaker main contact tstart and the quenching of the arc in the arcing chamber tend.
This allows to determine a measure of the breaker load with the following formula:
The starting time tstart, i.e. the opening of the main breaker contacts, can be determined either by
the status of the CB auxiliary contacts or, if that status is not available, via the device TRIP com-
mand. For an accurate determination of the circuit breaker load, the instants tstart and tend must
be determined as precisely as possible. The following two sections describe two alternative
methods for determining the starting time tstart.
The plausibility of the times tStart and tEnd is monitored. When tStartis found to be greater than tEnd,
there will be no It measurement, and the indication „It set error“ (FNo. 13855) is output.
The starting time tStart can be marked by the signal „Start It Meas“ (FNo. 13848) in the fault record.
Using the Circuit Here the starting time tStart is determined from the moment of opening a circuit breaker auxiliary
Breaker Auxiliary contact. For sufficient precision, it is absolutely necessary to use an NC contact of the circuit
Contacts breaker auxiliary contact, i.e. the closed contact is equivalent to the OPEN position.
In the 7ST6 device the indication „>Brk Aux NC“ (FNo 4602) is used for this purpose. The device
does not detect the opening of the circuit breaker auxiliary contact until a delay time tBI of approx.
5 ms has elapsed.
Note
The indication „>Brk Aux NC“ must be allocated to a fast binary input. The binary inputs BI1
through BI12 must be used for this!
The circuit breaker main contact may open before or after the circuit breaker auxiliary contact. The
time difference between the switching of these two contacts can be set with the parameter DELTA
AuxCont (address 4103). A positive value is set for this time difference if the auxiliary contact
opens or closes later than the main contact.
The figure below illustrates how the time limit for determination of the current integral is specified.
The values used in it are:
tBI Instant at which the device detects through a binary input BI that the auxiliary
contact Aux is closed.
Figure 2-59 Typical course of a trip, including the beginning and end of the integration interval
to determine the trip load
Following a TRIP command, the binary inputs for the circuit breaker auxiliary contacts are moni-
tored for a maximum of 150 ms. If the binary input is activated during that interval, the current-time
integral measurement is started. Then the last zero crossing of the current is determined.
Using the TRIP In this case, the starting time of the current-time integral determination is computed with the fol-
Command lowing formula:
where:
tTRIP Instant at which the TRIP command is issued by one of the protection functions
in the device,
T00 CB response time (time between the TRIP command and the contact move-
ment, can be set in address 4102).
Calculation of tEnd The current-time integral measurement ends with the quenching in a current zero crossing.
This current zero crossing is the last one if no new zero crossing occurs during the following cycle
T (power system frequency). tend is the time of the last current zero crossing plus one cycle T.
Current-Time Inte- When the function is configured in address 141 FCT It-Calc., one of the above methods for deter-
gral Measurement mining the time tStart is selected.
The entire measuring time range starts with tstart and is limited to the duration 2T + parameter T
CB BREAKTIME.
If the current is not interrupted within the test time, e.g. because of a breaker failure, there is no
calculation, and the indication „It Overflow“ (FNo. 13849) is generated. The sums of I dt (indication
„ It=“; FNo. 13851) and I2 dt (indication „ I2t=“; FNo. 13852) are not changed in that case.
If the current is successfully interrupted, the values of the current-time integrals of the current I dt
and of the squared current I2 dt are generated for the current trip. The accumulated sums of these
values for all trips since the device startup or since the last reset are output in the indications „
It=“ and „ I2t=“. The accumulators can be individually set and cleared.
The cumulated fault current is also output in the indication „ I=“ (FNo. 13927).
The values of the last individual trip are output in the indications „Last It=“ (current-time integral
over absolute value, FNo. 13853) and „Last I2t=“ (current-time integral squared current, FNo.
13854).
If the limit of the current-time integral set in parameter It ALARM (address 4104) is exceeded by
the last trip, the indication „It Alarm“ (FNo. 13847) is output.
Neither does the use of auto-transformer systems affect the measured value acquisition as de-
scribed above.
General In the 2P-procedure the CB manufacturer's double-log operating cycle diagrams and the fault
current measured at the time of contact separation serve as a basis for the calculation of the re-
maining lifespan. The data supplied by the CB manufacturer is transformed in such manner that,
by means of measuring the fault currents, a concrete statement can be made with regard to the
still possible operating cycles.
The calculated remaining lifespan represents the number of still possible trips of currents as high
as the rating operating current. It is displayed as a statistical value. The display does not indicate
a unit and no decimals. As for the other procedures, the remaining lifespan is verified against a
limit value. This forms the "lower limit" here, as the remaining lifespan decrements with each trip
by a number of operating cycles in correspondence with the fault current. If the limit value is ex-
ceeded, a respective indication is generated.
In case of an internal protective tripping, the start criterion is complied with by means of generation
of the group indication "Device OFF" (D-OFF).
An externally initiated trip command can be taken into consideration if it is sent simultaneously via
a binary input on the message „>2P start“ (FNo. 16019). As a further initiation criterion the edge of
the coming indication „>Brk Aux NC“ (FNo. 4602) can be used as it is herewith signalled that the
mechanism of the circuit breaker has been set in motion to separate the contact.
As soon as the start criterion has been fulfilled, the parameterised operating time on tripping is
started. The time of commencement of separation of the circuit breaker contacts is thus deter-
mined. The end of the trip procedure, including arc deletion is determined via another given pa-
rameter (CB tripping time) supplied by the manufacturer of the circuit breaker.
In order to prevent an incorrect calculation procedure in case of circuit breaker failure, the current
criterion BkrClosed I MIN (address 251) verifies whether the current was actually switched off after
expiry of the CB tripping time. When the logic release is fulfilled by the current criterion, the calcu-
lation and evaluation methods are initiated. After these have been completed, the end criterion of
the 2P-procedure of the circuit breaker maintenance is fulfilled and ready for a new initiation.
It should be noted that the 2P-procedure is blocked in case of parameterisation errors. This state
is signalled via the indications „2P T sett.fail“ (FNo. 16020), „2P blk n PaErr“ (FNo. 16028) or „2P
blk I PaErr“ (FNo. 16027).
2P Calculation The application of the two-point procedure for the calculation of the remaining lifespan depends
on the 2P configuration.
The CB manufacturer supplies a double-log diagram on the relation between the number of oper-
ating cycles and fault currents (see example in figure 2-61). This picture also serves to determine
the still possible trips (in case of a trip with the same fault current). Considering this example, ap-
proximately 1000 trips can be executed for a fault current of 10kA. The characteristic is determined
by two vertices and the linking straight line. Point P1 is determined by the number of permitted
operating cycles for the rated normal current Ir, point P2 by the maximum number of operating
cycles for the rated short-circuit current Isc. The corresponding four values can be parameterised.
As figure 2-61 shows a double-log diagram, the straight line between P1 and P2 can be expressed
by the following exponential function:
n = b·Ibm
where:
Ib Fault current
m Direction coefficient
The general straight-line equation for the double-log diagram can be derived from the exponential
function, from which the coefficients b and m can be derived.
Note
As the directional coefficient of m < -4 is technically not relevant, but can nevertheless be derived
from an incorrect parameterisation, it is limited to -4. Should the derived coefficient fall below -4,
the exponential function in the operating cycle diagram is deactivated and, i.e. within its defined
fault current range, the maximum number of operating cycles for Isc (263 OP.CYCLES Isc) is con-
sidered as a calculation result of current operating cycles, see figure 2-62.
If the start release is now given by the criteria as described in section "Initiation" and the current
criterion is fulfilled at the same time after expiry of the operating time on tripping, the actual fault
current is calculated (for the AT system: the fault currents), the breaker load is determined in ac-
cordance with the method as described above and the remaining lifespan is thus calculated. It will
be displayed as a current statistical value and additionally compared with the set limit value.
Should it fall below the set limit value, the indiciation „Thresh.R.Endu.<“ (FNo. 16010) is generated.
All trips during which the fault current fell below the value of the current criterion (see section "Ini-
tiation") are interpreted as purely mechanical trips and are not included in the 2P-procedure. All
trips counted in this manner can be retrieved under the statistical value „mechan.TRIP=“ (FNo.
16011).
General The determination of the circuit breaker load in accordance with the It or 2P-procedure can only
operate if you have set address 141 FCT It-Calc. to Start by Aux or Start by TRIP during configura-
tion of the functional scope. Additionally, the It FUNCTION in address 4101 and via the binary
inputs „>It ON“ (FNo. 13845) and „>It OFF“ (FNo. 13846) ON— and OFF can be set. When the
function is switched on, the indication „It ACTIVE“ (FNo. 13850) or „2P ACTIVE“ (FNo. 13857) is
generated.
IT Procedure The following paragraphs apply to the IT procedure, however, not to the 2P-procedure. This is set
out in detail in the following.
When setting the parameter (address 141) that configures the functions, you select at the same
time the method for determining the starting time tstart of the It procedure. If the circuit breaker
auxiliary contacts are connected to the device, select method Start by Aux.
Time Difference CB This setting is only needed if you have selected the method Start by Aux when configuring the It
Main and Auxiliary procedure.
Contact
The moment of opening of the circuit breaker main contact can only be determined indirectly by
acquisition of the circuit breaker auxiliary contacts. In the 7ST6 device the indication „>Brk Aux
NC“ (FNo. 4602) is used for this purpose. The circuit breaker main contact may open before or
after the circuit breaker auxiliary contact. The time difference between the switching of these two
contacts is set with the parameter DELTA AuxCont (address 4103). A positive value is set for this
time difference if the auxiliary contact opens or closes later than the main contact.
CB Response Time This setting is only needed if you have selected the method Start by TRIP when configuring the It
procedure.
The moment of opening of the circuit breaker main contact can only be determined indirectly by
means of a preset time difference between the TRIP command and the opening of the circuit
breaker main contacts. This time difference is set in address 4102 T00.
Circuit Breaker The current value I dt, which is accumulated over all trips, is a measure for the circuit breaker load
Alarm and can be used for planning the circuit breaker maintenance.
The limit for this measure of the circuit breaker load is set in address 4104 It ALARM. When the
threshold is reached, the alarm „It Alarm“ (FNo. 13847) is output.
2P-procedure This procedure, together with the It procedure, uses the same configuration parameter It
FUNCTION (address 141) under "Functional Scope" and the same activation parameter It
FUNCTION (address 4101) under "It Function".
All parameters relevant to this procedure are available in the parameter block P.System Data 1 (see
chapter 2.1.3).
The parameters listed below represent important input values for a correct functioning of the sub-
functions:
The circuit breaker tripping time T CB BREAKTIME is a parameter supplied by the CB manufac-
turer. It comprises the complete trip procedure from trip command (activation of auxiliary power
on the shunt opening release of the circuit breaker) to arc deletion. The time is set at address 237
T CB BREAKTIME.
The CB opening time T CB OPENING is also a parameter of the circuit breaker. It comprises the
time span between trip command (activation of auxiliary power on the trigger of the circuit breaker)
and the time of separation of the main contacts. This is configured at address 238 T CB OPENING.
As zero-sequence current criterion the current-flow monitoring BkrClosed I MIN (address 251) is
used.
The CB manufacturer defines the relation between the number of operating cycles and trip current
by means of an operating cycle diagram (see example diagram in the functional description of the
2P-procedure). Both vertices of this characteristic in double-log scale determine the parameteri-
sation of addresses 260 to 263:
Point P1 is determined by the number of permitted operating cycles (parameter 261 OP.CYCLES
AT Ir) during raised rated current Ir (parameter 260 Ir-CB).
Point P2 is determined by the maximum number of operating cycles (parameter 263 OP.CYCLES
Isc) during raised rated fault current Isc (parameter 262 Isc-CB).
For the functional operation of the procedure, the time behaviour of the circuit breaker via param-
eter 237 T CB BREAKTIME and 238 T CB OPENING must be announced.
2.15.4 Settings
The device 7ST6 incorporates comprehensive monitoring functions which cover both hardware
and software; the measured values are continuously checked for plausibility, so that the current
and voltage transformer circuits are also included in the monitoring system to a large extent. Fur-
thermore it is possible to implement a trip circuit supervision function by means of the available
binary inputs.
The device is monitored from the measuring inputs up to the command relays. Monitoring features
and the processor check the hardware for malfunctions and impermissible states.
Auxiliary and Refer- The processor voltage is monitored by the hardware, and if the voltage decreases below the
ence Voltages minimum value, the processor is no longer operative. In that case, the device is not operational.
When the supply voltage returns, the processor system is restarted.
If the supply voltage is removed or switched off, the device is taken out of service, and an indica-
tion is immediately generated by a normally closed contact. Brief voltage interruptions of up to 50
ms do not disturb the operational readiness of the device.
The processor monitors the offset and the reference voltage of the ADC (analog-to-digital convert-
er). The protection is suspended if the voltages deviate outside an allowable range, and lengthy
deviations are reported.
Battery The buffer battery, which ensures the operation of the internal clock and the storage of counters
and indications if the auxiliary voltage fails, is periodically checked for charge status. On its under-
shooting a minimum admissible voltage, the indication „Fail Battery“ (FNo. 177) is issued.
If the device is isolated from the auxiliary voltage, the internal clock is switched off after 6 hours at
the earliest automatically (normally after over 24 hours), i.e. the time is not registered any more.
The data in the event and fault buffers, however, remain stored.
Memory Compo- All working memories (RAMs) are checked during start-up. If an error occurs, the start-up is abort-
nents ed, the Error LED and LED 1 light up, and the other LEDs start flashing simultaneously. During
operation, the memory is checked using its checksum.
For the program memory (EPROM), the cross-checksum is cyclically generated and compared to
a stored reference program cross-checksum.
A checksum for the parameter memory (FLASH-EPROM) is cyclically generated and compared
with the checksum which is computed after each change of the stored parameters.
Sampling Frequen- The sampling frequency and the synchronism between the ADCs is continuously monitored. If any
cy deviations cannot be removed by renewed synchronization, then the processor system is restart-
ed.
Watchdog For continuous monitoring of the program sequences, a watchdog timer is provided in the hard-
ware (hardware watchdog) which will reset and completely restart the processor system in the
event of processor failure or if a program falls out of step.
A further software watchdog ensures that any error in the processing of the programs will be rec-
ognized. This also initiates a restart of the processor system.
If such a malfunction is not cleared by the restart, an additional restart attempt is begun. If the fault
is still present after three restart attempts within 30 s, the protection system will take itself out of
service, and the red LED “ERROR” lights up. The Device OK relay drops off and signals the mal-
function by its life contact.
Ambient Tempera- If ambient temperature sensing by an external device has been configured, the functioning of the
ture Sensing ambient temperature sensing is monitored. In case of malfunctions (ambient temperature sensing
missing or defective, broken connection wire to the device or to the temperature sensor), the indi-
cation „Fail.TEMPSENS“ (FNo. 158) is generated.
In the event of measured voltage failure due to a short circuit or a broken conductor in the voltage
transformer secondary circuit, certain measuring loops may mistakenly see a voltage of zero,
which due to the load current may result in an unwanted pickup or even trip.
If fuses are used instead of a secondary miniature circuit breaker (VT mcb) with connected auxil-
iary contacts, then the fuse failure monitoring can detect problems in the voltage transformer sec-
ondary circuit. Of course the miniature circuit breaker and the fuse failure monitor can be used at
the same time.
A fuse failure is characterized by missing voltages but flowing current. Figure 2-64 shows the logic
diagram of the fuse failure monitor.
The voltage drop is detected when the voltage drops below 5 V while an operating current
between 0.06 In and 1.2 In is flowing. Currents above 1.2 In are considered not as normal oper-
ating currents but as short-circuit currents.
If a measuring-circuit voltage failure is detected, the distance and the undervoltage protection
function are blocked after expiry of an overfunction protection period of 5 sec. The emergency
overcurrent-time protection is activated, provided that it has been configured accordingly (see
Section 2.5).
In order to avoid triggering of the Fuse-Failure-Monitoring in case of a network error, the Fuse-
Failure-Monitor is only triggered by a non-recognised current step. A network error always occurs
in conjunction with a current step. The Fuse-Failure Monitor remains blocked for 10 s after trigger-
ing of the jump detector.
The distance and overvoltage protection is only activated again on returning measuring-circuit
voltage or reducing current on less than 6 % of IN.
Fuse Failure With the parameter MEASURE. SUPERV (address 2901) fuse failure monitoring can either be
Monitor switched off or operated in one of the two possible operating modes. If the parameter is set to
Without FFM, a fuse failure (failure of the measuring voltage) is always detected when the voltage
has dropped below 5 V while at the same time an operating current is flowing. This setting should
be chosen if it has been ensured that the short-circuit currents occurring at the device amounts to
at least 1.2 In. With the setting Without FFM, a fuse failure is detected with a delay of 5 s.
If this is not the case, select the setting With FFM. With this setting, the device also checks
whether a non-steady process is detected in the current path at the same time as the voltage dip.
In this case a fuse failure will not be detected until 10 s after the voltage dip, provided that the cur-
rents are in the operating current range.
2.16.5 Settings
Trip Circuit Supervi- The overhead contact line protection 7ST6 is equipped with an integrated trip circuit supervision.
sion Depending on the number of available binary inputs (not connected to a common potential), mon-
itoring with one or two binary inputs can be selected. If the allocation of the required binary inputs
does not match the selected monitoring mode, a corresponding alarm is issued („TripC1 Prog-
FAIL“). When using two binary inputs, malfunctions in the trip circuit can be detected under all
circuit breaker conditions. When only one binary input is used, malfunctions in the circuit breaker
itself cannot be detected.
Supervision with When using two binary inputs, these are connected according to Figure 2-65, parallel to the asso-
Two Binary Inputs ciated trip contact on one side, and parallel to the circuit breaker auxiliary contacts on the other.
A precondition for the use of the trip circuit supervision is that the control voltage for the circuit
breaker is higher than the total of the minimum voltages drops at the two binary inputs (UCtrl > 2
UBImin). Since at least 19 V are needed for each binary input, the monitor can only be used with a
system control voltage of over 38 V.
Figure 2-65 Principle of trip circuit monitoring with two binary inputs
Monitoring with two binary inputs not only detects interruptions in the trip circuit and loss of control
voltage, it also monitors the response of the circuit breaker using the position of the circuit breaker
auxiliary contacts.
Depending on the conditions of the trip contact and the circuit breaker, the binary inputs are acti-
vated (logical condition „H“ in the following table), or short-circuited (logical condition „L“).
A state in which both binary inputs are not activated („L“) is only possible in healthy trip circuits for
a short transition period (trip relay contact closed but circuit breaker not yet open).
A continuous state of this condition is only possible when the trip circuit has been interrupted, a
short-circuit exists in the trip circuit, a loss of battery voltage occurs, or malfunctions occur with the
circuit breaker mechanism. Therefore, it is used as monitoring criterion.
Table 2-7 Condition table for binary inputs, depending on RTC and CB position
No Trip Contact Circuit Breaker Aux 1 Aux 2 BI 1 BI 2
.
1 Open CLOSE Closed Open H L
2 Open OPEN Open Closed H H
3 Closed CLOSE Closed Open L L
4 Closed OPEN Open Closed L H
The conditions of the two binary inputs are checked periodically. A query takes place about every
500 ms. If three consecutive conditional checks detect an abnormality, an alarm is output (see
Figure 2-66). The repeated measurements determine the delay of the fault indication and avoid
that an alarm is output during short transition periods. After the fault in the trip circuit is removed,
the alarm is reset automatically after the same time (approx. 1.5 s).
Figure 2-66 Logic diagram of the trip circuit supervision with two binary inputs
Supervision with The binary input is connected in parallel to the respective command relay contact of the protection
One Binary Input device according to Figure 2-67. The circuit breaker auxiliary contact is bridged with a high-ohm
substitute resistor R.
The control voltage for the circuit breaker should be at least twice as high as the minimum voltage
drop at the binary input (UCtrl > 2 UBImin). Since at least 19 V are needed for the binary input, the
monitor can be used with a system control voltage of over 38 V.
A calculation example for the resistance shunt R is shown in the configuration notes in Section
„Mounting and Connections“, margin heading „Trip Circuit Supervision“.
Figure 2-67 Principle of trip circuit monitoring with one binary input
In normal operation, the binary input is energized when the trip relay contact is open and the trip
circuit is healthy (logic state „H“), as the monitoring circuit is closed via the auxiliary contact (if the
circuit breaker is closed) or via the substitute resistor R. Only as long as the trip contact is closed,
the binary input is short circuited and thereby deactivated (logical condition „L“).
If the binary input is permanently deactivated during operation, an interruption in the trip circuit or
a failure of the (trip) control voltage can be assumed.
Because the trip circuit supervision does not operate during system faults, a closed tripping
contact does not lead to a fault indication. If however other trip relay contacts from different
devices are connected in parallel in the trip circuit, the fault indication must be delayed by Alarm
Delay (see also Figure 2-68). After the fault in the trip circuit is removed, the indication is reset au-
tomatically after approx. 1.5 s.
Figure 2-68 Logic diagram of trip circuit monitoring with one binary input
General This function is only effective and available if address 140 Trip Cir. Sup. has been set to Enabled
during configuration.
If you do not want to use the trip circuit supervision, set Disabled.
The trip circuit supervision can be switched ON or OFF in address 4001 FCT TripSuperv..
The number of binary inputs that shall be used in each of the monitored circuits is set in address
4002 No. of BI. If the allocation of the required binary inputs does not match the selected monitor-
ing mode, a corresponding indication is issued („TripC1 ProgFAIL“).
Monitoring with The alarm for monitoring with two binary inputs is always delayed by approx. 1 s to 2 s, whereas
One Binary Input the delay time of the alarm for monitoring with one binary input can be set in address 4003 Alarm
Delay. 1 s to 2 s are sufficient if only the 7ST6 device is connected to the trip circuits as the trip
circuit supervision does not operate during a system fault.
If, however, trip contacts from other devices are connected in parallel in the trip circuit, the alarm
must be delayed such that the longest trip command duration can be reliably bridged.
2.17.3 Settings
The function logic coordinates the sequence of both the protective and ancillary functions, pro-
cesses the functional decisions, and data received from the system.
2.18.1 General
- Pickup logic
- Tripping logic
- Switching statistics
During energization of the protected object, several measures may be required or desirable. Fol-
lowing a manual closure onto a short-circuit, immediate trip of the circuit breaker is usually re-
quired. In the distance protection for example, this is implemented by a special tripping logic for
manual reclosure that can be selected with the parameter SOTF zone (address 1232). For exam-
ple, the zone can be activated for a short period. In addition at least one stage of each short-circuit
protection function can be selected to trip without time delay following manual closure as de-
scribed in the corresponding sections. Also see Subsection 2.1.5.1 at margin heading „Circuit
Breaker Status“.
The manual closing command must be indicated to the device via a binary input. In order to be
independent of the duration that the switch is closed, the command is set to a defined length in
the device (adjustable with the address 1150 SI Time Man.Cl). Figure 2-69 shows the logic dia-
gram.
If the device has an integrated automatic reclosure, the integrated manual closure logic of the
7ST6 automatically distinguishes between an external control command via the binary input and
an automatic reclosure by the internal automatic reclosure so that the binary input „>Manual Close“
can be connected directly to the control circuit of the trip coil of the circuit breaker (Figure 2-70).
Each reclosure that is not initiated by the internal automatic reclosure function is interpreted as a
manual reclosure, even it has been initiated by a control command from the device.
If, however, external close commands which should not activate the manual close function are
possible, e.g. external reclosure device, the binary input „>Manual Close“ must be triggered by a
separate contact at the control discrepancy switch (Figure 2-71).
If in that latter case a manual close command can also be given by means of an internal control
command from the device, such a command must be combined with the manual CLOSE function
via a CFC chart. To do so, use the priority class for switchgear interlocking and the block CMD_INF
to derive a logic signal from the switchgear control command. The „>Manual Close“ must not be
configured to a binary input in this case. Define this signal as a CFC output signal and add a new
indication to the DIGSI matrix. Use this new binary signal for detection of the manual close signal,
and link it in the CFC chart with an OR gate to the output signal of the CMD_INF block. Now you
connect the output signal of this OR gate with the signal „>Manual Close“ on the right-hand margin
of the CFC chart.
Depending on the configuration of the distance protection, an undelayed trip command can be
generated after energisation for each pickup or for pickup in . The line energisation recognition
function is also used by the stages of the overcurrent protection.
Blocking of Under- In configurations with voltage transformers on the line-side and single-side infeed, no voltage is
voltage Protection measured after tripping of the line. If activated, the undervoltage protection would in such a case
cause a spurious trip. In this condition it would no longer be possible to energize the line, since
the presence of a TRIP command from the undervoltage protection would prevent energization.
To identify such situations, 7ST6 devices are provided with a residual current detection which
blocks the undervoltage protection if the currents drop below a specified threshold of 0.05 In. As
soon as a significant current level (I>0.05 In) is measured on the line, the line is assumed to be
energized, and the blocking is reset.
For Protection Pur- Several protection and auxiliary functions require information on the status of the circuit breaker
poses for proper functioning. This is, for example, of assistance for
• The automatic reclosure (refer to Section 2.12),
• The It (refer to Section 2.15)
The device is provided with the signals for detection of the circuit breaker auxiliary contacts. The
above functions assumes the circuit breaker auxiliary contacts to be wired if these signals have
been configured to binary inputs. Therefore, signals for non-wired feedback information must not
be configured to a binary input.
For Trip Circuit Su- For these functions separate binary inputs with information on the circuit breaker position are
pervision and available.
Switch Objects
Pickup Indications The fault detection logic combines the fault detection (pick-up) signals of all protection functions.
The group alarms „Relay PU“ and„Protection PU“ are available respectively for a general device
pickup and a general pickup of the protection functions.
The above indications can be allocated to LEDs or output relays. They can also be used for local
display, and for transfer of the indications to a personal computer or a control centre.
General Device The pickup signals are combined with OR and lead to a general pickup of the protection device.
Pickup It is signaled with the alarm „Protection PU“. If no protection function of the device has picked up
any longer, „Protection PU“ disappears (indication: „OFF“).
The general pickup is a prerequisite for a number of internal and external consequential functions.
The following are among the internal functions controlled by general device pickup:
• Start of trip log: From general device pickup to general device dropout, all fault indications are
entered in the trip log.
• Initialization of oscillographic records: The storage and maintenance of fault values can also be
made dependent on the occurrence of a trip command.
External functions may be controlled by this indication via an output contact. Examples are:
• Automatic reclose devices.
• Channel boost in conjunction with signal transmission by PLC.
• Further additional devices or similar.
Spontaneous Indi- Spontaneous indications are fault indications which appear in the display automatically following
cations a general fault detection or trip command of the device. In the case of 7ST6 they are the following:
„PU Time“: Operating time from the general pickup to the dropout of the
device, in ms;
„TRIP Time“: Operating time from general pickup to the first trip command of
the device, the time is given in ms;
TRIP Command Just like for pickup, a group alarm exists for the device TRIP command.
General Trip All trip signals for the protective functions are connected by OR and generate the indication
„Protection TRIP“. This can be allocated to LED or output relay.
Terminating the Trip A trip command once transmitted is stored (see Figure 2-72). At the same time, the minimum trip
Signal command duration TMin TRIP CMD is started. This ensures that the command is transmitted to
the circuit breaker for a sufficient amount of time, even if the function which issued the trip signal
drops out quickly. The trip commands can only be terminated when the last protection function
dropped out, i.e. functions no longer pick up, AND the minimum trip signal duration expired.
A further condition for terminating the trip command is that the circuit breaker is recognized to be
open. The function control of the device checks this by evaluating the current flow. It assumes that
a current of 0.05 In will certainly be undershot with the circuit breaker open. The figure below
shows the logic diagram for this.
Reclosure Inter- When tripping the circuit breaker by a protection function the manual reclosure must often be
locking blocked until the cause for the protection function operation is found. 7ST6 enables this via the
integrated reclosure interlocking.
Conditions which cause reclosure interlocking and control commands which have to be inter-
locked can be set individually. The two inputs and the output can be wired via the correspondingly
allocated binary inputs and outputs or be linked via user-defined logic functions (CFC).
If, for example, each trip by the protection function has to cause a reclosure lock-out, then combine
the tripping command „Protection TRIP“ (FNo. 13992) with the binary input „>Lockout SET“. If,
however, automatic reclosure is applied, only the final trip of the protection function should activate
reclosing lock-out. Combine in this case the output alarm „Final Trip“ (FNo. 536) with the interlock-
ing input „>Lockout SET“, so that the interlocking function is not established when an automatic
reclosure is still expected to come. Please bear in mind that the alarm „Final Trip“ (FNo. 536) is
only present for 500 ms.
With the output alarm „LOCKOUT“ (FNo. 530) it is possible in the most simple case to allocate to
the output, which trips the circuit-breaker, without creating further links. Then the tripping
command is maintained until the interlock is reset via the binary reset input. Naturally it has to be
ensured in advance that the close coil at the circuit breaker — as is usually done — is blocked as
long as a tripping command is maintained.
The output alarm „LOCKOUT“ can also be applied to interlock certain closing commands (exter-
nally or via CFC), e.g. by combining the output alarm with the binary input „>CloseCmd.Blo“ (FNo.
357) or by connecting the inverted alarm with the bay interlocking of the branch.
The reset input „>Lockout RESET“ (FNo. 386) resets the interlocking state. This input is initiated
by an external device which is protected against unauthorized or unintentional operation. The in-
terlocking state can also be controlled by internal sources using CFC, e.g. a function key, opera-
tion of the device or using DIGSI® on a PC.
For each case please make sure that the corresponding logical combinations, security measures,
etc. are taken into account for the routing of the binary inputs and outputs and are also considered
for the setting of user-defined logic functions, if necessary. See also SIPROTEC® 4 System De-
scription, Order No. E50417-H1176-C151.
Breaker Tripping Since every trip command issued by a protection function on feeders without automatic reclosure
Alarm Suppression is definite, it is desirable, when using automatic reclosure, to prevent the operation detector of the
circuit-breaker (transient contact on the breaker) from sending an alarm if the trip of the breaker
is not final (Figure 2-74).
For this purpose, the signal from the circuit-breaker is routed via a correspondingly allocated
output contact of the 7ST6 (output alarm „CB Alarm Supp“, FNo. 563). In the idle state and when
the device is turned off, this contact is closed. Therefore an output contact with a normally open
contact (NO contact) has to be allocated. Which contact is to be allocated is dependent on the
device version. Refer to the general views in the Appendix.
Prior to the command, with the internal automatic reclosure in the ready state, the contact opens
so that no signal from the circuit-breaker is forwarded. This is only the case if the device is
equipped with internal automatic reclosure and if the latter was taken into consideration when con-
figuring the protection functions (address 133 Auto Reclose).
This contact is also opened when closing the breaker via the binary input „>Manual Close“ (FNo.
356), so that no breaker alarm can pass there either.
Further optional closing commands which are not sent via the device cannot be taken into consid-
eration. Closing commands for control can be linked to the alarm suppression via the user-defined
logic functions (CFC).
If the device issues a final trip command, the contact remains closed. This is the case, during the
reclaim time of the automatic reclosure cycle, when the automatic reclosure is blocked or switched
off or, due to other reasons is not ready for automatic reclosure, e.g. tripping only occurred after
the action time expired.
Figure 2-75 shows time diagrams for manual trip and close as well as for short-circuit tripping with
a single, failed automatic reclosure cycle.
Trip-Dependent In- The recording of indications masked to local LEDs, and the maintenance of spontaneous indica-
dications tions, can be made dependent on whether the device has issued a trip signal. This information is
then not output if during a system disturbance one or more protection functions have picked up,
but no tripping by the 7ST6 resulted because the fault was cleared by a different device, e.g. on
another line. These indications are then limited to faults in the line to be protected.
Statistics The number of trips initiated by the device 7ST6 are counted.
Following each trip command the device registers the value of each current phase that was
switched off. This information is then provided in the trip log and summated in a register. The
squared interrupted current values are also summated. The maximum interrupted current is stored
as well. Moreover, the device has a separately configurable It function to determine the circuit
breaker trip load.
If the device is equipped with the integrated automatic reclosure, the automatic close commands
are also counted, separately for the first reclosure cycle and other reclosure cycles.
The counter and memory levels are secured against loss of auxiliary voltage. They can be set to
zero or to any other initial value. For more details, refer to the SIPROTEC® 4 System Description,
Order No. E50417-H1100-C151.
2.18.1.5 Pickup of the Automatic Test Unit for the Overhead Contact Line (only for 16.7 Hz)
For the pickup of the automatic test unit for the overhead contact line, the indication „Pckup
TstUnit“ (FNo. 1191) is available in the 7ST6.
This indication is output on the event „General protective TRIP of device (Protection TRIP)“ (FNo.
13992).
In addition, the indication „Pckup TstUnit“ (FNo. 1191) is output if, following a TRIP command by
the overload protection, „ThOverload TRIP“ (FNo. 1521), the closing temperature is undershot, i.e.
the inrush blocking „O/L blocked“ (FNo. 13825) is reset.
The indication „Pckup TstUnit“ stays activated for at least 200 ms and is reset after this time, pro-
vided that no TRIP command by one of the following functions is present:
• Distance protection
• High-Speed overcurrent protection
• Overcurrent protection
• Emergency overcurrent protection
• Thermal overload protection
• CB test
Figure 2-76 Start of the automatic overhead contact line check following TRIP commands by
the overload protection
If the thermal overload protection is active, the event „General protective TRIP of device (Protection
TRIP)“ (FNo. 13992) leads to a start of the automatic overhead contact line check, if no overload
inrush blocking „O/L blocked“ (FNr. 13825) is active.
Figure 2-77 Start of automatic overhead contact line check at thermal overload protection
Command Duration The setting of the minimum trip signal duration TMin TRIP CMD (address 240) was already dis-
cussed in Subsection 2.1.3. This duration is valid for all protection functions which can issue a trip
command.
2.18.2 Testing
The numerical overhead contact line protection 7ST6 allows an easy check of the trip circuits and
the circuit breakers.
The output alarms mentioned must be allocated to the relevant command relays that are used for
controlling the circuit breaker coils.
The test is started using the operator panel on the front of the device or using the PC with DIGSI®.
The procedure is described in detail in the SIPROTEC® 4 System Description, Order No. E50417-
H1176-C151. Figure 2-78 shows the chronological sequence of one TRIP–CLOSE test cycle. The
set times are those stated in Subsection 2.1.3.1 for „Trip command Duration“ and „Circuit Breaker
Test“.
Where the circuit breaker auxiliary contacts indicate the status of the circuit breaker or of its poles
to the device via binary inputs, the test cycle can only be initiated if the circuit breaker is closed.
The alarms of the device show the respective state of the test sequence.
The set times are those stated in Subsection 2.1.3.1 under margin heading „Manual Close“.
The general functions of the device are described in chapter "Additional Functions".
After the occurrence of a system fault, data regarding the response of the protective relay and the
measured quantities should be saved for future analysis. For this reason indications are pro-
cessed in three ways.
LED Display and Important events and statuses are displayed using front panel LEDs. The device furthermore has
Binary Outputs output relays for remote indication. Most indications and displays can be configured differently
(Output Relays) from the delivery default settings (for information on the delivery default setting see Appendix).
The procedure is described in detail in the SIPROTEC® 4 System Description (Order No. E50417-
H1176-C151).
The output relays and the LEDs may be operated in a latched or unlatched mode (each may be
individually set).
The latched conditions are protected against loss of the auxiliary voltage. They are reset
• On site by pressing the LED key on the relay,
• Remotely using a binary input configured for that purpose,
• Using one of the serial interfaces,
• Automatically at the beginning of a new pickup.
Condition indications should not be latched. Also, they cannot be reset until the condition to be
reported has been cancelled. This applies to e.g. indications from monitoring functions, or the like.
A green LED displays operational readiness of the relay („RUN“), and cannot be reset. It extin-
guishes if the self-check feature of the microprocessor recognizes an abnormal occurrence, or if
the auxiliary voltage fails.
When auxiliary voltage is present, but the relay has an internal malfunction, then the red LED
(„ERROR“) lights up and the processor blocks the relay.
DIGSI® enables you to control selectively each output relay and LED of the device and, in doing
so, check the correct connection to the system. In a dialog box you can, for instance, cause each
output relay to pick up, and thus test the wiring between the 7ST6 and the station, without having
to create the indications masked to it.
Fast Binary Outputs The device 7ST6 has the fast binary outputs (output relays) BO1 and BO2. These binary outputs
(Output Relays) have extra short switching times. When used for TRIP commands, these binary outputs allow to
achieve very short trip times.
These fast trip times are possible by a parallel connection of relays and semiconductor switches.
The semiconductor switch has the task of switching the output on and off. The relay contact carries
the continuous current and opens shortly before the semiconductor switch drops out. This helps
to avoid erosion of the relay contacts, and thus to prolong the service life of these binary outputs.
This procedure leads to a defined contact opening delay of 8 ms.
In all other respects, the properties of the fast binary outputs are the same as the general proper-
ties of the binary outputs described above.
Information on the Events and conditions can be read out on the display on the front cover of the relay. Using the front
Integrated Display PC interface or the rear service interface, for instance, a personal computer can be connected, to
(LCD) or to a Per- which the information can be sent.
sonal Computer
In the quiescent state, i.e. as long as no system fault is present, the LCD can display selectable
operational information (overview of the operational measured values) (default display). In the
event of a system fault, information regarding the fault, the so-called spontaneous indications, are
displayed instead. After the fault indications have been acknowledged, the quiescent data are
shown again. Acknowledgement can be performed by pressing the LED buttons on the front panel
(see above).
The device in addition has several event buffers for operational indications, fault indications,
switching statistics, etc., which are saved against loss of auxiliary supply by means of a battery
buffer. These indications can be displayed on the LCD at any time by selection using the keypad
or transferred to a personal computer via the serial service or PC interface. The retrieval of indi-
cations during operation is extensively described in the SIPROTEC® 4 System Description, Order
No. E50417-H1176-C151).
After a fault on the system, for example, important information about the progression of the fault
can be retrieved, such as the pickup of a protective element or the initiation of a trip signal. The
start of the fault is time stamped with the absolute time of the internal system clock. The progress
of the disturbance is output with a relative time referred to the instant of fault detection, so that the
duration of the fault until tripping and up to reset of the trip command can be ascertained. The res-
olution of the time information is 1 ms.
With a PC and the DIGSI® protection data processing software it is also possible to retrieve and
display the events with the convenience of visualization on a monitor and a menu-guided dialog.
The data may either be printed or stored for evaluation at a later time and place.
The protection device stores the indications of the last eight system faults; in the event of a ninth
fault, the oldest is erased.
A system fault starts with the recognition of the fault by the fault detection of any protection func-
tion and ends with the reset of the fault detection of the last protection function or after the expiry
of the auto-reclose reclaim time, so that several unsuccessful auto-reclose cycles are also stored
cohesively. Accordingly a system fault may contain several individual fault events (from fault de-
tection up to reset of fault detection).
Information to a If the device has a serial system interface, stored information may additionally be transferred via
Control Centre this interface to a centralized control and storage device. Transmission is possible using different
transmission protocols.
You may test whether the indications are transmitted correctly with DIGSI®.
Also the information transmitted to the control centre can be influenced during operation or tests.
The IEC 60870-5-103 protocol allows to identify all indications and measured values transferred
to the central control system with an added indication „test mode“ while the device is being tested
on site (test mode). This identification prevents the indications from being incorrectly interpreted
as resulting from an actual power system disturbance or event. Alternatively, you may disable the
transmission of indications to the system interface during tests („Transmission block“).
To influence information at the system interface during test mode („Test mode“ and „Transmission
block“) a CFC logic is required. Default settings already include this logic (see Appendix).
The SIPROTEC® 4 System Description describes in detail how to activate and deactivate test
mode and blocked data transmission.
A complete list of all indication and output functions that can be generated by the device with the
maximum functional scope can be found in the Appendix. All functions are associated with an in-
formation number (FNo). It also indicates where each indication can be sent to. If functions are not
present in the specific version of the device, or if they are set to disable, then the associated indi-
cations cannot appear.
Operational Indica- Operational indications contain information that the device generates during operation and on op-
tions (Buffer: Event erational conditions.
Log)
Up to 200 operational indications are recorded in chronological order in the device. Newly gener-
ated indications are added to those already there. When the maximum capacity of the memory is
exhausted, the oldest indication is lost.
Operational indications come in automatically and can be read out from the device display or a
personal computer. Faults in the power system are indicated with „Network Fault“ and the consec-
utive fault number. The fault indications contain detailed information on the behaviour of the power
system fault.
Fault Indications Following a system fault, it is possible, for example, to retrieve important information regarding its
(Buffer: Trip Log) progress, such as pickup and trip. The start of the fault is time stamped with the absolute time of
the internal system clock. The progress of the disturbance is output with a relative time referred to
the instant of fault detection, so that the duration of the fault until tripping and up to reset of the trip
command can be ascertained. The resolution of the time information is 1 ms.
A system fault starts with the recognition of the fault by the fault detection, i.e. first pickup of any
protection function, and ends with the reset of the fault detection, i.e. dropout of the last protection
function. Where fault causes several protective functions to pick up, the fault is considered to
include all that occurred between pickup of the first protective function and dropout of the last pro-
tective function.
Spontaneous Indi- After a fault, the most important data of the fault are displayed automatically without any further
cations operating actions in the sequence displayed below after a general device pickup:
Retrievable Indica- The indications of the last eight faults can be retrieved and output. In total 600 indications can be
tions recorded. Oldest indications are erased for newest fault indications when the buffer is full.
Spontaneous Indi- Spontaneous indications contain information on new incoming indication. Each new incoming in-
cations dication appears immediately, i.e. the user does not have to wait for an update or initiate one. This
can be a useful help during operation, testing and commissioning.
Spontaneous indications can be read out via DIGSI®. You will find more details in the SIPROTEC®
4 System Description (Order No. E50417-H1176-C151).
General Interroga- The present condition of a SIPROTEC® 4 device can be examined with DIGSI® by viewing the
tion contents of the General Interrogation. All indications requiring general interrogation are displayed
with their present value.
2.19.2 Measurement
Display of Mea- For local retrieval, or for data transmission via system interface, measured values and resulting
sured Values computed values are continuously available. The operational measured values can be read out
as secondary, primary or percent values. The measured values can only be correctly displayed if
the transformer ratings are entered completely and correctly.
Calculation of Mea- In auto-transformer systems, the active and reactive power is calculated from the currents and
sured Values voltages of the overhead contact line and the negative feeder. The operating impedance and the
load angle are calculated using the overhead contact line voltage and the summation current.
Depending on the ordering code, connection type to the device and the configured protection func-
tion, only some of the listed operational measured values in Table may be available.
2.19.3 Statistics
The number of trips initiated by 7ST6, the accumulated interrupted currents resulting from trips
initiated by protection functions and the number of close commands initiated by the auto-reclosure
function are counted.
Counters and Mem- The counters and memories of the statistics are saved by the device. Therefore the information
ories will not get lost in case the auxiliary voltage supply fails. The counters, however, can be reset back
to zero or to any value within the setting range.
Switching statistics can be viewed on the LCD of the device, or on a PC running DIGSI® and con-
nected to the operating or service interface.
A password is not required to read counter and stored values but is required to change or delete
them. You will find more details in the SIPROTEC® 4 System Description (Order No. E50417-
H1176-C151).
Number of Trips The number of trips initiated by the device 7ST6 are counted.
Number of Auto- If the device is equipped with the integrated automatic reclosure, the automatic close commands
matic Reclosing are also counted separately for the first reclosure cycle and other reclosure cycles.
Commands
Interrupted Cur- Following each trip command the device registers the value of each current phase that was
rents switched off. This information is then provided in the trip log and summated in a register. The
maximum interrupted current that was switched off is stored as well. The specified measured
values are primary values.
For the last trip, the value of the current-time integral and the squared current-time integral I2t are
output and separately summated.
Readout/Set- The SIPROTEC® 4 System Description describes how to read out the statistical counters using
ting/Resetting the device front panel or DIGSI®. Setting or resetting of these statistical counters takes place
under the menu item Annunciation -> STATISTIC by overwriting the counter values displayed.
The SIPROTEC 4 7ST6 includes a command processing function for initiating switching opera-
tions in the system.
Switchgear with single and multiple busbars are supported. The number of switchgear devices to
be controlled is limited only by the number of binary inputs and outputs present. High security
against inadvertent device operations can be ensured if interlocking checks are enabled. A stan-
dard set of optional interlocking checks is provided for each command issued to circuit break-
ers/switchgear.
Commands to the These are all commands that are directly output to the switchgear to change their process state:
Process • Commands for the operation of circuit breakers (asynchronous; or synchronized by applying
the synchronism check and closing control function) as well as commands for the control of iso-
lators and earth switches.
Device-internal These commands do not directly operate command outputs. They serve for initiating internal func-
Commands tions, for communicating the detection of status changes to the device or for acknowledging them.
• Manual override commands for „manual update“ of information on process-dependent objects
such as indications and switching states, e.g. if the communication with the process is interrupt-
ed. Manually overridden objects are flagged as such in the information status and can be dis-
played accordingly.
• Tagging commands are issued to „set“ the information values of internal objects, such as
switching authority (remote vs. local), parameter set changeover, data transmission block to the
SCADA interface, and measured value set-points.
• Acknowledgment and resetting commands for setting and resetting internal buffers or data
states.
• Information status commands to set/delete the additional „Information Status“ item of a process
object, such as
– Acquisition blocking,
– Output blocking.
Safety mechanisms in the command sequence ensure that a command can only be released after
a thorough check of preset criteria has been successfully concluded. Additionally, user-defined in-
terlocking conditions can be configured separately for each device. The actual execution of the
command is also monitored after its release. The entire sequence of a command is described
briefly in the following.
• Fixed commands:
– Internal process time (software watch dog which checks the time for processing the control
action between initiation of the control and final close of the relay contact);
– Configuration in process (if setting modification is in process, commands are rejected or de-
layed);
– Output block (if an output block has been programmed for the circuit breaker, and is active
at the moment the command is processed, then the command is rejected);
– Command in progress (only one command can be processed at a time for each circuit
breaker or switch);
– 1–of–n check (for multiple allocations such as common contact relays or multiple protection
commands configured to the same contact it is checked if a command procedure was
already initiated for the output relays concerned or if a protection command is present. Su-
perimposed commands in the same switching direction are tolerated).
2.20.1.3 Interlocking
Interlocking can be executed by the user-defined logic (CFC). Switchgear interlocking checks in
a SICAM/SIPROTEC 4 system are normally divided in the following groups:
• System interlocking checked by a central control system (for interbay interlocking),
• Zone controlled / bay interlocking checked in the bay device (for the feeder).
• Cross-bay interlocking via GOOSE messages directly between bay controllers and protection
relays (with rollout of IEC 61850; inter-relay communication by GOOSE messaging is per-
formed via the EN100 module)
System interlocking is based on the process image in the central device. Zone controlled / bay
interlocking relies on the object database (feedback information) of the bay unit (here the SIPRO-
TEC 4 relay) as was determined during configuration (see SIPROTEC 4 System Description).
The extent of the interlocking checks is determined by the configuration and interlocking logic of
the relay. For more information on GOOSE messaging, please refer to the SIPROTEC 4 System
Description.
Switching objects that require system interlocking in a central control system are marked by a spe-
cific parameter inside the bay unit (via configuration matrix).
For all commands, operation with interlocking (normal mode) or without interlocking (test mode)
can be selected:
• For local commands by reprogramming the settings with password check,
• For automatic commands, via command processing by CFC and Deactivated Interlocking Rec-
ognition,
• For local / remote commands, using an additional interlocking disable command via PROFIB-
US.
Interlocked/non-in- The configurable command checks in the SIPROTEC 4 devices are also called „standard inter-
terlocked Switching locking“. These checks can be activated via DIGSI (interlocked switching/tagging) or deactivated
(non-interlocked).
De-interlocked or non-interlocked switching means that the configured interlock conditions are not
tested.
Interlocked switching means that all configured interlocking conditions are checked within the
command processing. If a condition could not be fulfilled, the command will be rejected by an in-
dication with a minus added to it, e.g. „CO–“, followed by an operation response information. The
command is rejected if a synchronism check is carried out before closing and the conditions for
synchronism are not fulfilled. Table 2-10 shows some types of commands and indications. The in-
dications marked with *) are displayed only in the event logs on the device display; for DIGSI they
appear in spontaneous indications.
The plus sign in the indication is a confirmation of the command execution: The command output
has a positive result, as expected. A minus sign means a negative, i.e. an unexpected result; the
command was rejected. Figure 2-80 shows an example for successful switching of the circuit
breaker in the Event Log (command and feedback).
The check of interlocking can be programmed separately for all switching devices and tags that
were set with a tagging command. Other internal commands such as overriding or abort are not
tested, i.e. are executed independently of the interlockings.
Figure 2-80 Example of an operational indication for switching circuit breaker (Q0)
Standard Interlock- The standard interlocking includes the checks for each switchgear which were set during the con-
ing figuration of inputs and outputs, see SIPROTEC 4 System Description.
An overview for processing the interlocking conditions in the relay is shown in Figure 2-81.
The display shows the configured interlocking reasons. The are marked by letters as explained in
Table 2-11.
Figure 2-82 shows all interlocking conditions (which usually appear in the display of the device)
for three switchgear items with the relevant abbreviations explained in Table 2-11. All parameter-
ised interlocking conditions are indicated.
Control Logic via For bay interlocking, a release logic can be created using CFC. Via specific release conditions the
CFC information „released“ or „bay interlocked“ are available, e.g. object „Release CD Close“ and „Re-
lease CD Open“ with the information values: ON / OFF).
During the processing of commands, independently of the further allocation and processing of in-
dications, command and process feedbacks are sent to the indication processing. These indica-
tions contain information on the cause. With the corresponding allocation (configuration) these in-
dications are entered in the event log, thus serving as a report.
A listing of possible operational indications and their meaning, as well as the command types
needed for tripping and closing the switchgear or for raising and lowering transformer taps and
detailed information are described in the SIPROTEC 4 System Description.
Acknowledgement All indications with the source of command LOCAL are transformed into a corresponding re-
of Commands to the sponse and shown in the display of the device.
Device Front
Acknowledgement The acknowledgement of indications which relate to commands with the origin “Command Issued
of commands to lo- = Local/ Remote/DIGSI” are sent back to the initiating point independent of the routing (configu-
cal/remote/DIGSI ration on the serial digital interface).
Feedback monitor- Command processing time monitors all commands with feedback. Parallel to the command, a
ing monitoring time period (command runtime monitoring) is started which checks whether the switch-
gear has achieved the desired final state within this period. The monitoring time is stopped as soon
as the feedback information arrives. If no feedback information arrives, a response „Time Limit Ex-
pired“ appears and the process is terminated.
Commands and their feedbacks are also recorded as operational indications. Normally the exe-
cution of a command is terminated as soon as the feedback information (FB+) of the relevant
switchgear arrives or, in case of commands without process feedback information, the command
output resets.
In the feedback, the plus sign means that a command has been positively completed. The
command was as expected, in other words positive. The "minus" is a negative confirmation and
means that the command was not executed as expected.
Command out- The command types needed for tripping and closing of the switchgear or for raising and lowering
put/switching transformer taps have been defined during the configuration, see also SIPROTEC 4 System De-
relays scription.
2.20.4 Protocol
The following protocols are available for communication with the control system via the system
interface:
• IEC 60870-5-103
• PROFIBUS FMS
• PROFIBUS DP
• Modbus
• DNP 3.0
Note
A description of the profiles and the mapping files are included on the DIGSI® CD.
Depending on the device components (1– or 3–transformer), different measured values may be
displayed, for example, via the IEC 60870-5–103 protocol. The following table presents an over-
view.
1–transformer device
3–transformer device
The 2x25 kV (or 2x15 kV) system is used increasingly in a.c. power traction networks to enhance
the transmission properties. Additional auto-transformers and a so called negative feeder of 25 kV
(or 15 kV) potential are characteristic of this type of infeed. For this reason, two-pole switching
devices are necessary in the overhead contact line system.
General Since auto-transformer systems require current inputs for summation, they can only be imple-
mented in devices that feature 3 analog inputs each. It can be specified in parameter CURRENT
I1, I2 whether the protective function operates only with the overhead line current or with the sum-
mation current of overhead line and negative feeder. In the latter case, the two currents are de-
tected via separate transformers, vectorially added and in the further process treated as a mea-
sured quantity. Please consider also the polarity of the current transformer (current of the negative
feeder) at IF CT STARPOINT for determination of direction. The measured value connections can
be found in the Appendix at A.3. These settings apply to all functions, not including some excep-
tions.
All three currents (overhead line current, negative feeder current and the resulting summation cur-
rent) are generally available for detection and display of the operational measured values and fault
recording.
General In DIGSI® double-click on Settings to display the relevant selection. A dialog box with the tabs
General, Transformer data, System data, Voltage transformers and Circuit breaker will open under
Power System Data 1, in which you can configure the individual parameters. Thus, the following
subsections are structured accordingly.
Transformer Data At address 206 IF CT STARPOINT the polarity of the current transformers (negative feeder cur-
for Auto-transform- rent) must be stated. This setting determines the measuring direction of the device (forwards =
er Systems line direction).
The measured value connections can be found in the Appendix under A.3.
At address 207 IF CT PRIMARY you set the primary rated CT current (negative feeder current).
At addresses 209 UF PRIMARY and 210 UF SECONDARY, information regarding the primary and
secondary current ratings of the current transformers (negative feeder voltage) is entered.
General
WARNING!
Warning of improper transport, storage, installation or erection of the device.
Failure to observe these precautions can result in death, personal injury or substantial property
damage.
The successful and safe operation of this device is dependent on proper handling, storage, instal-
lation, operation, and maintenance.
Of particular importance are the general installation and safety regulations for work in a high-
voltage environment (for example, ANSI, IEC, EN, DIN, or other national and international regu-
lations). These regulations must be observed.
Prerequisites For mounting and connections the following conditions must be met:
The rated device data has been checked as recommended in the SIPROTEC® 4 System Descrip-
tion. The compliance of these data has been verified with the Power System Data.
Connection Vari- Outline diagrams are shown in Appendix A.2. Connection examples for the current and voltage
ants transformer circuits are given in the Appendix A.3. It must be checked that the setting configuration
of the P.System Data 1, Section 2.1.3.1, corresponds with the connections to the device.
Currents Appendix A.3 shows examples for the possibilities of the current transformer connections in de-
pendence on network conditions.
Voltages Connection examples for current and voltage transformer circuits are provided in Appendix A.3.
Binary Inputs and The connections to the system depend on the possible allocation of the binary inputs and outputs,
Outputs i.e. how they are assigned to the system. The preset allocation can be found in the tables in
Section A.5 of the Appendix. Check also whether the labelling corresponds to the allocated indi-
cation functions.
Changing Setting If binary inputs are used to change setting groups, please observe the following (please see also
Groups section 2.1.4:
• Two binary inputs must be dedicated to the purpose of changing setting groups when four
groups are to be switched. One binary input must be set for „>Set Group Bit0“, the other input
for „>Set Group Bit1“. If either of these input functions is not assigned, then it is considered as
not controlled.
• To control two setting groups, only one binary input is required, namely „>Set Group Bit0“, since
binary input „>Set Group Bit1“, which is not allocated, then is classified as “not controlled”.
• The status of the signals controlling the binary inputs to activate a particular setting group must
remain constant as long as that particular group is to remain active.
The following table shows the allocation of the binary inputs to the setting groups A to D and a
simplified connection diagram for the two binary inputs is illustrated in the following figure. The
figure illustrates an example in which both Set Group Bits 0 and 1 are configured to be controlled
(actuated) when the associated binary input is energized (high).
Where:
No = not controlled
Yes = controlled
Figure 3-1 Connection diagram (example) for setting group switching with binary inputs
Trip Circuit Supervi- It must be noted that two binary inputs or one binary input and one substitute resistor R must be
sion connected in series. The pick-up threshold of the binary inputs must therefore be substantially
below half the rated control DC voltage.
If two binary inputs are used for trip circuit supervision, the binary inputs must be isolated, i.e. not
communed with each other or with another binary input.
If one binary input is used, a substitute resistor R must be employed (refer to Figure 3-2). The re-
sistor R is inserted into the circuit of the second circuit breaker auxiliary contact (Aux2), to facilitate
the detection of a malfunction also when the first circuit breaker auxiliary contact (Aux1) is open
and the trip contact has dropped out. The value of this resistor must be such that in the circuit
breaker open condition (therefore Aux1 is open and Aux2 is closed) the circuit breaker trip coil
(TC) is no longer picked up and binary input (BI1) is still picked up if the command relay contact
is open.
Figure 3-2 Trip circuit supervision with one binary input – example for trip circuit
This results in an upper limit for the resistance dimension, Rmax, and a lower limit Rmin, from which
the optimal value of the arithmetic mean R should be selected:
In order that the minimum voltage for controlling the binary input is ensured, Rmax is derived as:
So the circuit breaker trip coil does not remain energized in the above case, Rmin is derived as:
If the calculation yields that Rmax < Rmin, then the calculation must be repeated using the next
lowest switching threshold UBI min, and this threshold must be implemented in the relay using plug-
in jumpers (see Section „Hardware Modifications“).
Example:
IBI (HIGH) 1.8 mA (SIPROTEC® 4 7ST6)
UBI min 19 V for delivery setting for nominal voltages of 24/48/60 V (from the 7ST6);
88 V for delivery setting for nominal voltage 110/125/220/250 V (from device 7ST6);
UCTR 110 V (system / trip circuit)
RTC 500 (system / trip circuit)
UTC (LOW) 2 V (system / trip circuit)
3.1.2.1 General
A subsequent adaptation of the hardware to the power system conditions can, for example,
become necessary with regard to the control voltage for binary inputs or the termination of bus-
capable interfaces. Follow the procedure described in this section, whenever hardware modifica-
tions are done.
Auxiliary Voltage There are different input voltage ranges for nominal voltage. The versions for 60/110/125 VDC and
110/125/220/250 VDC are interchangeable by altering jumper settings. The assignment of these
jumpers to the nominal voltage ranges and their spatial arrangement on the PCB are described
further below at „Processor Board C-CPU-2“. Location and ratings of the miniature fuse and the
buffer battery are also shown. When the device is delivered, these jumpers are set according to
the name-plate sticker and generally need not be altered.
Life Contact The life contact of the device is a changeover contact from which either the NC contact or the NO
contact can be connected to the device terminals via a plug-in jumper (X40). Assignments of the
jumpers to the contact type and the spatial layout of the jumpers are described in Section at
margin heading „Processor Board C-CPU-2“.
Rated Currents The rated currents can be 1 or 5 A depending on the variant ordered.
Control Voltage for When the device is delivered from the factory the binary inputs are set to operate with a voltage
Binary Inputs that corresponds to the rated DC voltage of the power supply. In case of deviating nominal values
of the power system control voltage, it may become necessary to change the switching threshold
of the binary inputs.
To change the switching threshold of a binary input, one jumper must be changed for each input.
The assignments of the jumpers to the binary inputs and the spatial layout of the jumpers is de-
scribed in the following sections under „Processor Board C-CPU-2“, Board C-I/O-7, „Board(s) C-
I/O-12 and C-I/O-13“ and „Board B-I/O-2“.
Note
If binary inputs are used for trip circuit monitoring, note that two binary inputs (or a binary input and
a substitute resistor) are connected in series. The switching threshold must be significantly less
than half the rated control voltage.
Contact Mode for Depending on the version, some output relays can be set to have normally closed or normally
Binary Outputs open contacts. To do so a jumper location must be changed. For which relays on which boards
this is valid can be found in the following sections under „Switching Elements on Printed Circuit
Boards“.
Termination of If the device is equipped with a serial RS 485 interface or PROFIBUS, they must be terminated
Serial Interfaces with resistors at the last device on the bus to ensure reliable data transmission. For this purpose
terminating resistors are provided on the PCB of the C-CPU-2 processor boards and on the RS
485 or PROFIBUS interface module which can be connected via jumpers. The spatial arrange-
ment of the jumpers on the PCB of the processor module C-CPU-2 is described in the following
sections under „Processor Board C-CPU-2“ and on the interface modules under „RS485 Interface“
and „PROFIBUS Interface“. Both jumpers must be plugged in the same way.
Spare Parts Spare parts can be the battery for storage of data in the battery-buffered RAM in case of a power
failure, and the internal power supply miniature fuse. Their spatial arrangement is shown in the
figure of the processor board. The ratings of the fuse are printed on the board next to the fuse
itself. When exchanging the fuse, please observe the hints given in the SIPROTEC® 4 System De-
scription in the chapter „Maintenance“ and „Corrective Action / Repairs“.
3.1.2.2 Disassembly
Note
It is assumed for the following steps that the device is not in operation.
Caution!
Caution when changing jumper settings that affect nominal values of the device:
As a consequence, the order number (MLFB) and the ratings on the nameplate no longer match
the actual device properties.
Where such changes are necessary in exceptional changes, they MUST be marked clearly and
visibly on the device. Self adhesive stickers are available that can be used as replacement name-
plates.
To perform work on the PCB´s, such as checking or rearranging switching elements or exchanging
modules, proceed as follows:
• Prepare area of work: Prepare a surface appropriate to electrostatic sensitive devices (ESD).
In addition to this, the following tools are required:
– Screwdriver with a 5 to 6 mm wide tip,
• Unfasten the screw-posts of the D-subminiature connectors on the back panel at location „A“
and „C“.
• If the device has, in addition to the communication interfaces at locations „A“ and „C“, interfaces
at locations „B“ and „D“, the screws located diagonally to the interfaces must be removed.
• Remove the caps on the front cover of the device and withdraw the then accessible screws.
• Remove the front cover and tilt it to the side. With device versions with a detached operator
panel it is possible to remove the front cover of the device right after having unscrewed all
screws.
Caution!
Mind electrostatic discharges:
When handling plug connectors, eliminate electrostatic discharges by first touching an earthed
metal surface.
The assembly of the boards for the housing size 1/2 is shown in Figure 3-3 and for the housing size
1/ in Figure 3-4.
1
• Disconnect the plug connector of the ribbon cable between the front cover and the processor
board C-CPU-2 at the front cover side. To do this, spread the latches on the upper and lower
end of the plug connector to release the plug connector of the ribbon cable. This action does
not apply to the device version with detached operator panel. However, on the central proces-
sor unit C–CPU-2 (No. 1) the 7-pole plug connector X16 behind the D-subminiature connector
and the plug connector of the ribbon cable (connected to the 68-pole plug connector on the rear
side) must be removed.
• Disconnect the ribbon cables between the processor board C-CPU-2 (No. 1) and the input/out-
put boards I/O (No. 2 to No. 6, depending on the ordered variant).
• Remove the modules and place them on a surface suitable for electrostatically sensitive
modules (ESD).
• Check the jumpers according to Figures 3-5 to 3-10, 3-13, 3-14 and the following information.
Change or remove the jumpers if necessary.
Figure 3-3 Front view with housing size 1/2 after removal of the front cover (simplified and
scaled down)
Figure 3-4 Front view with housing size 1/1 after removal of the front cover (simplified and scaled down)
Processor Board C- The PCB layout of the processor board C–CPU-2 is illustrated in the following figure. The set rated
CPU-2 voltage of the integrated power supply is checked according to Table 3-2, the quiescent state of
the life contact according to Table 3-3, the selected pickup voltages of the binary inputs BI1 to BI5
according to Table 3-4 and the integrated RS232 / RS485 interface according to Table 3-5 to 3-7.
The location and ratings of the miniature fuse (F1) and the buffer battery (G1) are shown in the
following figure.
Before checking the integrated RS232/RS485 interface, it may be necessary to remove the inter-
face modules mounted on top of it.
Figure 3-5 Processor board C–CPU with jumper settings required for the board configuration
Table 3-2 Jumper setting of the rated voltage of the integrated Power Supply on the C-
CPU-2 processor board
Jumper Rated Voltage
24 to 48 VDC 60 to 125 VDC 110 to 250 VDC
X51 Not used 1-2 2-3
X52 Not used 1-2 and 3-4 2-3
X53 Not used 1-2 2-3
X55 Not used Not used 1-2
Cannot be changed Interchangeable
Table 3-3 Jumper position of the quiescent state of the Life Contact on the C-CPU-2 pro-
cessor board
Table 3-4 Jumper settings of the Pickup Voltages of the binary inputs BI1 to BI5 (DC volt-
age) on the C-CPU-2 processor board
1)
Factory settings for devices with rated power supply voltages 24 VDC to 125 VDC
2)
Factory settings for devices with rated power supply voltages 110 VDC to 250 VDC
3)
Only to be used with control voltages 220 or 250 VDC
By repositioning jumpers the interface RS485 can be modified into a RS232 interface and vice
versa.
Jumpers X105 to X110 must be set to the same position.
Table 3-5 Jumper settings of the integrated RS232/RS485 Interface on the C-CPU-2 pro-
cessor board
The jumpers are preset at the factory according to the configuration ordered.
With interface RS232 jumper X111 is needed to activate CTS which enables the communication
with the modem.
X111 is not important for consideration with regard to the RS485 interface.
Jumper setting 2-3: The connection to the modem is usually established with a star coupler or
fibre-optic converter. Therefore the modem control signals according to RS232 standard DIN
66020 are not available. Modem signals are not required since communication to SIPROTEC® 4
devices is always carried out in the half duplex mode. Please use the connection cable with order
number 7XV5100-4.
Jumper setting 1-2: This setting makes the modem signals available, i. e. for a direct RS232 con-
nection between the SIPROTEC® 4 device and the modem this setting can be selected optionally.
We recommend to use a standard RS232 modem connection cable (converter 9-pin to 25-pin).
Note
For a direct connection to DIGSI® with the RS232 interface, jumper X111 must be plugged in po-
sition 2-3.
If there are no external matching resistors in the system, the last devices on a RS485 bus must
be configured using jumpers X103 and X104.
Table 3-7 Jumper settings of the Terminating Resistors of the RS485 interface on the C-
CPU-2 processor board
Terminating resistors can also be implemented outside the device (e.g. on the terminal block). In
this case, the matching resistors located on the RS485 or PROFIBUS interface module or directly
on the PCB of the C-CPU-2 board must be disabled.
C-I/O-7 Input/Out- The P.C.B layout for the C-I/O-7 input/output board is shown in Figure 3-7.
put Board(s)
Figure 3-7 Input/output board C-I/O-7 with representation of the jumper settings required for
checking the configuration settings
Depending on the device version the contacts of some binary outputs can be changed from from
normally open to normally closed (see Appendix, under section A.2).
• In versions 7ST6 1 * 1/5 (housing size 1/2 with 27 binary outputs), this is valid for the binary
outputs BO14, BO15, BO25 and BO26 (figure 3-3, slot 19).
• In versions 7ST6 1 * 3/7 (housing size 1/2 with 22 binary outputs), this is valid for the binary
outputs BO9, BO10, BO20 and BO21 (figure 3-3, slot 19).
• In versions 7ST6 3 * 3/7 (housing size 1/1 with 36 binary outputs), this is valid for the binary
outputs BO9, BO10, BO20 and BO21 (figure3-4, slot 19 right);
The Tables 3-8 and 3-9 show the position of the jumpers for the contact mode.
Table 3-8 Jumper setting for the Contact Mode of the relays for BO14, BO15, BO25 and
BO26 or BO9, BO10, BO20 and BO21 on the input/output board C-I/O-7 with
housing size 1/2
Device 7ST61* Printed Circuit For Jumpe Open in Quies- Closed in Quiescent State Factory
Board r cent State (NO) (NC) Setting
1/5 Slot 19 BO14 X41 1-2 2-3 1-2
Slot 19 BO15 X42 1-2 2-3 1-2
Slot 19 BO25 X43 1-2 2-3 1-2
Slot 19 BO26 X44 1-2 2-3 1-2
3/7 Slot 19 BO9 X41 1-2 2-3 1-2
Slot 19 BO10 X42 1-2 2-3 1-2
Slot 19 BO20 X43 1-2 2-3 1-2
Slot 19 BO21 X44 1-2 2-3 1-2
Table 3-9 Jumper setting for the Contact Mode of the relays for BO9, BO10, BO20 and
BO21 on the input/output board C-I/O-7 with housing size 1/1
Device 7ST63* Printed Circuit For Jumpe Open in Quies- Closed in Quiescent State Factory
Board r cent State (NO) (NC) Setting
Slot 19 right side BO9 X41 1-2 2-3 1-2
Slot 19 right side BO10 X42 1-2 2-3 1-2
Slot 19 right side BO20 X43 1-2 2-3 1-2
Slot 19 right side BO21 X44 1-2 2-3 1-2
Depending on the version there are 5 or 6 inputs available on this board. 6 binary inputs (BI7–
BI12), connected to common potential, or 5 binary inputs divided into 1 x 2 binary inputs (BI7–BI8),
connected to common potential and 1 x 3 binary inputs (BI9–BI11), connected to common poten-
tial. Please note that the relationship between jumpers X110, X111 and X29 must always be cor-
rect.
BI7 to BI12 (with housing size 1/2 slot 19, and with housing size 1/1 slot 19 right side) according to
Table 3-11.
Table 3-11 Jumper settings of Pickup Voltages of the binary inputs BI7 to BI12 on the in-
put/output board C-I/O-7
1) Factory settings for devices with rated power supply voltages 24 VDC to 125 VDC
2) Factory settings for devices with power supply voltages 110 VDC to 250 VDC
3) Use only with pickup voltages 220 to 250 VDC
Jumpers X71, X72 and X73 on the input/output board C-I/O-7 are used to set the bus address and
must not be changed. The following two tables list the jumper presettings.
Table 3-12 Jumper settings of the PCB Address of the input/output board C-I/O-7 or C-I/O-
10 with housing size 1/2 slot 19, and with housing size 1/1 slot 19 right side)
Jumper Mounting Location 19
A0 X71 1-2 (H)
A1 X72 1-2 (H)
A2 X73 2-3 (L)
Board C-I/O-12 The PCB layout for the C-I/O-12 input/output board is shown in Figure 3-8.
Figure 3-8 C-I/O-12 input/output board with representation of jumper settings required for
checking configuration settings
Table 3-13 Jumper setting for the Contact Mode of the relays for BO4 and BO5 on the in-
put/output board C-I/O-12 with housing size 1/2
Device 7ST61*1/5 Printed Circuit For Jumpe Open in Quies- Closed in Quiescent State Factory
Board r cent State (NO) (NC) Setting
Slot 33 BO4 X41 1-2 2-3 1-2
Slot 33 BO5 X42 1-2 2-3 1-2
Table 3-14 Jumper settings of Pickup Voltages of the binary input BI6 on the input/output
board C-I/O-12
BI6 X21 L M H
1) Factory settings for devices with rated power supply voltages 24 VDC to 125 VDC
2)
Factory settings for devices with rated power supply voltages 110 VDC to 250 VDC
3)
Use only with pickup voltages 220 to 250 VDC
Jumpers X71, X72 and X73 on the input/output board C-I/O-12 are used to set the bus address
and must not be changed. The following table lists the jumper presettings.
Mounting location:
Table 3-15 Jumper settings of Board Address of the input/output board C-I/O-12
Jumper Factory Setting
A0 X71 1-2 (H)
A1 X72 2-3 (L)
A2 X73 2-3 (L)
C-I/O-13 Input/Out-
put Board
Figure 3-9 C-I/O-13 input/output board with representation of jumper settings required for
checking configuration settings
Table 3-16 Jumper settings of Pickup Voltages of the binary input BI6 on the input/output
board C-I/O-13
BI6 X21 L M H
1)
Factory settings for devices with rated power supply voltages 24 VDC to 125 VDC
2)
Factory settings for devices with rated power supply voltages 110 VDC to 250 VDC
3)
Use only with pickup voltages 220 to 250 VDC
Jumpers X71, X72 and X73 on the input/output board C-I/O-13 are used to set the bus address
and must not be changed. The following table lists the jumper presettings.
Mounting location:
Table 3-17 Jumper settings of Bus Address of the input/output board C-I/O-13
Table 3-18 Jumper setting for current summation I1+I2 with high-set stage
Jumper X600 Function
1–2 Only I1
2–3 I1+I2
Input/Output Board The PCB layout for the B-I/O-2 input/output board is shown in Figure 3-10.
B-I/O-2
Figure 3-10 Input/output board B-I/O-2 with jumper settings required for the board configura-
tion (representation of the jumpers X71, X72 and X73 for housing size 1/1)
Table 3-19 Jumper settings for the Pickup Voltages of the binary inputs BI13 to BI38 on the
B–I/O-2 board for model 7ST63*
1) Factory settings for devices with rated power supply voltages 24 VDC to 125 VDC
2) Factory settings for devices with power supply voltages 110 VDC to 250 VDC
Jumpers X71, X72 and X73 on the input/output board B-I/O-2 are for the setting Bus Address.
The jumpers must not be changed. The following two tables list the jumper presettings.
Table 3-20 Jumper settings of the Board Address of the input/output board B-I/O-2 for
housing size 1/1
Jumper Mounting Location
Slot 33 left side Slot 19 left side
X71 1-2 (H) 1-2 (H)
X72 2-3 (L) 1-2 (H)
X73 1-2 (H) 1-2 (H)
Exchanging Inter- The interface boards are located on the C–CPU-2 board (in Figures 3-3 and 3-4).
face Modules
The order numbers of the exchange modules can be found in the Appendix in Section A.1, Acces-
sories.
RS232 Interface Interface RS232 can be modified to interface RS485 and vice versa (see Figures 3-12 and 3-13).
Figure 3-11 shows the PCB of the C-CPU-2 with the layout of the boards.
The following figure shows the location of the jumpers of interface RS232 on the interface module.
The fibre optics module is controlled via an RS232 interface module at the associated CPU inter-
face slot. For this application type the jumpers X12 and X13 on the RS232 module are plugged in
position 2-3.
Terminating resistors are not required for RS232. They are disconnected.
With jumper X11 the flow control which is important for modem communication is enabled.
Table 3-22 Jumper setting for CTS (Flow Control) on the interface board
1) Factory Setting
Jumper setting 2-3: The connection to the modem is usually established with a star coupler or
fibre-optic converter. Therefore the modem control signals according to RS232 standard DIN
66020 are not available. Modem signals are not required since communication to SIPROTEC® 4
devices is always carried out in the half duplex mode. Please use the connection cable with order
number 7XV5100-4.
Jumper setting 1-2: This setting makes the modem signals available, i. e. for a direct RS232 con-
nection between the SIPROTEC® 0.4 device and the modem this setting can be selected option-
ally. We recommend to use a standard RS232 modem connection cable (converter 9-pin to 25-
pin).
Note
For a direct connection to DIGSI® with interface RS232 jumper X11 must be plugged in position
2-3.
RS485 Interface The following figure shows the location of the jumpers of interface RS485 on the interface module.
Interface RS485 can be modified to interface RS232 and vice versa, according to Figure 3-12.
Figure 3-13 Position of matching resistors and the plug-in jumpers for configuration of the
RS485 interface
PROFIBUS Inter-
face
Figure 3-14 Position of the plug-in jumpers for the configuration of the terminating resistors at the interfaces PROFIBUS
(FMS and DP), DNP3.0 and Modbus
Termination For bus-capable interfaces a termination is necessary at the bus for each last device, i.e. termi-
nating resistors must be connected. With the 7ST6 device, this concerns the variants with RS485
or PROFIBUS interfaces.
The terminating resistors are located on the RS485 or PROFIBUS interface module, which is on
the board C-CPU-2 (No.1 in Figure 3-3 to 3-4), or directly on the PCB of the processor board C-
CPU-2 (see margin heading „Processor Board C-CPU-2“, Table 3-7).
Figure 3-11 shows the C-CPU-2 P.C.B. with the layout of the boards.
The board with configuration as RS485 interface is shown in Figure 3-13, the module for the PRO-
FIBUS interface in Figure 3-14.
For the configuration of the terminating resistors both jumpers have to be plugged in the same
way.
On delivery the jumpers are set so that the terminating resistors are disconnected.
The terminating resistors can also be connected externally (e.g. to the connection module), see
the following figure. In this case, the terminating resistors located on the RS485 or PROFIBUS
interface module or directly on the PCB of the processor board C-CPU-2 must be de-energized.
3.1.2.5 Reassembly
3.1.3 Mounting
Depending on the version, the device housing can be 1/2 or 1/1. For the 1/2 housing size (Figure 3-
16) there are four covers and four holes. For the 1/1 housing size (Figure 3-17) there are six covers
and six holes.
• Remove the 4 covers at the corners of the front cover, for size 1/1 the two covers located cen-
trally at the top and bottom also have to be removed. Thus the 4 respectively 6 elongated holes
in the mounting flange are revealed and can be accessed.
• Insert the device into the panel cut-out and fasten it with four or six screws. Dimension drawings
see Section 4.17.
• Mount the four or six covers.
• Connect the low-resistance operational and protective earth on the rear plate of the device,
using at least one M4 screw for the device earthing. The cable-cross section used must corre-
spond to the largest connected cable cross-section, at least being 2.5 mm2..
• Establish connections via the plug-in or screw connections on the rear panel of the housing ac-
cording to circuit diagram.
For screw connections with forked lugs or direct connection, before inserting wires the screws
must be tightened so that the screw heads are flush with the outer edge of the connection block.
A ring lug must be centred in the connection chamber in such a way that the screw thread fits
in the hole of the lug.
Specifications regarding maximum cross sections, tightening torques, bending radii and
tension relief as specified in the SIPROTEC® 4 System Description (Order No. E50417-H1176-
C151) must be observed. You will find hints in the short description included in the device.
2 mounting brackets are required for incorporating a device in a rack or cubicle. The order number
is given in the Appendix, Subsection A.1.
For the 1/2 housing size (Figure 3-18), there are four covers and four holes. For the 1/1 housing
size (Figure 3-19) there are six covers and six holes.
• First the two mounting brackets in the rack or cubicle are screwed loosely by means of 4 screws
each.
• Remove the 4 covers at the corners of the front cover, for size 1/1 the two covers located cen-
trally at the top and bottom also have to be removed. Thus the 4 respectively 6 elongated holes
in the mounting flange are revealed and can be accessed.
• Fasten the device to the mounting brackets with four or six screws.
• Mount the four or six covers.
• Next, tighten the 8 screws of the mounting brackets in the frame or cabinet.
• Connect the low-resistance operational and protective earth on the rear plate of the device,
using at least one M4 screw for the device earthing. The cable cross-section used must corre-
spond to the largest connected cable cross-section, at least being 2.5 mm2 (AWG 14).
• Establish connections via the plug-in or screw connections on the rear panel of the housing ac-
cording to circuit diagram.
For screw connections with forked lugs or direct connection, before inserting wires the screws
must be tightened so that the screw heads are flush with the outer edge of the connection block.
A ring lug must be centred in the connection chamber in such a way that the screw thread fits
in the hole of the lug.
Specifications regarding maximum cross sections, tightening torques, bending radii and
tension relief as specified in the SIPROTEC® 4 System Description (Order No. E50417-H1176-
C151) must be observed. You will find hints in the short description included in the device.
Figure 3-19 Example of rack or cubicle mounting of a device (housing size 1/1)
The following tables illustrate the pin assignment of the various serial device interfaces and of the
time synchronization interface. The position of the connections can be seen in the following figure.
Operator Interface When the recommended communication cable is used, correct connection between the SIPRO-
TEC® 4 device and the PC is automatically ensured. See the Appendix for an ordering description
of the cable.
Service Interface Check the data connection if the service interface (Port C) is used for communication with the
device via fix wiring or a modem. If the service port is used as input for one or two RTD-boxes,
verify the interconnection according to one of the connection examples given in the Appendix A.3.
System Interface For versions equipped with a serial interface to a control centre, the user must check the data con-
nection. The visual check of the assignment of the transmission and reception channels is of par-
ticular importance in the context. With RS232 and fibre optic interfaces, each connection is dedi-
cated to one transmission direction. For this reason, the data output of the first device must be
connected with the data input of the second device and vice-versa.
With data cables, the connections are designated according to DIN 66 020 and ISO 2110:
• TxD = Data Output
• RxD = Data Input
• RTS = Request to Send
The cable shield is to be earthed at both ends. In case of an extreme electromagnetic environ-
ment, a separate, individually shielded pair of wires can be incorporated for improving the interfer-
ence immunity of the GND.
Pin-Nr. RS232 RS485 Profibus FMS Slave, RS485 Modbus RS485 EN 100 IEC 60870-5-103
Profibus DP Slave, RS485 DNP 3.0 RS485 electr redundant RS485
(RJ45)
RJ45
1 Shield (electrically connected with shield shroud) Tx+ B/B’ (RxD/TxD-P)
2 RxD – – – Tx- A/A’ (RxD/TxD-N)
3 TxD A/A’ (RxD/TxD-N) B/B’ (RxD/TxD-P) A Rx+
4 – – CNTR-A (TTL) RTS (TTL Pegel) –
5 GND C/C’ (GND) C/C’ (GND) GND1 –
6 – – +5 V (belastbar mit <100 mA) VCC1 Rx-
7 RTS – 1) – – –
8 CTS B/B’ (RxD/TxD-P) A/A’ (RxD/TxD-N) B –
9 – – – – not provided
1)
Pin 7 also carries the RTS signal with RS232 level when operated as RS485 interface. Pin 7
must therefore not be connected!
Termination The RS485 interface is capable of half-duplex operation with signals A/A' and B/B' with the
common reference potential C/C' (GND). It is necessary to check that the terminating resistors are
connected to the bus only at the last unit, and not at other devices on the bus. The jumpers for the
terminating resistors are on the interface module RS485 (see Figure 3-12) or on the PROFIBUS
RS485 (see Figure 3-14), or in the 7ST6 directly on the C–CPU–2 (see Figure 3-5 and Table 3-7).
Terminating resistors can also be implemented outside the device (e.g. in the plug connectors) as
shown in Figure 3-6. In this case, the terminating resistors located on the module must be dis-
abled.
If the bus is extended, make sure again that only terminating resistors at the last device to the bus
are energized. The remaining terminating resistors at the bus may not be energized.
Time Synchroniza- It is optionally possible to process 5 V-, 12 V- or 24 V- time synchronization signals, provided that
tion Interface they are carried to the inputs named in the following table.
Fibre-Optic Cables
WARNING!
Warning of laser rays!
Non-observance of the following measure can result in death, personal injury or substantial prop-
erty damage.
The transmission via fibre optics is particularly insensitive to electromagnetic interference and
thus ensures galvanic isolation of the connection. Transmit and receive connections are repre-
sented by symbols.
The normal setting of the character idle state for the fibre optic cable interface is "Light off". If the
character idle state is to be changed, use the operating program DIGSI®, as described in the
SIPROTEC® 4 System Description.
WARNING!
Warning of hazardous voltages
Non-observance of the following measures can result in death, personal injury or substantial prop-
erty damage.
Only qualified people who are familiar with and observe the safety procedures and precautionary
measures shall perform the inspection steps.
Caution!
Be careful when operating the device connected to a battery charger without a battery
Non-observance of the following measure can lead to unusually high voltages and consequently,
the destruction of the device.
Do not operate the device on a battery charger without a connected battery. (For limit values see
also Technical Data, Section 4.1).
If undervoltage protection is configured and enabled in the device and if, at the same time, the
current criterion is disabled, the device picks up right after auxiliary voltage has been connected,
since no measuring voltage is available. To make the device configurable, pickup is to be stopped,
i.e. the measuring voltage is connected or voltage protection is blocked. This can be performed
by operation.
Before the device is energized for the first time, the device should be in the final operating envi-
ronment for at least 2 hours to equalize the temperature, to minimize humidity and avoid conden-
sation. Connections are checked with the device at its final location. The system must first be
switched off and earthed.
– Remove the ribbon cable connected to the I/O board with the measured current inputs (on
the front side it is the right printed circuit board). Furthermore, remove the printed circuit
board so that there is no more contact anymore with the plug-in terminal of the housing.
– Check continuity on the connection side, for each current connection pair.
– Insert the board again firmly; press the ribbon cable with care. Avoid to bend connection
pins! Do not apply force!
– At the terminals of the device, again check continuity for each pair of terminals that receives
current from the CTs.
• Connect an ammeter in the supply circuit of the power supply. A range of about 2.5 A to 5 A for
the meter is appropriate.
• Switch on mcb for auxiliary voltage (supply protection), check the voltage level and, if applica-
ble, the polarity of the voltage at the device terminals or at the connection modules.
• The current input should correspond to the power input in neutral position of the device. The
measured steady state current should be insignificant. Transient movement of the ammeter
merely indicates the charging current of capacitors.
• Switch off mcb for the auxiliary power supply.
• Remove ammeter; re-establish normal auxiliary voltage connection.
• Switch on mcb for the auxiliary power supply.
• Switch on voltage transformer protective circuit breaker.
• Switch off mcb for the voltage transformers and the auxiliary power supply.
• Check the trip and close circuits to the power system circuit breakers.
• Check control lines from and to the other devices.
• Check signalling lines.
• Switch on m.c.b.
3.3 Commissioning
WARNING!
Warning of hazardous voltages when operating electrical devices
Non-observance of the following measures can result in death, personal injury or substantial prop-
erty damage.
Only qualified people shall work on and around this device. They must be thoroughly familiar with
all warnings and safety notices in this instruction manual as well as with the applicable safety
steps, safety regulations, and precautionary measures.
The device is to be earthed to the substation earth before any other connections are made.
Hazardous voltages can exist in all switchgear components connected to the power supply and to
measurement and test circuits.
Hazardous voltages can be present in the device even after the power supply voltage has been
removed (capacitors can still be charged).
After removing voltage from the power supply, wait a minimum of 10 seconds before re-energizing
the power supply. This wait allows the initial conditions to be firmly established before the device
is re-energized.
The limit values given in Technical Data must not be exceeded, neither during testing nor during
commissioning.
When testing the device with secondary test equipment, make sure that no other measured values
are connected and that the TRIP command lines and possibly the CLOSE command lines to the
circuit breakers are interrupted, unless otherwise specified.
DANGER!
Hazardous voltages during interruptions in secondary circuits of current transformers
Non-observance of the following measure will result in death, severe personal injury or substantial
property damage.
Short-circuit the current transformer secondary circuits before current connections to the device
are opened.
For the commissioning switching operations have to be carried out. A prerequisite for the pre-
scribed tests is that these switching operations can be executed without danger. They are accord-
ingly not meant for operational checks.
WARNING!
Warning of dangers evolving from improper primary tests
Non-observance of the following measure can result in death, personal injury or substantial prop-
erty damage.
Primary tests may only be carried out by qualified persons who are familiar with commissioning
protection systems, with managing power systems and the relevant safety rules and guidelines
(switching, earthing etc.).
Activation and De- If the device is connected to a central or main computer system via the SCADA interface, then the
activation information that is transmitted can be influenced. This is only possible with some of the protocols
available (see Table „Protocol-dependent Functions“ in the Appendix A.6).
If Test mode is activated, then a message sent by a SIPROTEC®4 device to the main system has
an additional test bit. This bit allows the indication to be recognized as resulting from testing and
not an actual fault or power system event. In addition to this, the user can determine by activating
the transmission block that no indications at all are transferred via the system interface during
a test operation.
The SIPROTEC® 4 System Description describes in detail how to activate and deactivate test
mode and blocked data transmission (Order No. E50417-H1176-C151). Note that when DIGSI® is
being used, the program must be in the Online operating mode for the test features to be used.
Note
When changing into test mode the device status indication changes from green (RUN) to red (ER-
ROR).
If external time synchronization sources are used, the data of the time source (antenna system,
time generator) are checked (see Chapter 4 under „Time Synchronization“). A correct function
(IRIG B, DCF77) is recognized in such a way that 3 minutes after the startup of the device the clock
status is displayed as „synchronized“, accompanied by the indication „Alarm Clock OFF“.
Prefacing Remarks If the device features a system interface and uses it to communicate with the control centre, the
DIGSI® device operation can be used to test if indications are transmitted correctly. This test
option should however definitely not be used while the device is in service on a „live“ system.
DANGER!
The sending or receiving of indications via the system interface by means of the test func-
tion is a real information exchange between the SIPROTEC device and the control centre.
Connected operating equipment such as circuit breakers or disconnectors can be
switched in this way!
Non-observance of the following measure will result in death, severe personal injury or substantial
property damage.
Equipment used to allow switching such as circuit breakers or disconnectors is to be checked only
during commissioning. Do not under any circumstances check them by means of the testing mode
during real operation performing transmission and reception of indications via the system inter-
face.
Note
After termination of the hardware test, the device will reboot. All annunciation buffers are erased
and statistical values reset. If required, these buffers and statistical values should be extracted
with DIGSI® prior to the test.
The interface test is carried out using DIGSI® in the Online operating mode:
• Open the Online directory by double-clicking; the operating functions for the device appear.
• Click on Test; the function selection appears in the right half of the screen.
• Double-click on Generate Indications shown in the list view. The dialog box Generate Indica-
tions opens (refer to the following figure).
Structure of the The Indication column shows the display texts of all indications configured in the matrix to the
Dialog Box system interface. The SETPOINT column serves to specify a value for the indications to be tested.
Depending on the indication type, several input fields are offered (e.g. ON/ OFF). By double-click-
ing onto one of the fields the required value can be selected from the list.
Figure 3-22 System interface test with dialog box: Generate Indications — example
Changing the Oper- On clicking one of the buttons in the column Action you will be prompted for the password No. 6
ating State (for hardware test menus). After you have entered the password correctly you can send the indi-
cations individually. To do so, click on the button Send on the corresponding line. The correspond-
ing indication is sent and can be read out either from the event log of the SIPROTEC® 4 device or
from the substation control system.
Test in Indication For all information that is transmitted to the substation control system, test in Status Scheduled
Direction the desired options in the list which appears:
• Make sure that each checking process is carried out carefully without causing any danger (see
above and refer to DANGER!).
• Click on Send in the function to be tested and check whether the transmitted information
reaches the substation control system and shows the desired reaction. Data which are normally
linked via binary inputs (first character „>“) are likewise indicated to the substation control
system with this procedure. The function of the binary inputs itself is tested separately.
Exiting the Proce- To end the system interface test, click Close. The device is briefly out of service while the start-up
dure routine is executed. The dialog box closes.
Test in Command The information transmitted in command direction must be issued by the substation control
Direction system. Check whether the reaction is correct.
Prefacing Remarks The binary inputs, outputs, and LEDs of a SIPROTEC® 4 device can be individually and precisely
controlled in DIGSI®. This feature is used e.g. to check the correct connection to the system during
commissioning. This test option should however definitely not be used while the device is in
service on a „live“ system.
DANGER!
The sending or receiving of indications via the system interface by means of the test func-
tion is a real information exchange between the SIPROTEC device and the control centre.
Connected operating equipment such as circuit breakers or disconnectors can be
switched in this way!
Non-observance of the following measure will result in death, severe personal injury or substantial
property damage.
Equipment used to allow switching such as circuit breakers or disconnectors is to be checked only
during commissioning. Do not under any circumstances check them by means of the testing mode
during real operation performing transmission and reception of indications via the system inter-
face.
Note
After termination of the hardware test, the device will reboot. All annunciation buffers are erased.
If required, these buffers should be extracted with DIGSI® prior to the test.
The hardware test is carried out using DIGSI® in the Online operating mode:
• Open the Online directory by double-clicking; the operating functions for the device appear.
• Click on Test; the function selection appears in the right half of the screen.
• Double-click in the list view on Device Inputs / Outputs. The dialog box of the same name
opens (see the following figure).
Structure of the The dialog box is divided into three groups: BI for binary inputs, BO for output relays, and LED for
Dialog Box light-emitting diodes. On the left of each group is an accordingly labelled panel. By double-clicking
a button, information regarding the associated group can be shown or hidden.
In the column Actual the present (physical) state of the hardware component is displayed. The
display is made in symbols. The actual states of the binary inputs and outputs are displayed by
the symbol of opened and closed switch contacts, those of the LEDs by a symbol of a lit or extin-
guished LED.
The opposite state of each element is displayed in the column Scheduled. The display is made
in plain text.
The right-most column shows the commands or indications that are configured (masked) to the
hardware components.
Changing the Oper- To change the operating state of a hardware component, click on the associated button in the
ating State Scheduled column.
Before executing the first change of the operating state the password No. 6 is demanded (provided
that it has been activated). After entry of the correct password a change of state will be executed.
Further state changes remain possible while the dialog box is open.
Test of the Output Each individual output relay can be energized allowing a check of the wiring between the output
Relays relays of the protection device and the system, without having to generate the indication that is
assigned to the relay. As soon as the first change of state for any one of the output relays is initi-
ated, all output relays are separated from the internal device functions, and can only be operated
by the hardware test function. This means that, e.g. a TRIP command coming from a protection
function or a control command from the operator panel to an output relay cannot be executed.
Proceed as follows in order to check the output relay:
• Ensure that the switching of the output relay can be executed without danger (see above under
DANGER!).
• Each output relay must be tested via the corresponding Scheduled column in the dialog box.
• The test sequence must be terminated (refer to margin heading „Exiting the Procedure“), to
avoid the initiation of inadvertent switching operations by further tests.
Test of the Binary To test the wiring between the system and the binary inputs of the protection device, the condition
Inputs in the system which initiates the binary input must be generated and the response of the device
checked.
To do so, open the dialog box Hardware Test again to view the physical position of the binary
input. The password is not yet required.
If, however, the effect of a binary input must be checked without carrying out any switching in the
system, it is possible to trigger individual binary inputs with the hardware test function. As soon as
the first state change of any binary input is triggered and the password No. 6 has been entered,
all binary inputs are separated from the system and can only be activated via the hardware test
function.
Test of the LEDs The LEDs may be tested in a similar manner to the other input/output components. As soon as
the first state change of any LED has been triggered, all LEDs are separated from the internal
device functionality and can only be controlled via the hardware test function. This means e.g .that
no LED is illuminated anymore by a protection function or by pressing the LED reset button.
Updating the When the dialog box Hardware Test is opened, the present conditions of the hardware compo-
Display nents at that moment are read in and displayed.
An update occurs:
• For each hardware component, if a command to change the condition is successfully per-
formed,
• For all hardware components if the Update button is clicked,
• For all hardware components with cyclical updating (cycle time is 20 seconds) if the Automatic
Update (20sec) field is marked.
Exiting the Proce- To end the hardware test, click on Close. The dialog box closes. The device becomes unavailable
dure for a brief start-up period immediately after this. Then all hardware components are returned to
the operating conditions determined by the system settings.
General If the device provides a breaker failure protection and if this is used, the integration of this protec-
tion function in the system can be tested under practical conditions.
Because of the manifold application facilities and various configuration possibilities of the system
it is not possible to give a detailed description of the necessary test steps. It is important to observe
local conditions and protection and system drawings.
Before starting the circuit breaker tests it is recommended to isolate at both ends the feeder which
is to be tested, i.e. line isolators and busbar isolators should be open so that the breaker can be
operated without risk.
Caution!
Also for tests on the local circuit breaker of the feeder a trip command to the surrounding circuit
breakers can be issued for the busbar.
Non–observance of the following measure can result in minor personal injury or property damage.
Therefore, it is recommended primarily to interrupt the tripping commands to the adjacent (busbar)
breakers, e.g. by interrupting the corresponding pickup voltage supply.
Before the breaker is closed again for normal operation, the trip command of the feeder protection
routed to the circuit breaker must be disconnected so that the trip command can only be initiated
by the breaker failure protection.
Although the following lists do not claim to be complete, they may also contain points which are to
be ignored in the current application.
Auxiliary Contacts The circuit breaker auxiliary contact(s) form an essential part of the breaker failure protection
of the CB system in case they have been connected to the device. Make sure the correct assignment has
been checked.
Busbar Tripping The most important thing is the check of the correct distribution of the trip commands to the adja-
cent circuit breakers in case of breaker failure.
The adjacent circuit breakers are those of all feeders which must be tripped in order to ensure in-
terruption of the fault current should the local breaker fail. These are therefore the circuit breakers
of all feeders which feed the busbar or busbar section to which the feeder with the fault is connect-
ed.
A general detailed test guide cannot be specified, because the layout of the surrounding circuit
breakers largely depends on the system topology.
In particular with multiple busbars the trip distribution logic for the surrounding circuit breakers
must be checked. Here it should be checked for every busbar section that all circuit breakers
which are connected to the same busbar section as the feeder circuit breaker under observation
are tripped, and no other breakers.
Termination of the All temporary measures taken for testing must be undone, e.g. especially switching states, inter-
Checks rupted trip commands, changes to setting values or individually switched off protection functions.
Load Current The connections of the current and voltage transformers are tested using primary quantities. Sec-
[10% I N ] ondary load current of at least 10 % of the nominal current of the device is necessary. The line is
energized and will remain in this state during the measurements.
With proper connections of the measuring circuits, none of the measured values supervision ele-
ments should pick up in the device. If an element detects a problem, the causes which provoked
it may be viewed in the Event Log.
If current or voltage summation errors occur, then check the matching factors (see Section
2.1.3.1).
Indications from the symmetry monitoring could occur because there are actually asymmetrical
conditions in the network. If these asymmetrical conditions are normal service conditions, the cor-
responding monitoring functions should be made less sensitive (see Section 2.16).
Current and Voltage Currents and voltages can be viewed in the display field on the front of the device or the operator
Values interface using a PC. They can be compared to the actual measured values, as primary and sec-
ondary quantities.
If the measured values are not plausible, the connection must be checked and corrected after the
line has been isolated and the current transformer circuits have been short-circuited. The mea-
surements must then be repeated.
Voltage Transform- Open the miniature circuit breaker of the feeder voltage transformers. The measured voltages in
er Miniature Circuit the operational measured values appear with a value close to zero (small measured voltages are
Breaker (VT mcb) of no consequence).
Check in the spontaneous indications that the VT mcb trip was entered (indication „>FAIL:Feeder
VT“ „ON“ in the spontaneous indications). It has to be assured beforehand that the position of the
VT mcb is connected to the device via a binary input.
Close the VT mcb again: The above indication appears in the spontaneous indications as „OFF“,
i.e. „>FAIL:Feeder VT“ „OFF“.
If one of the indications does not appear, the connection and allocation of these signals must be
checked.
If the „ON“ state and the „OFF“ state are swapped, the contact type (H–active or L–active) must
be checked and remedied.
If a busbar voltage is used (for voltage or synchronism check) and the assigned VT mcb is con-
nected to the device, the following function must also be checked:
If the VT mcb is open the indication „ON“ appears, if it is closed the indication „OFF“ is displayed.
Load Current The correct connection of the current and voltage transformers is tested via the protected line
[10% I N ] using the load current. For this purpose, connect the line. The load current the line carries must
be at least 0.1 · IN. The load current should be in-phase or lagging the voltage (resistive or resis-
tive-inductive load). The direction of the load current must be known. If there is a doubt, network
or ring loops should be opened. The line remains energized during the test.
The direction can be derived directly from the operational measured values. Initially the correlation
of the measured load direction with the actual direction of load flow is checked. In this case the
normal situation is assumed, where the forward direction (measuring direction) extends from the
busbar towards the line (see the following figure).
The power measurement provides an initial indication as to whether the measured values have
the correct polarity. If both the active power as well as the reactive power have the wrong sign, the
polarity in address 201 CT Starpoint must be checked and rectified.
However, power metering itself is not able to detect all connection errors. Therefore, the imped-
ance of the phase loop is read out as well. This impedance can also be found as primary and sec-
ondary quantity in the operational measured values.
In addition, the following applies for the impedance when the load is in the first quadrant:
In this case the normal situation is assumed, where the forward direction (measuring direction)
extends from the busbar towards the line. In the case of capacitive load, the X-component may
have the opposite sign.
Only for Synchro- If the device is equipped with the function for synchronism and voltage check and it is applied, it
nism Check is necessary - under asynchronous system conditions - that the operating time of the circuit
breaker is measured and set correctly when closing. If the synchronism check function is not used
or only for closing under synchronous system conditions, this subsection is irrelevant.
For measuring the operating time a setup as shown in Figure 3-25 is recommended. The timer is
set to a range of 1 s and a graduation of 1 ms.
The circuit breaker is connected manually. At the same time the timer is started. After closing the
poles of the circuit breaker, the voltage ULine appears and the timer is stopped. The time displayed
by the timer is the real circuit breaker closing time.
If the timer is not stopped due to an unfavourable closing moment, the attempt will be repeated.
It is particularly favourable to calculate the mean value from several (3 to 5) successful switching
attempts.
Set the calculated time in address 239 as T-CB close (under P.System Data 1). Select the next lower
settable value.
The device has a vast capability for allowing functions to be defined by the user, especially with
the CFC logic. Any special function or logic added to the device must be checked.
Naturally, general test procedures cannot be given. Configuration of these functions and the set
value conditions must be actually known beforehand and tested. Possible interlocking conditions
of switching devices (circuit breakers, disconnectors, earth switch) are of particular importance.
They must be considered and tested.
The circuit breaker and tripping circuits can be conveniently tested by the device 7ST6.
If the check does not produce the expected results, the cause may be established from the text in
the display of the device or the PC. If necessary, the connections of the circuit breaker auxiliary
contacts must be checked.
Switching via If the configured operating devices were not switched sufficiently in the hardware test already de-
Command Input scribed, all configured switching devices must be switched on and off from the device via the in-
tegrated control element. The feedback information of the circuit breaker position injected using
binary inputs is read out at the device and compared with the actual breaker position. For devices
with graphic display this is easy to do with the control display.
The switching procedure is described in the SIPROTEC® 4 System Description (Order No.
E50417-H1176-C151). The switching authority must be set in correspondence with the source of
commands used. With the switching mode, you can choose between locked and unlocked switch-
ing. In this case, you must be aware that unlocked switching is a safety risk.
Control from a If the device is connected to a remote substation via a system interface, the corresponding switch-
Remote Control ing tests may also be checked from the substation. Please also take into consideration that the
Centre switching authority is set in correspondence with the source of commands used.
In order to be able to test the stability of the protection also during switch-on procedures, closing
tests can also be carried out at the end. Oscillographic records obtain the maximum information
about the behaviour of the protection.
Requirement Along with the capability of storing fault recordings via pickup of the protection function, the 7ST6
also has the capability of initiating a measured value recording using the operator control program
DIGSI® using the serial interface and via binary inputs. For the latter, event „>Trig.Wave.Cap.“ must
be allocated to a binary input. Triggering for the oscillographic recording then occurs, for instance,
via the binary input when the protection object is energized.
Those that are externally triggered (that is, without a protective element pickup) are processed by
the device as a normal oscillographic record. For each oscillographic record a fault record is
created which is given its individual number to ensure that assignment can be made properly.
However, these recordings are not displayed in the fault indication buffer, as they are not fault
events.
Start Triggering Os- To trigger test measurement recording with DIGSI®, click on Test in the left part of the window.
cillographic Re- Double-click in the list view the entry Test Wave Form (see Figure 3-26).
cording
Oscillographic recording is immediately started. During recording, an indication is given in the left
part of the status bar. Bar segments also inform you of the progress of the operation.
The SIGRA or the Comtrade Viewer program is required to view and analyse the oscillographic
data.
The used terminal screws must be tightened, including those that are not used. All the plug con-
nectors must be correctly inserted.
Caution!
Do not apply force!
The tightening torques must not be exceeded as the threads and terminal chambers may other-
wise be damaged!
The setting values should be checked again if they were changed during the tests. Check
if protection, control and auxiliary functions to be found with the configuration parameters are set
correctly (Section 2.1.1, Functional Scope). All desired functions must be switched ON. Ensure
that a copy of the setting values is stored on the PC.
Check the internal clock of the device. If necessary, set the clock or synchronize the clock if the
element is not automatically synchronized. Further details on this subject are described in /1/.
The indication buffers are deleted under Main Menu Annunciation Set/Reset, so that in the
future they only contain information on actual events and states. The numbers in the switching sta-
tistics should be reset to the values that were existing prior to the testing.
The counters of the operational measured values (e.g. operation counter, if available) are reset
under Main Menu Measurement Reset.
Press the ESC key, several times if necessary, to return to the default display.
Clear the LEDs on the front panel by pressing the LED key, so that they only show real events and
states. In this context, saved output relays are reset, too. Pressing the LED key also serves as a
test for the LEDs on the front panel because they should all light when the button is pressed. If the
LEDs display states relevant by that moment, these LEDs, of course, stay lit.
The green „RUN“ LED must light up, whereas the red „ERROR“ must not light up.
Close the protective switches. If test switches are available, then these must be in the operating
position.
4.10 Synchronism and Voltage Check (optional or depending on device version) 239
4.1 General
Current Inputs
Rated current IN 1 A or 5 A
Measuring range 100 IN
Error limits 1% of IN for I IN
1% of I for I > IN
Thermal loading 100 IN for 1 s
(rms values) 20 IN for 10 s
4 IN continuous
Dynamic loading 250·IN for one half-cycle
(pulse current)
Power consumption per phase Approx. 0.05 VA at IN = 1 A
Approx. 0.3 VA at IN = 5 A
Voltage Inputs
Rated DC current IN 20 mA
Measuring range DC –24 to +24 mA
Error limits 1% of IN for I IN
1% of I for I > IN
Input resistance Approx. 11
Overload capability 100 mA continuous
DC Voltage
Binary Inputs
Variant Quantity
7ST61* 12 (configurable)
7ST63* 38 (configurable)
Output Relays
Operator Interface
Connection Front side, non-isolated, RS232, 9 pin DSUB port for connecting a
personal computer
Operation With DIGSI®
Transmission speed Min. 4800 Baud; max. 115200 Baud; factory setting: 38400 Baud;
Parity: 8E1
Channel distance 15 m (50 ft.)
Ethernet electrical
(EN 100) for IEC61850 Connection for flush-mounted casing Rear panel, mounting location „B“
and DIGSI 2 x RJ45 socket contact
100BaseT acc. to IEEE802.3
Connection for surface-mounted casing in console housing on the bottom
Test voltage (reg. socket) 500 V; 50 Hz
Transmission speed 100 Mbit/s
Bridgeable distance 20 m (65.62 feet)
Ethernet optical (EN100)
for IEC61850 and DIGSI Connection for flush-mounted case Rear panel, mounting location „B“
LC connector
100 Base FX-Ethernet acc. to IEEE802.3
Connection for surface-mounted case not available
Transmission speed 100 Mbit/s
Optical wavelength 1300 nm
Bridgeable distance Max. 1.5 km (0.93 miles)
Fibre optic cable (FO)
FO connector type ST connector
Connection for panel flush-mounted Rear panel, mounting location „B“
housing
Connection for panel surface-mounted In console housing on bottom
housing
Optical wavelength = 820 nm
Laser Class 1 according to EN 60825-1/-2 Using glass fibre 50/125 µm or using glass
fibre 62.5/125 µm
Permissible optical link signal attenuation Max. 8 dB, with glass fibre 62.5/125 µm
Channel distance Max. 1.5 km (5,000 ft.)
Character idle state Selectable: factory setting „Light off“
Profibus RS 485 (FMS and DP)
Connection for panel flush-mounted Rear panel, mounting location „B“ 9-pin D-
housing subminiature female connector
Connection for panel surface-mounted 9-pin D-subminiature female connector in
housing console housing on the bottom
Test voltage 500 V; 50 Hz
Transmission speed Up to 12 MBaud
Channel distance 1,000 m (3,300 ft.) at 93.75 kBd
500 m (1,150 ft.) at 187.5 kBd
200 m (660 ft.) at 1.5 MBaud
100 m (330 ft.) at 12 MBaud
Specifications
Insulation Test
Climatic tests
Humidity
The protection device is designed for installation in normal relay rooms and plants, so that electromagnetic compati-
bility (EMC) is ensured if installation is done properly.
In addition, the following are recommended:
• All contactors and relays that operate in the same cubicle, cabinet, or relay panel as the numerical protective device
should, as a rule, be equipped with suitable surge suppression components.
• For substations with operating voltages of 100 kV and above, all external cables should be shielded with a conduc-
tive shield earthed at both ends. For substations with lower operating voltages, no special measures are normally
required.
• Do not withdraw or insert individual modules while the protective device is energized. In withdrawn condition, some
components are electrostatically endangered; during handling the ESD standards (for Electrostatic Sensitive De-
vices) must be observed. The modules and device are not endangered when inserted into the housing.
4.1.9 Design
Housing 7XP20
Dimensions See dimensional drawings, Section 4.17
Distance Measurement
Setting ranges:
Zmin WPC, Zmax WPC 0,1 .. 500,00
ALPHA WPC, BETA WPC 0° to 180° Increments 1°
Umax WPC 10 U/Un .. 200 U/Un Increments 1 U/Un
Times
Very High Set Current Stage, High Set Current Stage and Definite-time Overcurrent Stage
1)
The currents are specified in secondary values for IN = 1 A. With IN = 5 A, currents must be
multiplied by 5. Increments are 0,2 IN.
Tolerances
DT
Currents 5 % of setting value for IAct IN
Times 1 % of setting value, at least 10 ms
With high-speed overcurrent protec- 1 % of setting value, at least 3 ms
tion
IDMT
Pickup/dropout thresholds Ip, IEp 2 % of set value or 10 mA for IN = 1 A
or 50 mA for IN 5 A
Pickup time for 2 I/Ip 20 5 % of reference (calculated) value +2 % current toler-
ance, or 30 ms
Figure 4-1 Trip Time Characteristics of the Inverse-time Overcurrent Protection, acc. to AN-
SI/IEEE
Figure 4-2 Trip Characteristics of the Inverse-time Overcurrent Protection, as per IEC
Figure 4-3 Trip Time Characteristics of the Inverse-time Overcurrent Protection, acc. to AN-
SI/IEEE
Tolerances
Setting Ranges
Factor k ITRise = ITRise / IN (continuous limit current) 0.10 to 4.00 Increments 0.01
Time constant TAU 2.0 min to 30.0 min Increments 0.1 min (6 s)
Final temperature rise TRise (for continuous limit cur- 0 to 100 K Increments 1 K
rent)
Trip temperature TEMP TRIP 50 to 100 °C Increments 1 °C
Alarm temperature TEMP ALARM 40 to 100 °C Increments 1 °C
Close temperature TEMP CLOSE 25 to 100 °C Increments 1 °C
Factor for 2 catenaries CAT2 1.0 to 3.0 Increments 0.1
Factor for 3 catenaries CAT3 1.0 to 3.0 Increments 0.1
Fixed ambient temperature value TEMP.SENS -55 to 40 °C Increments 1 °C
VALUE
ULS TRIP Drops out with internal signal No dropout to pickup ratio
„Current=0“
ULS ALARM 1K (dropout threshold =
pickup value –1K)
ULS BLOCK TEMP TRIP/TEMP CLOSE Depends on the settings of
TEMP TRIP and TEMP
CLOSE
Tolerances
Defrosting Protection
1)
The currents are specified in secondary values for IN = 1 A. With IN = 5 A, currents must be
multiplied by 5.
Tolerances
Pickup
General AR Function
Operating Modes
Voltages
U Measurement
Times
General
General
Monitoring
General Limits
Device-Specific Limits
Additional Limits
1) When the limit is exceeded, an error indication is output by the device. Consequently, the
device starts monitoring. The red ERROR-LED lights up.
1) When the sum of TICKS of all blocks exceeds the limits before-mentioned, an error indication
is output by CFC.
Measured Values
Operational measured values for currents I, IX, IF in A primary and secondary, and in % IN
Tolerance 1 % of IN for I IN and 1 % of I for I > IN
Operational measured values for voltages U, UF, URef in kV primary, in V secondary or in % UN
Tolerance 1 % of UN for U UN and 1 % of U for U > UN
Operational measured values of impedances R in primary and secondary
Operational measured values for power P in KW or MW
Q in KVA or Mvar
Tolerance 2 % each
Phase angle
Tolerance 0.02
Operational measured values for frequency f in Hz and % fN
Area 90 % to 110 % of fN
Tolerance 20 mHz
Thermal measured values TLine in °C
TAmbient in °C
Operational measured values of synchro check ULine; USync in kV primary
fLine; fSync in Hz
Fault Logging
Fault Recording
Statistics
4.17 Dimensions
4.17.1 Housing for Panel Flush Mounting or Cubicle Mounting (Size 1/2)
Figure 4-4 Dimensional drawing of a 7ST6 for panel flush or cubicle mounting (housing size
1/
2)
4.17.2 Housing for Panel Flush Mounting or Cubicle Mounting (Size 1/1)
Figure 4-5 Dimensional drawing of a 7ST6 for panel flush or cubicle mounting (housing size 1/1)
A.1.2 Accessories
RS232 C53207-A351-D641-1
RS485 C73207-A351-D642-1
FO 820 nm C73207-A351-D643-1
Terminal Block Cov- Terminal block covering cap for block type Order Number
ering Caps
18-pole voltage terminal, 12-pole current terminal C73334-A1-C31-1
2-pole C73334-A1-C35-1
3-pole C73334-A1-C36-1
Interface Cable An interface cable and the DIGSI® software is necessary for com-
munication between the SIPROTEC® 4 device and a PC or laptop:
The PC or laptop must run MS-WINDOWS 95/98, MS-WINDOWS
ME, MS-WINDOWS NT 4, MS-WINDOWS 2000 or MS-WINDOWS
XP. Order Number
DIGSI® Operating Software for setting and operating SIPROTEC® 4 devices Order Number of DIGSI® Pro-
Software tection Operation and Configu-
ration Software
DIGSI REMOTE 4 Software for remotely operating protective devices via a modem
(and possibly a star connector) using DIGSI®. Option package of
the complete version of DIGSI® Order Number
7ST61*1/5
Figure A-1 Connection diagram for 7ST61*1/5 (panel flush mounted or cubicle mounted)
7ST61*3/7
Figure A-2 Connection diagram for 7ST61*3/7 (panel flush mounted or cubicle mounted)
7ST63* Part 1
Figure A-3 Connection diagram for 7ST63 part 1 (panel flush mounted or cubicle mounted)
7ST63* Part 2
Figure A-4 Connection diagram for 7ST63 part 2 (panel flush mounted or cubicle mounted)
Flush Mounted/Cubicle
a
P2 Q3
S2
Q4 I1
S1
P1 Q7
Q8 I3
R17
U1
R18
P2
S2
S1
P1
Figure A-9 Measured value connection in 7ST6**3/7 for autotransformer systems with
synchro-check
The requirements to the feeder current transformers are normally determined by the overcurrent
protection, especially by the setting of the high-set stage. Furthermore, there is a minimum re-
quirement, which is an experimental value.
For the conversion of the requirements to the knee-point voltage and other transformer categories,
reference is made to IEC 60044-6, BS 3938 and ANSI/IEEE C 57.13.
Operational and
Required minimum operational
Nominal Overcur- overcurrent factor
rent Factor
minimum 20
where
n' minimum operational overcurrent factor
I>>PU primary pickup value of the high-set
stage
IpN primary CT rated current
Resulting rated overcurrent factor
where
n Rated overcurrent factor
RBC connected burden (device and connec-
tion lead)
RBN Rated load
RCt Internal transformer load
Calculation
IsN = 1 A
Example according
to IEC 60044-1 n' = 20
RBC = 0.6 (device and connection leads)
RCt = 3
RBN = 5 (5 VA) n with 10 selected,
therefore: 5P10. 5 VA
with
IsN = secondary nominal transformer current
When the device leaves the factory, a large number of LED indications, binary inputs and outputs
as well as function keys are already preset. They are summarised in the following table.
A.5.1 LEDs
Table A-2 Binary input presettings for all devices and ordering variants
Binary Input Allocated Func- Function No. Description
tion
BI1 >FAIL:Feeder VT 361 >Failure: Feeder VT (MCB tripped)
BI2 >VT MCB UF 13951 >U feeder side VT MCB tripped
BI3 >Reset LED 5 >Reset LED
BI4 >Dis.Z1 act. 3901 >Dist.: Zone Z1 is active
BI5 >DisZ1str act 3900 >Dist.: Zone Z1 stroke is active
BI6 >Dis. Z2 act. 3903 >Dist.: Zone Z2 is active
BI7 >DisZ2str act 3902 >Dist.: Zone Z2 stroke is active
BI8 >Dis Z3 act 3907 >Dist.: Zone Z3 active
BI9 >Dis Z3str act 3906 >Dist.: Zone Z3 stroke active
BI10 >Cat.1 active 6605 >First catenary is active
BI11 >Cat.2 active 6604 >Second catenary is active
BI12 >Cat.3 active 6603 >Third catenary is active
Table A-4 Output relay presettings for all devices and ordering variants
Binary Output Allocated Func- Function No. Description
tion
BO1 Protection TRIP 13992 General protective TRIP of device
BO2 With a 2-channel - -
TRIP command
control of the high-
speed overcurrent
protection function
the BO2 is assigned
like BO1. Usually it
BO2 is not as-
signed.
BO3 BrkFailure TRIP 1471 Breaker failure TRIP
CB-TEST TRIP M 13862 CB-Test: TRIP command main trip
element
BO4 AR in progress 2801 Auto-reclose in progress
Th-AR in prog 2805 Th-AR: Thermal AR in progress
BO5 Emer.Gen.Trip 2141 Emerg. O/C protection: General Trip
BO6 O/C TRIP 7211 Overcurrent General TRIP command
BO7 ThOverload TRIP 1521 Thermal Overload TRIP
BO8 Defrost TRIP 13967 Defrosting Protection TRIP
Table A-5 Further output relay presettings for 7ST61* 1/5 and 7ST61* 3/7
Binary Output Allocated Func- Function No. Description
tion
BO9 Dis.Gen. Trip 3801 Distance protection: General trip
BO10 Dis. Z1 act. 3915 Dist.: Zone Z1 is active
BO11 Dis.Z1str act 3916 Dist.: Zone Z1 stroke is active
BO12 Dis.Z2 act. 3917 Dist.: Zone Z2 is active
BO13 Dis.Z2str act 3918 Dist.: Zone Z2 stroke is active
Page 1
Page 2
Page 3
Graphic Display
Note
The above examples of basic displays may deviate, depending on the configuration, with regard
to information contents and extent.
Spontaneous Dis- Spontaneous displays are fault indications which appear in the display automatically following a
plays general fault detection or trip command of the device. In the case of 7ST6 they are the following:
„PU Time“: Operating time from the general pickup to the dropout of the
device, in ms;
„TRIP Time“: Operating time from general pickup to the first trip command of
the device, in ms;
Some CFC charts are already supplied with the SIPROTEC 4 device. Depending on the variant
the following charts may be implemented:
Device and System Some of the event-controlled logical allocations are created with blocks of the slow logic
Logic (PLC1_BEARB = slow PLC processing). This way, the binary input „Data Stop“ is modified from
a single point indication (SP) into an internal single point indication (IntSP) by means of a negator
block.
With double point indication „EarthSwit.“ = CLOSE an indication saying „fdrEARTHED“ ON and
with „EarthSwit.“ = OPEN or INT the indication „fdrEARTHED“ OFF is generated.
From the output indication „definite TRIP“ the internal indication „Brk OPENED“ is generated. As
indication „definite TRIP“ is only queued for 500 ms, indication „Device Brk OPENED“ is also reset
after this time.
Figure A-11 Allocation of input and output with blocks of level System Logic
Interlocking With blocks of level Interlocking (SFS_BEARB = interlocking), standard interlocking for three
switchgears (circuit breaker, disconnector and earth switch) is pre-defined. Due to the large func-
tional scope of the logic you will find this level on two worksheets.
If the above requirements are not fulfilled, the actions of the switch commands will be blocked with
error messages by DIGSI®.
Figure A-12 Standard interlocking for circuit breaker (Breaker), disconnector (Disc. Swit.) and earth switch (GndSwit.)
A.8 Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under Additional Set-
tings.
The table indicates region-specific presettings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corre-
sponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
6101 X1 CL Begin. Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 0.00 X1 (CL), Section 1, Beginning
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 0.00
6102 I1 CL Begin. Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 10.00 A I1 (CL), Section 1, Beginning
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 50.00 A
6103 X1 NF Begin. Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 0.00 X1 (NF), Section 1, Beginning
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 0.00
6104 I1 NF Begin. Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 10.00 A I1 (NF), Section 1, Beginning
5A 0.50 A .. 90.00 A 50.00 A
6110 d1 Middle Fault Locator 1.00 km .. 200.00 km, 10.00 km Distance d, Section 1, Middle
6110 d1 Middle Fault Locator 0.60 mi .. 124.00 mi 6.20 MEIL. Distance d, Section 1, Middle
6111 X1 CL Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 5.00 X1 (CL), Section 1, Middle
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 1.00
6112 I1 CL Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 8.00 A I1 (CL), Section 1, Middle
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 40.00 A
6113 X1 NF Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 5.00 X1 (NF), Section 1, Middle
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 1.00
6114 I1 NF Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 8.00 A I1 (NF), Section 1, Middle
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 40.00 A
6120 d1 MP2 Fault Locator 1.00 km .. 200.00 km, Distance d, Section 1, Measur-
ingpoint 2
6120 d1 MP2 Fault Locator 0.60 mi .. 124.00 mi, Distance d, Section 1, Measur-
ingpoint 2
6122 I1 CL MP2 Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 1.00 A I1 (CL), Section 1, Measuring-
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 5.00 A point 2
6124 I1 NF MP2 Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 1.00 A I1 (NF), Section 1, Measuring-
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 5.00 A point 2
6131 X1 CL End Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 10.00 X1 (CL), Section 1, End
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 2.00
6132 I1 CL End Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 7.00 A I1 (CL), Section 1, End
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 35.00 A
6133 X1 NF End Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 10.00 X1 (NF), Section 1, End
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 2.00
6134 I1 NF End Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 7.00 A I1 (NF), Section 1, End
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 35.00 A
6210 d2 Middle Fault Locator 1.00 km .. 200.00 km 10.00 km Distance d, Section 2, Middle
6210 d2 Middle Fault Locator 0.60 mi .. 124.00 mi 6.20 MEIL. Distance d, Section 2, Middle
6211 X2 CL Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 5.00 X2 (CL), Section 2, Middle
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 1.00
6212 I2 CL Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 8.00 A I2 (CL), Section 2, Middle
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 40.00 A
6213 X2 NF Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 15.00 X2 (NF), Section 2, Middle
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 3.00
6214 I2 NF Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 6.00 A I2 (NF), Section 2, Middle
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 30.00 A
6220 d2 MP2 Fault Locator 1.00 km .. 200.00 km, Distance d, Section 2, Measur-
ingpoint 2
6220 d2 MP2 Fault Locator 0.60 mi .. 124.00 mi, Distance d, Section 2, Measur-
ingpoint 2
6222 I2 CL MP2 Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 1.00 A I2 (CL), Section 2, Measuring-
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 5.00 A point 2
6224 I2 NF MP2 Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 1.00 A I2 (NF), Section 2, Measuring-
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 5.00 A point 2
6231 X2 CL End Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 10.00 X2 (CL), Section 2, End
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 2.00
6232 I2 CL End Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 7.00 A I2 (CL), Section 2, End
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 35.00 A
6233 X2 NF End Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 20.00 X2 (NF), Section 2, End
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 4.00
6234 I2 NF End Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 5.50 A I2 (NF), Section 2, End
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 27.50 A
6310 d3 Middle Fault Locator 1.00 km .. 200.00 km 10.00 km Distance d, Section 3, Middle
6310 d3 Middle Fault Locator 0.60 mi .. 124.00 mi 6.20 MEIL. Distance d, Section 3, Middle
6311 X3 CL Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 25.00 X3 (CL), Section 3, Middle
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 5.00
6312 I3 CL Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 5.00 A I3 (CL), Section 3, Middle
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 25.00 A
6313 X3 NF Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 25.00 X3 (NF), Section 3, Middle
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 5.00
6314 I3 NF Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 5.00 A I3 (NF), Section 3, Middle
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 25.00 A
6320 d3 MP2 Fault Locator 1.00 km .. 200.00 km, Distance d, Section 3, Measur-
ingpoint 2
6320 d3 MP2 Fault Locator 0.60 mi .. 124.00 mi, Distance d, Section 3, Measur-
ingpoint 2
6322 I3 CL MP2 Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 1.00 A I3 (CL), Section 3, Measuring-
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 5.00 A point 2
6324 I3 NF MP2 Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 1.00 A I3 (NF), Section 3, Measuring-
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 5.00 A point 2
6331 X3 CL End Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 10.00 X3 (CL), Section 3, End
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 2.00
6332 I3 CL End Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 7.00 A I3 (CL), Section 3, End
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 35.00 A
6333 X3 NF End Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 30.00 X3 (NF), Section 3, End
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 6.00
6334 I3 NF End Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 4.50 A I3 (NF), Section 3, End
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 22.50 A
6410 d4 Middle Fault Locator 1.00 km .. 200.00 km 10.00 km Distance d, Section 4, Middle
6410 d4 Middle Fault Locator 0.60 mi .. 124.00 mi 6.20 MEIL. Distance d, Section 4, Middle
6411 X4 CL Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 5.00 X4 (CL), Section 4, Middle
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 1.00
6412 I4 CL Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 8.00 A I4 (CL), Section 4, Middle
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 40.00 A
6413 X4 NF Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 35.00 X4 (NF), Section 4, Middle
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 7.00
6414 I4 NF Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 3.50 A I4 (NF), Section 4, Middle
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 17.50 A
6420 d4 MP2 Fault Locator 1.00 km .. 200.00 km, Distance d, Section 4, Measur-
ingpoint 2
6420 d4 MP2 Fault Locator 0.60 mi .. 124.00 mi, Distance d, Section 4, Measur-
ingpoint 2
6422 I4 CL MP2 Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 1.00 A I4 (CL), Section 4, Measuring-
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 5.00 A point 2
6424 I4 NF MP2 Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 1.00 A I4 (NF), Section 4, Measuring-
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 5.00 A point 2
6431 X4 CL End Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 10.00 X4 (CL), Section 4, End
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 2.00
6432 I4 CL End Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 7.00 A I4 (CL), Section 4, End
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 35.00 A
6433 X4 NF End Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 40.00 X4 (NF), Section 4, End
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 8.00
6434 I4 NF End Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 3.00 A I4 (NF), Section 4, End
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 15.00 A
6510 d5 Middle Fault Locator 1.00 km .. 200.00 km 10.00 km Distance d, Section 5, Middle
6510 d5 Middle Fault Locator 0.60 mi .. 124.00 mi 6.20 MEIL. Distance d, Section 5, Middle
6511 X5 CL Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 5.00 X5 (CL), Section 5, Middle
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 1.00
6512 I5 CL Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 8.00 A I5 (CL), Section 5, Middle
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 40.00 A
6513 X5 NF Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 45.00 X5 (NF), Section 5, Middle
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 9.00
6514 I5 NF Middle Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 3.00 A I5 (NF), Section 5, Middle
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 15.00 A
6520 d5 MP2 Fault Locator 1.00 km .. 200.00 km, Distance d, Section 5, Measur-
ingpoint 2
6520 d5 MP2 Fault Locator 0.60 mi .. 124.00 mi, Distance d, Section 5, Measur-
ingpoint 2
6522 I5 CL MP2 Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 1.00 A I5 (CL), Section 5, Measuring-
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 5.00 A point 2
6524 I5 NF MP2 Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 1.00 A I5 (NF), Section 5, Measuring-
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 5.00 A point 2
6531 X5 CL End Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 10.00 X5 (CL), Section 5, End
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 2.00
6532 I5 CL End Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 7.00 A I5 (CL), Section 5, End
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 35.00 A
6533 X5 NF End Fault Locator 1A 0.00 .. 200.00 50.00 X5 (NF), Section 5, End
5A 0.00 .. 40.00 10.00
6534 I5 NF End Fault Locator 1A 0.10 A .. 30.00 A 2.00 A I5 (NF), Section 5, End
5A 0.50 A .. 150.00 A 10.00 A
Indications for IEC 60 870-5-103 are always reported ON / OFF if they are subject to general in-
terrogation for IEC 60 870-5-103. If not, they are reported only as ON.
New user-defined indications or such newly allocated to IEC 60 870-5-103 are set to ON / OFF
and subjected to general interrogation if the information type is not a spontaneous event („.._Ev“).
Further information on indications can be found in detail in the SIPROTEC 4 System Description,
Order No. E50417-H1100-C151.
In columns „Event Log“, „Trip Log“ and „Ground Fault Log“ the following applies:
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
Ground Fault Log ON/OFF
for-
Trip (Fault) Log On/Off
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Event Log ON/OFF
n
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
- Setting Group D is active (P- Change Group IntSP ON * * LED BO 128 26 1 Yes
GrpD act) OFF
- Fault Recording Start (FltRecSta) Osc. Fault Rec. IntSP ON * m LED BO
OFF
- CB-Test:TRIP command main trip Testing - * * * LED BO
element (CB-T T M)
- CB-Test:TRIP command backup Testing - * * * LED BO
trip element (CB-T T B)
- CB-Test: trip/close main trip Testing - * * * LED BO
element (CB-T T/C M)
- CB-Test: trip/close backup trip Testing - * * * LED BO
element (CB-T T/C B)
- Control Authority (Cntrl Auth) Cntrl Authority DP ON * LED 101 85 1 Yes
OFF
- Controlmode LOCAL (ModeLO- Cntrl Authority DP ON * LED 101 86 1 Yes
CAL) OFF
- Controlmode REMOTE (ModeR- Cntrl Authority IntSP ON * LED
EMOTE) OFF
- Breaker (Breaker) Control Device CF_D on * BO 240 160 20
12 off
- Breaker (Breaker) Control Device DP on * BI 240 160 1 Yes
off
- Disconnect Switch (Disc.Swit.) Control Device CF_D on * BO 240 161 20
2 off
- Disconnect Switch (Disc.Swit.) Control Device DP on * BI CB 240 161 1 Yes
off
- Earth Switch (EarthSwit) Control Device CF_D on * BO 240 164 20
2 off
- Earth Switch (EarthSwit) Control Device DP on * BI CB 240 164 1 Yes
off
- Interlocking: Breaker Open (Brk Control Device IntSP * * *
Open)
- Interlocking: Breaker Close (Brk Control Device IntSP * * *
Close)
- Interlocking: Disconnect switch Control Device IntSP * * *
Open (Disc.Open)
- Interlocking: Disconnect switch Control Device IntSP * * *
Close (Disc.Close)
- Interlocking: Earth switch Open Control Device IntSP * * *
(E Sw Open)
- Interlocking: Earth switch Close Control Device IntSP * * *
(E Sw Cl.)
- Fan ON/OFF (Fan ON/OFF) Control Device CF_D on * BO 240 175 20
2 off
- Fan ON/OFF (Fan ON/OFF) Control Device DP on * BI CB 240 175 1 Yes
off
- Unlock data transmission via BI Control Device IntSP * * *
(UnlockDT)
- Error Systeminterface (SysIn- Protocol IntSP on * * LED BO
tErr.) off
1 No Function configured (Not con- Device SP
figured)
2 Function Not Available (Non Exis- Device SP
tent)
3 >Synchronize Internal Real Time Device SP * * * LED BI BO
Clock (>Time Synch)
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
4 >Trigger Waveform Capture Osc. Fault Rec. SP ON * m LED BI BO
(>Trig.Wave.Cap.)
5 >Reset LED (>Reset LED) Device SP * * * LED BI BO
7 >Setting Group Select Bit 0 (>Set Change Group SP * * * LED BI BO
Group Bit0)
8 >Setting Group Select Bit 1 (>Set Change Group SP * * * LED BI BO
Group Bit1)
11 >User defined annunciation 1 P.System Data 1 SP * * * LED BI BO 128 27 1 Yes
(>Annunc. 1)
12 >User defined annunciation 2 P.System Data 1 SP * * * LED BI BO 128 28 1 Yes
(>Annunc. 2)
13 >User defined annunciation 3 P.System Data 1 SP * * * LED BI BO 128 29 1 Yes
(>Annunc. 3)
14 >User defined annunciation 4 P.System Data 1 SP * * * LED BI BO 128 30 1 Yes
(>Annunc. 4)
15 >Test mode (>Test mode) Device SP ON * * LED BI BO 135 53 1 Yes
OFF
16 >Stop data transmission Device SP * * * LED BI BO 135 54 1 Yes
(>DataStop)
51 Device is Operational and Pro- Device OUT ON * * LED BO 138 32 1 Yes
tecting (Device OK) OFF
52 At Least 1 Protection Funct. is P.System Data 2 IntSP ON * * LED BO 128 18 1 Yes
Active (ProtActive) OFF
55 Reset Device (Reset Device) Device OUT * * * LED BO 128 4 1 No
56 Initial Start of Device (Initial Start) Device OUT ON * * LED BO 128 5 1 No
60 Reset LED (Reset LED) Device OUT_ ON
Ev
67 Resume (Resume) Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 97 1 No
68 Clock Synchronization Error Device OUT ON * * LED BO
(Clock SyncError) OFF
69 Daylight Saving Time (Day- Device OUT ON * * LED BO
LightSavTime) OFF
70 Setting calculation is running Device OUT ON * * LED BO 128 22 1 Yes
(Settings Calc.) OFF
71 Settings Check (Settings Check) Device OUT * * * LED BO
72 Level-2 change (Level-2 change) Device OUT ON * * LED BO
OFF
73 Local setting change (Local Device OUT * *
change)
110 Event lost (Event Lost) Device OUT_ on * LED 135 130 1 No
Ev
113 Flag Lost (Flag Lost) Device OUT ON * m LED BO 135 136 1 Yes
125 Chatter ON (Chatter ON) Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 145 1 Yes
OFF
126 Protection ON/OFF (via system P.System Data 2 IntSP ON * * LED BO
port) (ProtON/OFF) OFF
140 Error with a summary alarm Device OUT ON * * LED BO 128 47 1 Yes
(Error Sum Alarm) OFF
144 Error 5V (Error 5V) Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 164 1 Yes
OFF
157 Failure of main circuit breaker Breaker Failure OUT on * * LED BO 138 73 1 Yes
(Fail. MAIN CB) off
158 Failure of outdoor temp. sensing Device OUT on * * LED BO 138 234 1 Yes
(Fail.TEMPSENS) off
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
160 Alarm Summary Event (Alarm Device OUT * * * LED BO 128 46 1 Yes
Sum Event)
169 VT Fuse Failure (alarm >t) (VT Monitoring OUT on * * LED BO 135 188 1 Yes
FuseFail>t) off
170 VT Fuse Failure (alarm instanta- Monitoring OUT on * * LED BO
neous) (VT FuseFail) off
177 Failure: Battery empty (Fail Bat- Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 193 1 Yes
tery) OFF
181 Error: A/D converter (Error A/D- Device OUT ON * * LED BO 128 33 1 Yes
conv.) OFF
182 Alarm: Real Time Clock (Alarm Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 194 1 Yes
Clock) OFF
183 Error Board 1 (Error Board 1) Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 171 1 Yes
OFF
184 Error Board 2 (Error Board 2) Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 172 1 Yes
OFF
185 Error Board 3 (Error Board 3) Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 173 1 Yes
OFF
186 Error Board 4 (Error Board 4) Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 174 1 Yes
OFF
187 Error Board 5 (Error Board 5) Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 175 1 Yes
OFF
188 Error Board 6 (Error Board 6) Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 176 1 Yes
OFF
189 Error Board 7 (Error Board 7) Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 177 1 Yes
OFF
190 Error Board 0 (Error Board 0) Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 210 1 Yes
OFF
192 Error:1A/5Ajumper different from Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 169 1 Yes
setting (Error1A/5Awrong) OFF
193 Alarm: Analog input adjustment Device OUT ON * * LED BO 135 181 1 Yes
invalid (Alarm adjustm.) OFF
196 Fuse Fail Monitor is switched Monitoring OUT on * * LED BO 135 196 1 Yes
OFF (Fuse Fail M.OFF) off
197 Measurement Supervision is Monitoring OUT on * * LED BO 135 197 1 Yes
switched OFF (MeasSup OFF) off
301 Power System fault P.System Data 2 OUT ON ON * 138 43 2 Yes
(Pow.Sys.Flt.) OFF
302 Fault Event (Fault Event) P.System Data 2 OUT * ON * 138 42 2 Yes
356 >Manual close signal (>Manual P.System Data 2 SP * * * LED BI BO 150 6 1 Yes
Close)
357 >Block all close commands from P.System Data 2 SP ON * * LED BI BO 150 7 1 Yes
external (>CloseCmd.Blo) OFF
361 >Failure: Feeder VT (MCB P.System Data 2 SP ON * * LED BI BO 128 38 1 Yes
tripped) (>FAIL:Feeder VT) OFF
365 >Select: Control by BI or SYS in- P.System Data 2 SP ON * * LED BI BO
terface (>Ctrl Select.) OFF
378 >CB faulty (>CB faulty) P.System Data 2 SP * * * LED BI BO
385 >Lockout SET (>Lockout SET) P.System Data 2 SP ON * * LED BI BO 150 35 1 Yes
OFF
386 >Lockout RESET (>Lockout P.System Data 2 SP ON * * LED BI BO 150 36 1 Yes
RESET) OFF
510 General CLOSE of relay (Relay P.System Data 2 OUT * * * LED BO
CLOSE)
511 Relay GENERAL TRIP command P.System Data 2 OUT * m LED BO
(Relay TRIP)
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
530 LOCKOUT is active (LOCKOUT) P.System Data 2 IntSP ON ON * LED BO 150 170 1 Yes
OFF OFF
536 Final Trip (Final Trip) P.System Data 2 OUT ON ON * LED BO 150 180 2 No
545 Time from Pickup to drop out (PU P.System Data 2 VI
Time)
546 Time from Pickup to TRIP (TRIP P.System Data 2 VI
Time)
561 Manual close signal detected P.System Data 2 OUT ON * * LED BO 150 211 1 No
(Man.Clos.Detect)
562 CB close command for manual P.System Data 2 OUT * * * LED BO 150 212 1 No
closing (Man.Close Cmd)
563 CB alarm suppressed (CB Alarm P.System Data 2 OUT * * LED BO
Supp)
1000 Number of breaker TRIP com- Statistics VI * *
mands (# TRIPs=)
1008 Sum of fault currents (I/In)^2 Statistics VI * *
((I/In)^2=)
1110 Fault locator is blocked (FltLoc Fault Locator OUT on * * LED BO 138 11 1 Yes
block) off
1114 Flt Locator: primary RESIS- Fault Locator VI * on off 138 1 4 No
TANCE (Rpri =)
1115 Flt Locator: primary REAC- Fault Locator VI * on off 128 73 4 No
TANCE (Xpri =)
1117 Flt Locator: secondary RESIS- Fault Locator VI * on off 138 2 4 No
TANCE (Rsec =)
1118 Flt Locator: secondary REAC- Fault Locator VI * on off 138 8 4 No
TANCE (Xsec =)
1119 Flt Locator: Distance to fault (dist Fault Locator VI * on off 138 3 4 No
=)
1120 Flt Locator: Distance [%] to fault Fault Locator VI * on off 138 4 4 No
(d[%] =)
1121 Fault in section (Fault section) Fault Locator VI * on off 138 5 4 No
1122 Flt Locator: Distance to fault (dist Fault Locator VI * on off 138 10 4 No
=)
1129 No calculation of distance possi- Fault Locator OUT on * * LED BO 138 6 1 No
ble (FltLoc imposs)
1130 Distance to fault out of range (Flt Fault Locator OUT on * * LED BO 138 7 1 No
dist >)
1132 Fault location invalid (Flt.Loc.in- Fault Locator OUT_ * on LED
valid) Ev
1190 Forward direction (forward dir.) Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO 138 40 1 Yes
off
1191 Pickup autom. testunit P.System Data 2 OUT on * LED BO 138 38 2 Yes
overh.cont.line (Pckup TstUnit)
1401 >BF: Switch on breaker fail pro- Breaker Failure SP on * * LED BI BO
tection (>BF on) off
1402 >BF: Switch off breaker fail pro- Breaker Failure SP on * * LED BI BO
tection (>BF off) off
1431 >Breaker failure initiated exter- Breaker Failure SP on * * LED BI BO
nally (>BrkFail extSRC) off
1438 >External CB Trip (>Ext. CB Trip) Trip Superv SP on * * LED BI BO
off
1440 Breaker failure prot. ON/OFF via Breaker Failure IntSP * * * LED BO
BI (BkrFailON/offBI)
1451 Breaker failure is switched OFF Breaker Failure OUT on * * LED BO 138 64 1 Yes
(BkrFail OFF) off
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
1455 Breaker failure : fault detection Breaker Failure OUT * on off * LED BO 138 75 2 Yes
(B/F fault)
1471 Breaker failure TRIP (BrkFailure Breaker Failure OUT * on * LED BO 138 76 2 No
TRIP)
1484 B/F: pick up superordinat.prot.re- Breaker Failure OUT * on * LED BO 138 72 2 No
lais (B/F s.ordProt)
1491 Circuit Breaker Fault (CB Fault) Trip Superv OUT on on off * LED BO 138 74 1 Yes
off
1501 >Switch on thermal overload pro- Therm. Overload SP on * * LED BI BO 167 1 1 Yes
tection (>O/L on) off
1502 >Switch off thermal overload pro- Therm. Overload SP on * * LED BI BO 167 2 1 Yes
tection (>O/L off) off
1511 Thermal Overload Protection Therm. Overload OUT on * * LED BO 138 224 1 Yes
OFF (Th.Overload OFF) off
1516 Overload Alarm! Near Thermal Therm. Overload OUT on * * LED BO 138 230 1 Yes
Trip (O/L Alarm) off
1521 Thermal Overload TRIP (ThOver- Therm. Overload OUT on * m LED BO 138 231 1 No
load TRIP)
1820 Ip picked up (Ip picked up) Overcurrent OUT * on off * LED BO 138 212 2 Yes
1825 Ip TRIP (Ip TRIP) Overcurrent OUT * on * LED BO 138 216 2 No
2001 >Switch ON emerg. overcurrent Emerg. O/C SP on * * LED BI BO 61 1 1 Yes
prot. (>Emer. ON) off
2002 >Switch OFF emerg. overcurrent Emerg. O/C SP on * * LED BI BO 61 2 1 Yes
prot. (>Emer. OFF) off
2051 Emergency O/C protect. is Emerg. O/C OUT on * * LED BO 61 51 1 Yes
switched off (Emer. off) off
2053 Emergency O/C protection is Emerg. O/C OUT on * * LED BO
active (Emer. active) off
2054 Emergency mode (Emer. mode) Monitoring OUT on * * LED BO 128 37 1 Yes
off
2061 Emerg. O/C prot.: General fault Emerg. O/C OUT * on off m LED BO 61 61 2 Yes
detect. (Emer.Gen.Flt)
2141 Emerg. O/C protection: General Emerg. O/C OUT * on m LED BO 138 53 2 No
Trip (Emer.Gen.Trip)
2640 FL Fault direction forward (FL Flt Fault Locator OUT * * * LED BO 138 54 2 No
forward)
2641 FL Fault direction reverse (FL Flt Fault Locator OUT * * * LED BO 138 55 2 No
reverse)
2701 >Auto reclose ON (>AR ON) Auto Reclose SP on * * LED BI BO 40 1 1 Yes
off
2702 >Auto reclose OFF (>AR OFF) Auto Reclose SP on * * LED BI BO 40 2 1 Yes
off
2703 >BLOCK Auto reclose (>BLOCK Auto Reclose SP on on off * LED BI BO 40 3 1 Yes
AR) off
2710 >Th-AR: Block thermal AR-func- Auto Reclose SP on on off * LED BI BO 40 5 1 Yes
tion (>Th-AR block) off
2711 >External start of internal Auto Auto Reclose SP * on off * LED BI BO 40 11 2 Yes
reclose (>AR Start)
2718 >Th-AR: Switch on thermal-AR Auto Reclose SP on * * LED BI BO 40 18 1 Yes
function (>Th-AR ON) off
2719 >Th-AR: Switch off thermal-AR Auto Reclose SP on * * LED BI BO 40 19 1 Yes
function (>Th-AR OFF) off
2730 >Circuit breaker READY for re- P.System Data 2 SP * * * LED BI BO 40 30 1 Yes
closing (>CB Ready)
2731 >AR: Synchronism from ext. Auto Reclose SP * * * LED BI BO 40 31 2 Yes
sync.-check (>Sync.release)
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
2742 >AR: Block 1st AR-cycle (>BLK Auto Reclose SP on on off * LED BI BO 40 37 1 Yes
1.AR-cycle) off
2746 >AR: External Trip for AR start Auto Reclose SP * on off * LED BI BO 40 41 2 Yes
(>Trip for AR)
2781 Auto recloser is switched OFF Auto Reclose OUT on * * LED BO 40 81 1 Yes
(Auto recl. OFF) off
2782 Auto recloser is switched ON Auto Reclose IntSP * * * LED BO 128 16 1 Yes
(Auto recl. ON)
2783 AR: Auto-reclose is blocked (AR Auto Reclose OUT on * * LED BO 128 130 1 Yes
is blocked) off
2784 Auto recloser is NOT ready (AR is Auto Reclose OUT on * * LED BO
NOT ready) off
2785 Auto-reclose is dynamically Auto Reclose OUT * on * LED BO 40 85 2 Yes
BLOCKED (AR DynBlock)
2787 AR: Circuit breaker not ready (CB Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 87 1 Yes
not ready)
2788 AR: CB ready monitoring window Auto Reclose OUT * on * LED BO 40 88 2 No
expired (AR T-CBreadyExp)
2793 Th-AR: Thermal AR not ready Auto Reclose OUT on * * LED BO 40 136 1 Yes
(Th-AR not rdy) off
2794 Th-AR: Thermal AR is switched Auto Reclose OUT on * * LED BO 40 94 1 Yes
off (Th-AR off) off
2795 Th-AR: Thermal AR is switched Auto Reclose IntSP * * * LED BO 40 17 1 Yes
on (Th-AR on)
2796 AR: Auto-reclose ON/OFF via BI Auto Reclose IntSP * * * LED BO
(AR on/off BI)
2801 Auto-reclose in progress (AR in Auto Reclose OUT * on * LED BO 40 101 2 Yes
progress)
2805 Th-AR: Thermal AR in progress Auto Reclose OUT * on * LED BO 40 104 2 Yes
(Th-AR in prog)
2808 AR: CB open with no trip (AR Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 55 1 Yes
BLK: CB open)
2809 AR: Start-signal monitoring time Auto Reclose OUT * on * LED BO 40 174 2 No
expired (AR T-Start Exp)
2810 AR: Maximum dead time expired Auto Reclose OUT * on * LED BO 40 175 2 No
(AR TdeadMax Exp)
2819 Th-AR: dead time is running Auto Reclose OUT * on * LED BO 40 138 2 Yes
(ThAR Tdead ru)
2823 AR: no starter configured (AR no Auto Reclose OUT on * * LED BO
starter) off
2829 AR: action time expired before Auto Reclose OUT * on * LED BO
trip (AR Tact expired)
2844 AR 1st cycle running (AR 1stCyc. Auto Reclose OUT * on * LED BO 40 155 2 Yes
run.)
2851 Auto-reclose Close command Auto Reclose OUT * on m LED BO 40 128 2 No
(AR Close)
2855 Th-AR: Close command from Auto Reclose OUT * on m LED BO 40 139 2 No
thermal AR (Th-AR ClosCmd)
2861 AR: Reclaim time is running (AR Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 161 1 Yes
T-Recl. run.)
2862 Auto reclose cycle successful Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 162 1 Yes
(AR Successful)
2863 Auto reclose Lockout (AR Lock- Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 163 1 Yes
out)
2865 AR: Synchro-check request (AR Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 165 2 Yes
Sync.Request)
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
2866 Th-AR: Therm.AR reclaim time is Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO
running (Th-AR T-Recl.)
2867 Th-AR: Thermal AR cycle suc- Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 168 1 Yes
cessful (Th-AR success)
2868 Th-AR: Thermal AR definite trip Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 166 1 Yes
(Th-AR def.Trp)
2901 >Switch on synchro-check func- Sync. Check SP on * * LED BI BO
tion (>Sync. on) off
2902 >Switch off synchro-check func- Sync. Check SP on * * LED BI BO
tion (>Sync. off) off
2903 >BLOCK synchro-check function Sync. Check SP * * * LED BI BO
(>BLOCK Sync.)
2905 >Start synchro-check for Manual Sync. Check SP on * * LED BI BO
Close (>Sync. Start MC) off
2906 >Start synchro-check for AR Sync. Check SP on * * LED BI BO
(>Sync. Start AR) off
2907 >Sync-Prog. Live bus / live line / Sync. Check SP * * * LED BI BO
Sync (>Sync. synch)
2911 >Sync-Prog. Override ( bypass ) Sync. Check SP * * * LED BI BO
(>Sync. o/ride)
2930 Synchro-check ON/OFF via BI Sync. Check IntSP on * * LED BO
(Sync. on/off BI) off
2931 Synchro-check is switched OFF Sync. Check OUT on * * LED BO 41 31 1 Yes
(Sync. OFF) off
2932 Synchro-check is BLOCKED Sync. Check OUT on on off * LED BO 41 32 1 Yes
(Sync. BLOCK) off
2934 Synchro-check function faulty Sync. Check OUT on * * LED BO 41 34 1 Yes
(Sync. faulty) off
2935 Synchro-check supervision time Sync. Check OUT on on * LED BO 41 35 1 No
expired (Sync.Tsup.Exp)
2936 Synchro-check request by control Sync. Check OUT on on * LED BO 41 36 1 No
(Sync. req.CNTRL)
2941 Synchronization is running (Sync. Sync. Check OUT on on * LED BO 41 41 1 Yes
running) off
2942 Synchro-check override/bypass Sync. Check OUT on on * LED BO 41 42 1 Yes
(Sync.Override) off
2943 Synchronism detected (Synchro- Sync. Check OUT on * * LED BO 41 43 1 Yes
nism) off
2944 Sync. Dead ref. / Live line detect- Sync. Check OUT on * * LED BO 41 44 1 Yes
ed (SYN Uref<Uline>) off
2945 Sync. Live ref. / Dead line detect- Sync. Check OUT on * * LED BO 41 45 1 Yes
ed (SYN Uref>Uline<) off
2946 Sync. Dead ref. / Dead line de- Sync. Check OUT on * * LED BO 41 46 1 Yes
tected (SYN Uref<Uline<) off
2947 Sync. Voltage diff. greater than Sync. Check OUT on on off * LED BO 41 47 1 Yes
limit (Sync. Udiff>) off
2948 Sync. Freq. diff. greater than limit Sync. Check OUT on on off * LED BO 41 48 1 Yes
(Sync. fdiff>) off
2949 Sync. Angle diff. greater than limit Sync. Check OUT on on off * LED BO 41 49 1 Yes
(Sync. -diff>) off
2951 Synchronism release (to ext. AR) Sync. Check OUT * * * LED BO 41 51 1 Yes
(Sync. release)
2961 Close command from synchro- Sync. Check OUT * * * LED BO 41 61 1 Yes
check (Sync.CloseCmd)
2970 Sync. Reference frequency > Sync. Check OUT on on off * LED BO
(fn+3Hz) (Sync. fref>>) off
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
2971 Sync. Reference frequency < (fn- Sync. Check OUT on on off * LED BO
3Hz) (Sync. fref<<) off
2972 Sync. Line frequency > (fn + 3Hz) Sync. Check OUT on on off * LED BO
(Sync. f-line>>) off
2973 Sync. Line frequency < (fn - 3Hz) Sync. Check OUT on on off * LED BO
(Sync. f-line<<) off
2974 Sync. Reference voltage > Umax Sync. Check OUT on on off * LED BO
(Sync. Uref>>) off
2975 Sync. Reference voltage < U> Sync. Check OUT on on off * LED BO
(Sync. Uref<<) off
2976 Sync. Line voltage > Umax Sync. Check OUT on on off * LED BO
(P.3504) (Sync. U-line>>) off
2977 Sync. Line voltage < U> (P.3503) Sync. Check OUT on on off * LED BO
(Sync. U-line<<) off
3601 >Distance protection is switched Distance prot. SP on * * LED BI BO
on (>Dis.prot. on) off
3602 >Distance protection is switched Distance prot. SP on * * LED BI BO
off (>Dis.prot.off) off
3603 >BLOCK Distance protection Distance prot. SP on * * LED BI BO
(>BLOCK Distance) off
3651 Distance is switched off (Dist. Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO 138 96 1 Yes
OFF) off
3652 Distance is BLOCKED (Dist. Distance prot. OUT on on off * LED BO 28 52 1 Yes
BLOCK) off
3653 Distance is ACTIVE (Dist. Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO 28 53 1 Yes
ACTIVE) off
3671 Distance PICKED UP (Dis. Distance prot. OUT * on off m LED BO 28 71 2 Yes
PICKUP)
3740 Dist.: Fault detection Zone Z1 Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 116 2 Yes
(Dist. Z1)
3755 Distance Pickup Z2 (Dis. Pickup Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 117 2 Yes
Z2)
3758 Distance Pickup Z3 (Dis. Pickup Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 118 2 Yes
Z3)
3771 DistanceTime Out T1 (Dis.Time Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 176 2 No
Out T1)
3780 DistanceTime Out T1B (Dis.Tim- Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO
eOut T1B)
3783 Dist.: Time T1L ( Zone Z1L ) Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO
expired (Dist. T1L)
3801 Distance protection: General trip Distance prot. OUT * on m LED BO 138 192 2 No
(Dis.Gen. Trip)
3810 Dist.: Trip in Zone Z1 (Dis.Trip Z1) Distance prot. OUT * * * LED BO 128 78 2 No
3900 >Dist.: Zone Z1 stroke is active Distance prot. SP * * * LED BI BO 28 22 1 Yes
(>DisZ1str act)
3901 >Dist.: Zone Z1 is active (>Dis.Z1 Distance prot. SP * * * LED BI BO 28 21 1 Yes
act.)
3902 >Dist.: Zone Z2 stroke is active Distance prot. SP * * * LED BI BO 28 24 1 Yes
(>DisZ2str act)
3903 >Dist.: Zone Z2 is active (>Dis. Distance prot. SP * * * LED BI BO 28 23 1 Yes
Z2 act.)
3906 >Dist.: Zone Z3 stroke active Distance prot. SP * * * LED BI BO 28 26 1 Yes
(>Dis Z3str act)
3907 >Dist.: Zone Z3 active (>Dis Z3 Distance prot. SP * * * LED BI BO 28 25 1 Yes
act)
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
3909 Dist.: Delay Time T2K is active Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO
(Dis. T2K active) off
3915 Dist.: Zone Z1 is active (Dis. Z1 Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO 138 80 1 Yes
act.) off
3916 Dist.: Zone Z1 stroke is active Distance prot. IntSP on * * LED BO 138 85 1 Yes
(Dis.Z1str act) off
3917 Dist.: Zone Z2 is active (Dis.Z2 Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO 138 81 1 Yes
act.) off
3918 Dist.: Zone Z2 stroke is active Distance prot. IntSP on * * LED BO 138 86 1 Yes
(Dis.Z2str act) off
3925 Dist.: Flt. detect. Z2 (short circuit) Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 128 2 Yes
(Dist.Flt.Z2K)
3926 Dist.: Fault detection Z2 (over- Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 132 2 Yes
load) (Dist.Flt.Z2L)
3927 Dist.: Flt. detect. VE (short circuit) Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 28 115 2 Yes
(Dist.Flt.VE)
3930 Dist.: Trip in zone Z2 (short cir- Distance prot. OUT * * * LED BO 138 194 2 No
cuit) (Dis. Trip Z2K)
3931 Dist.: Trip in zone Z2 (overload) Distance prot. OUT * * * LED BO 138 198 2 No
(Dis. Trip Z2L)
3935 Dist.: Time T2K (Zone Z2) Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 177 2 No
expired (Dist. T2K)
3936 Dist.: Time T2L (Zone Z2) expired Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 181 2 No
(Dist. T2L)
3941 Fault impedance, Ohm sec. Measurement VI ON 138 9 4 No
(Zsec=) OFF
3943 DIS Fault direction forward (DIS Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 128 74 2 No
Flt forward)
3944 DIS Fault direction reverse (DIS Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 128 75 2 No
Flt reverse)
3991 Dist.: Zone Z3 is active (Dis. Z3 Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO 138 82 1 Yes
act) off
3992 Dist.: Zone Z3 stroke is active Distance prot. IntSP on * * LED BO 138 87 1 Yes
(Dis. Z3str act) off
4004 >Dist. teleprotection: Carrier Distance prot. SP * on * LED BI BO
receive (>Dis. Recept)
4005 >Dist. teleprotection: Carrier Distance prot. SP * on * LED BI BO
faulty (>Dis.RecFail)
4067 Dis. Telep. Transient Blocking Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO
(Dis EchoSend)
4271 HS O/C is switched OFF (HS O/C HS O/C OUT on * * LED BO 25 71 1 Yes
OFF) off
4281 HS O/C PICKED UP (HS O/C HS O/C OUT * on off m LED BO 138 218 2 Yes
PICKUP)
4293 HS O/C TRIPPED (HS O/C TRIP) HS O/C OUT * on m LED 138 220 2 No
4331 Overvoltage detection : Stage U> Over/Under Volt OUT * on off * LED BO 50 31 2 Yes
(U> Detection)
4332 Overvoltage detection : Stage Over/Under Volt OUT * on off * LED BO 50 32 2 Yes
U>> (U>> Detection)
4335 Overvoltage trip : Stage U> (U> Over/Under Volt OUT * on * LED BO 50 35 2 Yes
Trip)
4336 Overvoltage trip : Stage U>> Over/Under Volt OUT * on * LED BO 50 36 2 Yes
(U>> Trip)
4601 >Breaker contact (OPEN, if bkr is P.System Data 2 SP * * * LED BI BO 150 60 1 Yes
open) (>Brk Aux NO)
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
4602 >Breaker contact(OPEN, if bkr is P.System Data 2 SP * * * LED BI BO 150 61 1 Yes
closed) (>Brk Aux NC)
6603 >Third catenary is active (>Cat.3 Therm. Overload SP * * * LED BI BO
active)
6604 >Second catenary is active Therm. Overload SP * * * LED BI BO
(>Cat.2 active)
6605 >First catenary is active (>Cat.1 Therm. Overload SP * * * LED BI BO
active)
6616 First catenary is active (Cat. 1 Therm. Overload IntSP on * * LED BO 138 225 1 Yes
active) off
6617 Second catenary is active (Cat. 2 Therm. Overload IntSP on * * LED BO 138 226 1 Yes
active) off
6618 Third catenary is active (Cat. 3 Therm. Overload IntSP on * * LED BO 138 227 1 Yes
active) off
6854 >Trip circuit superv. 1: Trip Relay TripCirc.Superv SP on * * LED BI BO
(>TripC1 TripRel) off
6855 >Trip circuit superv. 1: Breaker TripCirc.Superv SP on * * LED BI BO
Relay (>TripC1 Bkr.Rel) off
6861 Trip circuit supervision OFF TripCirc.Superv OUT on * * LED BO
(TripC OFF) off
6865 Failure Trip Circuit (FAIL: Trip cir.) TripCirc.Superv OUT on * * LED BO 128 36 1 Yes
off
6866 TripC1 blocked: Binary Input is TripCirc.Superv OUT on * * LED BO
not set (TripC1 ProgFAIL) off
7151 Overcurrent is switched OFF Overcurrent OUT on * * LED BO 138 208 1 Yes
(O/C OFF) off
7161 Overcurrent PICKED UP (O/C Overcurrent OUT * * * LED BO 64 61 2 Yes
PICKUP)
7191 Overcurrent Pickup I>> (O/C Overcurrent OUT * on off * LED BO 138 210 2 Yes
PICKUP I>>)
7192 Overcurrent Pickup I> (O/C Overcurrent OUT * on off * LED BO 138 209 2 Yes
PICKUP I>)
7201 O/C I-STUB Pickup (I-STUB Overcurrent OUT * on off * LED BO 138 211 2 Yes
PICKUP)
7211 Overcurrent General TRIP Overcurrent OUT * * * LED BO 64 111 2 No
command (O/C TRIP)
7221 Overcurrent TRIP I>> (O/C TRIP Overcurrent OUT * on * LED BO 138 214 2 No
I>>)
7222 Overcurrent TRIP I> (O/C TRIP Overcurrent OUT * on * LED BO 138 213 2 No
I>)
7235 O/C I-STUB TRIP (I-STUB TRIP) Overcurrent OUT * on * LED BO 138 215 2 No
7345 CB-TEST is in progress (CB- Testing OUT on * * LED BO 153 45 1 Yes
TEST running) off
7346 CB-TEST canceled due to Power Testing OUT_ on * LED
Sys. Fault (CB-TSTstop FLT.) Ev
7347 CB-TEST canceled due to CB Testing OUT_ on * LED
already OPEN (CB-TSTstop Ev
OPEN)
7348 CB-TEST canceled due to CB Testing OUT_ on * LED
was NOT READY (CB-TSTstop Ev
NOTr)
7349 CB-TEST canceled due to CB Testing OUT_ on * LED
stayed CLOSED (CB-TSTstop Ev
CLOS)
7350 CB-TEST was succesful (CB- Testing OUT_ on * LED
TST .OK.) Ev
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
13800 di/dt function is active in Zone Z2 Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO
(Z2di/dt ACTIVE) off
13801 du/dt function is active in Zone Z2 Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO
(Z2du/dt ACTIVE) off
13802 di/dt function is active in Zone Z3 Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO
(Z3di/dt ACTIVE) off
13803 du/dt function is active in Zone Z3 Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO
(Z3du/dt ACTIVE) off
13804 Dist.: Delay Time T3K is active Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO
(Dis. T3K active) off
13805 Time Out T3K (Time Out T3K) Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 178 2 No
13806 Time Out T3L (Time Out T3L) Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 182 2 No
13807 Picked up in Zone Z1Strk (PU Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 121 2 Yes
Z1Strk)
13808 Picked up in Zone Z2Strk (PU Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 122 2 Yes
Z2Strk)
13809 Picked up in Zone Z3Strk (PU Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 123 2 Yes
Z3Strk)
13810 ON/OFF via BI (ON/offBI) Distance prot. IntSP * * * LED BO
13811 Zone Z1Stroke ON/OFF via Distance prot. IntSP * * * LED BO
Serial Inteface (Z1StrkON/OFFs-
er)
13812 Distance Zone Z2Stroke ON Distance prot. IntSP * * * LED BO
(Z2StrkON/OFFser)
13813 Distance Zone Z3Stroke ON Distance prot. IntSP * * * LED BO
(Z3StrkON/OFFser)
13815 HS O/C TRIPPED (M) (HS O/C HS O/C OUT * * * LED BO
TRIP (M))
13816 >Switch on HS O/C Protection HS O/C SP on * * LED BI BO
(>HS O/C ON) off
13817 >Switch off HS O/C Protection HS O/C SP on * * LED BI BO
(>HS O/C OFF) off
13818 HS O/C ON/OFF about Binary HS O/C IntSP * * * LED BO
Input (HSo/c ON/OFF BI)
13819 HS O/C uC-Failure (HS O/C Fail- HS O/C OUT on * * LED BO 138 221 1 Yes
ure) off
13820 >Switch on Overcurrent Protec- Overcurrent SP on * * LED BI BO 64 1 1 Yes
tion (>O/C ON) off
13821 >Switch off Overcurrent Protec- Overcurrent SP on * * LED BI BO 64 2 1 Yes
tion (>O/C OFF) off
13822 Overcurrent Protection ON/OFF Overcurrent IntSP * * * LED BO
via BI (O/C ON/OFF BI)
13824 Overload Protection ON/OFF via Therm. Overload IntSP * * * LED BO
BI (O/L ON/OFF BI)
13825 O/L Inrush blocking (O/L blocked) Therm. Overload OUT on * * LED BO 138 232 1 Yes
off
13826 Reset thermal replica (Reset- Therm. Overload IntSP on * * LED BO 138 239 1 No
ThermRepl)
13827 O/L Catenary 1 ON/OFF via Tele- Therm. Overload IntSP * * * LED BO
gram (Cat1 ON/OFF TEL)
13828 O/L Catenary 2 ON/OFF via Tele- Therm. Overload IntSP * * * LED BO
gram (Cat2 ON/OFF TEL)
13829 O/L Catenary 3 ON/OFF via Tele- Therm. Overload IntSP * * * LED BO
gram (Cat3 ON/OFF TEL)
13830 Overvoltage Protection is Over/Under Volt OUT on * * LED BO 73 2 1 Yes
switched off (OVER. OFF) off
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
13832 Undervoltage Protection is Over/Under Volt OUT on * * LED BO 73 4 1 Yes
switched off (UNDER. OFF) off
13834 Over/Undervoltage Protection Over/Under Volt OUT * * m LED BO 73 32 2 Yes
picked up (OVER/UNDER PU)
13835 Undervolt. U< picked up (UNDER Over/Under Volt OUT * on off * LED BO 73 33 2 Yes
U< PU)
13836 Undervolt. U<< picked up Over/Under Volt OUT * on off * LED BO 73 34 2 Yes
(UNDER U<< PU)
13837 Undervolt. U< TRIP command Over/Under Volt OUT * on * LED BO 73 36 2 Yes
(UNDER U< TRIP)
13838 Undervolt. U<< TRIP command Over/Under Volt OUT * on * LED BO 73 37 2 Yes
(UNDER U<< TRIP)
13839 Over/Undervoltage Prot. TRIP Over/Under Volt OUT * * m LED BO 73 35 2 No
comm. (OVER/UNDER TRIP)
13840 Distance Protection: Inrush Distance prot. OUT on on off * LED BO 28 60 1 Yes
blocked (Dis Rush blk) off
13841 Overcurrent Protection: Inrush Overcurrent OUT on on off * LED BO 64 3 1 Yes
blocked (O/C Rush blk) off
13842 Emerg. O/C Protection: Inrush Emerg. O/C OUT on on off * LED BO 61 8 1 Yes
blocked (Emer. Rush blk) off
13845 >Switch on It function (>It ON) It Function SP on * * LED BI BO
off
13846 >Switch off It function (>It OFF) It Function SP on * * LED BI BO
off
13847 CB It Alarm Stage (It Alarm) It Function OUT * * * LED BO 138 17 1 Yes
13848 Start time for It measurement It Function OUT_ * on LED
(Start It Meas) Ev
13849 Overflow It measurement (It It Function OUT * * * LED BO 138 18 1 No
Overflow)
13850 It function is ACTIVE (It ACTIVE) It Function OUT * * * LED BO 138 19 1 Yes
13851 Summation of measured It values Statistics VI * *
( It=)
13852 Summation of measured I2t Statistics VI * *
values ( I2t=)
13853 Last It value measured (Last It=) Statistics VI * *
13854 Last I2t value measured (Last Statistics VI * *
I2t=)
13855 It measurement CB settings not It Function OUT * * * LED BO
plausible (It set error)
13856 It function: ON/OFF via BI (It It Function IntSP * * * LED BO
ON/offBI)
13857 2P function is ACTIVE (2P It Function OUT * * * LED BO 138 20 1 Yes
ACTIVE)
13860 >CB-Test: Start TRIP cycle (>CB- Testing SP * * * LED BI BO
TEST)
13861 >CB-Test: Start TRIP-CLOSE Testing SP * * * LED BI BO
cycle (>CB-TEST AR)
13862 CB-Test: TRIP command main Testing OUT on * * LED BO 138 34 1 Yes
trip element (CB-TEST TRIP M) off
13863 CB-Test: TRIP command backup Testing OUT on * * LED BO 138 35 1 Yes
trip elem. (CB-TEST TRIP B) off
13864 CB-Test: CLOSE command main Testing OUT on * * LED BO 153 30 1 Yes
trip element (CB-TEST CLOSE off
M)
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
13865 CB-Test: CLOSE command Testing OUT on * * LED BO 153 31 1 Yes
backup trip elem. (CB-TEST off
CLOSE B)
13870 AR Number reclosure attempts Statistics VI * *
1st cycle (AR 1st cycle=)
13871 AR Number reclosure attempts Statistics VI * *
>1st cycle (AR >1st cycle=)
13872 AR thermal trip:ON/OFF via Tele- Auto Reclose IntSP * * * LED BO
gram (AR TH ON/OFFtel)
13873 AR thermal trip:ON/OFF via Auto Reclose IntSP * * * LED BO
Binary Input (AR TH ON/OFF BI)
13874 >AR: BLOCK 2nd-nth cycle (>AR Auto Reclose SP on on off * LED BI BO 40 48 1 Yes
BLK >1st) off
13875 AR thermal trip:Time Out Dead Auto Reclose OUT on * * LED BO
time (AR TH TO Tdead) off
13876 AR thermal trip:dynam. blocked Auto Reclose OUT * * m LED BO 40 97 1 Yes
(AR TH dyn Blk)
13877 AR Dead time is running (AR Auto Reclose OUT * on * LED BO 40 72 2 Yes
Dead Time)
13878 AR 2nd cycle or higher is running Auto Reclose OUT * on * LED BO 40 66 2 Yes
(AR >1st cycle)
13879 AR CLOSE command 1st cycle Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 128 128 1 No
(AR Close 1st)
13880 AR CLOSE command 2nd cycle Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 128 129 1 No
or higher (AR Close >1st)
13881 AR ON/OFF via Telegram (AR Auto Reclose IntSP on * * LED BO
ON/OFF TEL) off
13882 AR blocked by failure direction Auto Reclose OUT * on * LED BO 40 58 2 Yes
(AR BLK DIR)
13883 AR blocked by max. current (AR Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 57 2 Yes
BLK I MAX)
13884 AR blocked by BF (AR BLK BF) Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 56 2 Yes
13885 AR blocked by manual closing Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 54 1 Yes
(AR BLK MC)
13886 AR enable Zone Z1 (AR EN Z1) Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 61 1 Yes
13887 AR enable Zone Z1B (AR EN Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 62 1 Yes
Z1B)
13888 AR enable Zone Z1L (AR EN Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 63 1 Yes
Z1L)
13889 AR after thermal trip cannot start Auto Reclose OUT on * * LED BO 40 95 1 Yes
(AR TH T Reclaim) off
13890 Distance Prot. Picked up in Zone Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO
Z1B (Dis PU Z1B)
13891 Distance Prot. Picked up in Zone Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO
Z1L (Dis PU Z1L)
13892 Picked up di/dt function in Zone Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 160 2 Yes
Z2 (Dis PU Z2di/dt)
13893 Picked up du/dt function in Zone Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 164 2 Yes
Z2 (Dis PU Z2du/dt)
13894 Picked up di/dt function in Zone Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 161 2 Yes
Z3 (Dis PU Z3di/dt)
13895 Picked up du/dt function in Zone Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 165 2 Yes
Z3 (Dis PU Z3du/dt)
13896 Picked up in Zone Z3 (short cir- Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 129 2 Yes
cuit) (Dis PU Z3K)
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
13897 Picked up in Zone Z3 (overload) Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 138 133 2 Yes
(Dis PU Z3L)
13900 Distance Protection TRIP in Zone Distance prot. OUT * * * LED BO 28 118 2 No
Z1B (Dis TRIP Z1B)
13901 Distance Protection TRIP in Zone Distance prot. OUT * * * LED BO 28 119 2 No
Z1L (Dis TRIP Z1L)
13903 Dist. Prot. TRIP Zone Z3 (short Distance prot. OUT * * * LED BO 138 195 2 No
circuit) (Dis TRIP Z3K)
13904 Dist. Prot. TRIP Zone Z3 (over- Distance prot. OUT * * * LED BO 138 199 2 No
load) (Dis TRIP Z3L)
13905 Dist. Prot. TRIP after PU by Man. Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 28 116 2 No
Close (Dis TRIP PU MC)
13906 TRIP Overreach Zone after Man. Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO 28 117 2 No
Close (Dis TRIP MC ZOR)
13911 Zone Z1Stroke ON/OFF about Distance prot. IntSP * * * LED BO
Binary Input (Z1StrkON/OFF BI)
13912 Zone Z2Stroke ON/OFF about Distance prot. IntSP * * * LED BO
Binary Input (Z2StrkON/OFF BI)
13913 Zone Z3Stroke ON/OFF about Distance prot. IntSP * * * LED BO
Binary Input (Z3StrkON/OFF BI)
13925 Max. fault current (MAX I=) Statistics VI * *
13926 Last current interrupted by CB Statistics VI * * 138 16 4 No
(Last I=)
13927 Summation interrupted primary Statistics VI * *
currents ( I=)
13946 Inrush detection picked up InRushRestraint OUT on on off * LED BO
(INRUSH detected) off
13947 Inrush detection for Dis. is InRushRestraint OUT on * * LED BO
switched ON (Inrush Dis ON) off
13948 Inrush detection O/C is switched InRushRestraint OUT on * * LED BO
ON (Inrush O/C ON) off
13949 Inrush detection Emerg. O/C ON InRushRestraint OUT on * * LED BO
(Inrush BuO/C ON) off
13951 >U feeder side VT MCB tripped P.System Data 2 SP ON * * LED BI BO
(>VT MCB UF) OFF
13952 >U reference side VT MCB P.System Data 2 SP ON * * LED BI BO 150 11 1 Yes
tripped (>VT MCB Uref) OFF
13953 Measured value failure: Umeas Monitoring OUT * on off * LED BO
failed (Failure Umeas)
13960 >Switch on Defrosting Protection Defrosting SP on * * LED BI BO 93 201 1 Yes
(>Defrost ON) off
13961 >Switch off Defrosting Protection Defrosting SP on * * LED BI BO 93 202 1 Yes
(>Defrost OFF) off
13962 >BLOCK Defrosting Protection Defrosting SP * * * LED BI BO 93 203 1 Yes
(>BLOCK Defrost)
13963 Defrosting Protection is switched Defrosting IntSP * * * LED BO 93 205 1 Yes
ON (Defrost ON)
13964 Defrosting Protection is switched Defrosting OUT on * * LED BO 93 206 1 Yes
OFF (Defrost OFF) off
13965 Defrosting Protection is blocked Defrosting OUT on on off * LED BO 93 209 1 Yes
(Defrost blk) off
13966 Defrosting Protection PICKED Defrosting OUT * * m LED BO 93 211 2 Yes
UP (Defrost PICKUP)
13967 Defrosting Protection TRIP (De- Defrosting OUT * * m LED BO 93 212 2 No
frost TRIP)
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
13970 Defrosting current IX>> Pickup Defrosting OUT * on off * LED BO
(IX>> Pickup)
13971 Defrosting current IX> Pickup Defrosting OUT * on off * LED BO
(IX> Pickup)
13972 Defrosting current IX>> TRIP Defrosting OUT * on * LED BO
command (IX>> TRIP)
13973 Defrosting current IX> TRIP Defrosting OUT * on * LED BO
command (IX> TRIP)
13974 Differential Protection picked up Defrosting OUT * on off * LED BO 93 215 2 Yes
(Diff PU)
13975 Differential Protection TRIP (Diff Defrosting OUT * on * LED BO 93 216 2 No
TRIP)
13976 Defrosting Protection on/off about Defrosting IntSP * * * LED BO
BI (DEF ON/OFF BI)
13978 Block Defrosting Protection (De- Defrosting IntSP * * * LED BO 93 208 1 Yes
frost block)
13980 Catenary 1 ON/OFF about Binary Therm. Overload IntSP * * * LED BO
Input (Cat.1 ON/OFF BI)
13981 Catenary 2 ON/OFF about Binary Therm. Overload IntSP * * * LED BO
Input (Cat.2 ON/OFF BI)
13982 Catenary 3 ON/OFF about Binary Therm. Overload IntSP * * * LED BO
Input (Cat.3 ON/OFF BI)
13990 Relay General pickup (Relay PU) P.System Data 2 OUT * m LED BO
13991 General protective PICKUP of P.System Data 2 OUT on off m LED BO 128 84 2 Yes
device (Protection PU)
13992 General protective TRIP of P.System Data 2 OUT on m LED BO 128 68 2 No
device (Protection TRIP)
13993 AR: Recl. after thermal trip: Auto Reclose OUT * * * LED BO 40 96 2 Yes
Meas. Req. (TH Recl.SyncReq)
13994 Emerg.O/C Prot.: ON/OFF via Emerg. O/C IntSP * * * LED BO
Binary Input (Emer. ON/OFF BI)
13995 AR: Taction 1st cycle is running Auto Reclose OUT * on off * LED BO
(AR Taction 1st)
13996 AR: Taction 2nd cycle or higher Auto Reclose OUT * on off * LED BO
running (AR Taction >1st)
13998 Delay time for back up trip Breaker Failure OUT on * * LED BO 138 71 1 Yes
expired (BF T-BF1) off
16006 Residual Endurance (Resid.En- Statistics VI * *
du.=)
16010 Dropped below Threshold CB SetPoint(Stat) OUT on * LED BO
Res.Endurance (Thresh.R.En- off
du.<)
16011 Number of mechanical Trips Statistics VI * *
(mechan.TRIP=)
16019 >2P Measurement Start (>2P It Function SP on * * LED BI BO
start) off
16020 2P blocked by Time-Setting It Function OUT on * * LED BO
Failure (2P T sett.fail) off
16027 2P Logic blocked Ir-CB >= Isc-CB It Function OUT on * * LED BO
(2P blk I PaErr) off
16028 2P Logic blk SwCyc. It Function OUT on * * LED BO
Isc>=SwCyc. Ir (2P blk n PaErr) off
17100 Distance Protection Signal send Distance prot. OUT * on * LED BO
(Dis Sig. Send)
17101 Signal transmission Z1 active Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO
(SigMod Z1 act)
No. Description Function Type Log Buffers Configurable in Matrix IEC 60870-5-103
of In-
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
matio
Function Key
Binary Input
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
17102 Signal transmission Z2 active Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO
(SigMod Z2 act)
17103 Signal transmission Z3 active Distance prot. OUT on * * LED BO
(SigMod Z3 act)
17104 Distance protection Z1 is Distance prot. OUT * on off * LED BO
BLOCKED (DIS blk Z1)
17105 Signal transmission is switched Distance prot. OUT * * * LED BO
OFF (SigMod OFF)
17106 Last Neg. Feeder curr. interrupt. Statistics VI * *
by CB (Last IF=)
17107 Summation interrupt. Neg.Feed- Statistics VI * *
er currents ( IF=)
17108 Overload Alarm Stage2! Near Therm. Overload OUT on * * LED BO
Thermal Trip (O/L 2 Alarm) off
Information Number
Control Display
Default Display
Compatibility
Data Unit
Position
Type
CFC
- Control DIGSI (CntrlDIGSI) Cntrl Authority - - - - - CFC CD DD
636 U - Difference (line - reference) (Udif=) Measurement - - - - - CFC CD DD
637 U - Line (Uline=) Measurement - - - - - CFC CD DD
638 U - Reference (Uref=) Measurement - - - - - CFC CD DD
641 P (active power) (P =) Measurement 128 148/ Yes 9 7 CFC CD DD
149 1)
134 120 No 9 7
138 241 No 9 6
128 148 Yes 9 3 CFC CD DD
134 119 No 9 3
642 Q (reactive power) (Q =) Measurement 128 148/ Yes 9 8 CFC CD DD
149 1
134 120 No 9 8
138 241 No 9 7
128 148 Yes 9 4 CFC CD DD
134 119 No 9 4
643 Power factor (PF =) Measurement 134 120 No 9 13 CFC CD DD
644 Frequency (Freq=) Measurement 128 148/ Yes 9 9 CFC CD DD
149 1
134 120 No 9 9
138 241 No 9 8
128 148 Yes 9 5 CFC CD DD
134 119 No 9 5
646 f - Reference (fref=) Measurement - - - - - CFC CD DD
647 f - Difference (line-reference) (fdif=) Measurement - - - - - CFC CD DD
648 Angle (difference line-bus) (-diff=) Measurement - - - - - CFC CD DD
649 f - Line (fline=) Measurement - - - - - CFC CD DD
668 Operational measurement: I = (I =) Measurement 128 148/ Yes 9 1 CFC CD DD
149 1
134 120 No 9 1
138 240 No 3 1
138 241 No 9 1
134 119 No 9 1
678 Operational measurement: U = (U =) Measurement 128 148/ Yes 9 4 CFC CD DD
149 1
134 120 No 9 4
138 240 No 3 2
138 241 No 9 4
128 148 Yes 9 2 CFC CD DD
134 119 No 9 2
950 Operat. meas. temp. of catenary (Tmp.cat=) Measurement 134 120 No 9 12 CFC CD DD
138 241 No 9 2
134 119 No 9 8
951 Operat. meas. ambient temperature Measurement - - - - - CFC CD DD
(Tmp.amb=)
Information Number
Control Display
Default Display
Compatibility
Data Unit
Position
Type
CFC
13915 Resistive component of total resistance (R Measurement - - - - - CFC CD DD
=)
13916 Reactive component of total resistance (X =) Measurement - - - - - CFC CD DD
13917 Operating impedance (Z =) Measurement 134 120 No 9 10 CFC CD DD
138 241 No 9 5
134 119 No 9 6
13918 Phase angle PHI in [degrees] ( =) Measurement 134 120 No 9 11 CFC CD DD
138 241 No 9 3
134 119 No 9 7
13920 Voltage UF- is (UF- =) Measurement 128 148/ Yes 9 5 CFC CD DD
149 1
134 120 No 9 5
13921 Current IF- is (IF- =) Measurement 128 148/ Yes 9 2 CFC CD DD
149 1
134 120 No 9 2
13922 Reference voltage (Uref=) Measurement 128 148/ Yes 9 6 CFC CD DD
149 1
134 120 No 9 6
13923 Defrosting current IX is (IX =) Measurement 128 148/ Yes 9 3 CFC CD DD
149 1
134 120 No 9 3
13924 Summated current I1 + I2 is (I1,I2=) Measurement - - - - - CFC CD DD
13968 Differential current in [%] is (Id =) Measurement - - - - - CFC CD DD
13969 Restraint current in [%] is (Ir =) Measurement - - - - - CFC CD DD
16009 Lower Threshold of CB Residual Endurance SetPoint(Stat) 138 21 No 4 - CFC CD DD
(Resid.Endu. <)
1)
148 at 7ST63 / 149 at 7ST61*3/7
Battery The buffer battery ensures that specified data areas, flags, timers and counters are retained re-
tentively.
Bay controllers Bay controllers are devices with control and monitoring functions without protective functions.
Bit pattern indica- Bit pattern indication is a processing function by means of which items of digital process informa-
tion tion applying across several inputs can be detected together in parallel and processed further. The
bit pattern length can be specified as 1, 2, 3 or 4 bytes.
BP_xx Bit pattern indication (Bitstring Of x Bit), x designates the length in bits (8, 16, 24 or 32 bits).
CFC Continuous Function Chart. CFC is a graphical editor with which a program can be created and
configured by using ready-made blocks.
CFC blocks Blocks are parts of the user program delimited by their function, their structure or their purpose.
Chatter blocking A rapidly intermittent input (for example, due to a relay contact fault) is switched off after a config-
urable monitoring time and can thus not generate any further signal changes. The function pre-
vents overloading of the system when a fault arises.
Combination Combination devices are bay devices with protection functions and a control display.
devices
Combination matrix From DIGSI V4.6 onward, up to 32 compatible SIPROTEC 4 devices can communicate with one
another in an Inter Relay Communication combination (IRC combination). Which device exchang-
es which information is defined with the help of the combination matrix.
Communication The communication reference describes the type and version of a station in communication by
reference CR PROFIBUS.
Component view In addition to a topological view, SIMATIC Manager offers you a component view. The component
view does not offer any overview of the hierarchy of a project. It does, however, provide an over-
view of all the SIPROTEC 4 devices within a project.
COMTRADE Common Format for Transient Data Exchange, format for fault records.
Container If an object can contain other objects, it is called a container. The object Folder is an example of
such a container.
Control display The display which is displayed on devices with a large (graphic) display after you have pressed
the control key is called the control display. It contains the switchgear that can be controlled in the
feeder with status display. It is used to perform switching operations. Defining this display is part
of the configuration.
Data pane The right-hand area of the project window displays the contents of the area selected in the
navigation window, for example indications, measured values, etc. of the information lists or the
function selection for the device configuration.
DCF77 The extremely precise official time is determined in Germany by the "Physikalisch-Technische-
Bundesanstalt PTB" in Braunschweig. The atomic clock station of the PTB transmits this time via
the long-wave time-signal transmitter in Mainflingen near Frankfurt/Main. The emitted time signal
can be received within a radius of approx. 1,500 km from Frankfurt/Main.
Device container In the Component View, all SIPROTEC 4 devices are assigned to an object of type Device con-
tainer. This object is a special object of DIGSI Manager. However, since there is no component
view in DIGSI Manager, this object only becomes visible in conjunction with STEP 7.
Double command Double commands are process outputs which indicate 4 process states at 2 outputs: 2 defined (for
example ON/OFF) and 2 undefined states (for example intermediate positions)
Double-point Double-point indications are items of process information which indicate 4 process states at 2
indication inputs: 2 defined (for example ON/OFF) and 2 undefined states (for example intermediate posi-
tions).
DP Double-point indication
Drag and drop Copying, moving and linking function, used at graphics user interfaces. Objects are selected with
the mouse, held and moved from one data area to another.
Earth The conductive earth whose electric potential can be set equal to zero at every point. In the area
of earth electrodes the earth can have a potential deviating from zero. The term "Earth reference
plane" is often used for this state.
Earth (verb) This term means that a conductive part is connected via an earthing system to the earth.
Earthing Earthing is the total of all means and measures used for earthing.
Electromagnetic Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) is the ability of an electrical apparatus to function fault-free
compatibility in a specified environment without influencing the environment unduly.
ESD protection ESD protection is the total of all the means and measures used to protect electrostatic sensitive
devices.
ExBPxx External bit pattern indication via an ETHERNET connection, device-specific Bit pattern indica-
tion
ExDP External double point indication via an ETHERNET connection, device-specific Double point
indication
ExDP_I External double point indication via an ETHERNET connection, intermediate position 00, device-
specific Double point indication
ExSI External single point indication via an ETHERNET connection, device-specific Single point in-
dication
ExSI_F External single point indication via an ETHERNET connection, device-specific Transient infor-
mation, Single point indication
Field devices Generic term for all devices assigned to the field level: Protection devices, combination devices,
bay controllers.
FMS communica- Within an FMS communication branch, the users communicate on the basis of the PROFIBUS
tion branch FMS protocol via a PROFIBUS FMS network.
Folder This object type is used to create the hierarchical structure of a project.
General interro- During the system start-up the state of all the process inputs, of the status and of the fault image
gation (GI) is sampled. This information is used to update the system-end process image. The current
process state can also be sampled after a data loss by means of a GI.
GOOSE message GOOSE messages (Generic Object Oriented Substation Event) are data packets which are trans-
ferred event-controlled via the Ethernet communication system. They serve for direct information
exchange among the relays. This mechanism implements cross-communication between bay
units.
GPS Global Positioning System. Satellites with atomic clocks on board orbit the earth twice a day on
different paths in approx. 20,000 km. They transmit signals which also contain the GPS universal
time. The GPS receiver determines its own position from the signals received. From its position it
can derive the delay time of a satellite signal and thus correct the transmitted GPS universal time.
Hierarchy level Within a structure with higher-level and lower-level objects a hierarchy level is a container of equiv-
alent objects.
HV field description The HV project description file contains details of fields which exist in a ModPara-project. The
actual field information of each field is stored in a HV field description file. Within the HV project
description file, each field is allocated such a HV field description file by a reference to the file
name.
HV project descrip- All the data is exported once the configuration and parameterization of PCUs and sub-modules
tion using ModPara has been completed. This data is split up into several files. One file contains
details about the fundamental project structure. This also includes, for example, information de-
tailing which fields exist in this project. This file is called a HV project description file.
ID_S Internal double point indication, intermediate position 00 Double point indication
IEC address Within an IEC bus a unique IEC address has to be assigned to each SIPROTEC 4 device. A total
of 254 IEC addresses are available for each IEC bus.
IEC communica- Within an IEC communication branch the users communicate on the basis of the IEC60-870-5-
tion branch 103 protocol via an IEC bus.
IEC61850 International communication standard for communication in substations. The objective of this
standard is the interoperability of devices from different manufacturers on the station bus. An
Ethernet network is used for data transfer.
Initialization string An initialization string comprises a range of modem-specific commands. These are transmitted to
the modem within the framework of modem initialization. The commands can, for example, force
specific settings for the modem.
IRC combination Inter Relay Communication, IRC, is used for directly exchanging process information between
SIPROTEC 4 devices. You require an object of type IRC combination to configure an inter relay
communication. Each user of the combination and all the necessary communication parameters
are defined in this object. The type and scope of the information exchanged between the users is
also stored in this object.
ISO 9001 The ISO 9000 ff range of standards defines measures used to assure the quality of a product from
the development stage to the manufacturing stage.
Link address The link address gives the address of a V3/V2 device.
List view The right window section of the project window displays the names and icons of objects which rep-
resent the contents of a container selected in the tree view. Because they are displayed in the form
of a list, this area is called the list view.
LV Limit value
Master Masters may send data to other users and request data from other users. DIGSI operates as a
master.
Metered value Metered values are a processing function with which the total number of discrete similar events
(counting pulses) is determined for a period, usually as an integrated value. In power supply com-
panies the electrical work is usually recorded as a metered value (energy purchase/supply, energy
transportation).
Modem connection This object type contains information on both partners of a modem connection, the local modem
and the remote modem.
Modem profile A modem profile consists of the name of the profile, a modem driver and may also comprise
several initialization commands and a user address. You can create several modem profiles for
one physical modem. To do so you need to link various initialization commands or user addresses
to a modem driver and its properties and save them under different names.
Modems Modem profiles for a modem connection are stored in this object type.
MV Measured value
Navigation pane The left pane of the project window displays the names and symbols of all containers of a project
in the form of a folder tree.
Object properties Each object has properties. These might be general properties that are common to several ob-
jects. An object can also have specific properties.
Off-line In offline mode a connection to a SIPROTEC 4 device is not required. You work with data which
are stored in files.
On-line When working in online mode, there is a physical connection to a SIPROTEC 4 device. This con-
nection can be implemented as a direct connection, as a modem connection or as a PROFIBUS
FMS connection.
Parameter set The parameter set is the set of all parameters that can be set for a SIPROTEC 4 device.
Phone book User addresses for a modem connection are saved in this object type.
Process bus Devices with a process bus interface allow direct communication with SICAM HV modules. The
process bus interface is equipped with an Ethernet module.
PROFIBUS PROcess FIeld BUS, the German process and field bus standard, as specified in the standard EN
50170, Volume 2, PROFIBUS. It defines the functional, electrical, and mechanical properties for
a bit-serial field bus.
PROFIBUS address Within a PROFIBUS network a unique PROFIBUS address has to be assigned to each SIPRO-
TEC 4 device. A total of 254 PROFIBUS addresses are available for each PROFIBUS network.
Project Content-wise, a project is the image of a real power supply system. Graphically, a project is rep-
resented as a number of objects which are integrated in a hierarchical structure. Physically, a
project consists of a number of directories and files containing project data.
Protection devices All devices with a protective function and no control display.
Reorganizing Frequent addition and deletion of objects results in memory areas that can no longer be used. By
reorganizing projects, you can release these memory areas again. However, a cleanup also reas-
signs the VD addresses. The consequence is that all SIPROTEC 4 devices have to be reinitial-
ized.
SCADA Interface Rear serial interface on the devices for connecting to a control system via IEC or PROFIBUS.
Service port Rear serial interface on the devices for connecting DIGSI (for example, via modem).
Setting parameters General term for all adjustments made to the device. Parameterization jobs are executed by
means of DIGSI or, in some cases, directly on the device.
SI_F Single point indication transient Transient information, Single point indication
SICAM WinCC The SICAM WinCC operator control and monitoring system displays the state of your network
graphically, visualizes alarms, interrupts and indications, archives the network data, offers the pos-
sibility of intervening manually in the process and manages the system rights of the individual em-
ployee.
SICAM PAS (Power Substation control system: The range of possible configurations spans from integrated standalone
Automation systems (SICAM PAS and M&C with SICAM PAS CC on one computer) to separate hardware for
System) SICAM PAS and SICAM PAS CC to distributed systems with multiple SICAM Station Units. The
software is a modular system with basic and optional packages. SICAM PAS is a purely distributed
system: the process interface is implemented by the use of bay units / remote terminal units.
SICAM Station Unit The SICAM Station Unit with its special hardware (no fan, no rotating parts) and its Windows XP
Embedded operating system is the basis for SICAM PAS.
Single command Single commands are process outputs which indicate 2 process states (for example, ON/OFF) at
one output.
Single point indica- Single indications are items of process information which indicate 2 process states (for example,
tion ON/OFF) at one output.
SIPROTEC The registered trademark SIPROTEC is used for devices implemented on system base V4.
SIPROTEC 4 device This object type represents a real SIPROTEC 4 device with all the setting values and process data
it contains.
SIPROTEC 4 variant This object type represents a variant of an object of type SIPROTEC 4 device. The device data of
this variant may well differ from the device data of the original object. However, all variants derived
from the original object have the same VD address as the original object. For this reason they
always correspond to the same real SIPROTEC 4 device as the original object. Objects of type
SIPROTEC 4 variant have a variety of uses, such as documenting different operating states when
entering parameter settings of a SIPROTEC 4 device.
Slave A slave may only exchange data with a master after being prompted to do so by the master.
SIPROTEC 4 devices operate as slaves.
Time stamp Time stamp is the assignment of the real time to a process event.
Topological view DIGSI Manager always displays a project in the topological view. This shows the hierarchical
structure of a project with all available objects.
Transformer Tap Transformer tap indication is a processing function on the DI by means of which the tap of the
Indication transformer tap changer can be detected together in parallel and processed further.
Transient informa- A transient information is a brief transient single-point indication at which only the coming of the
tion process signal is detected and processed immediately.
Tree view The left pane of the project window displays the names and symbols of all containers of a project
in the form of a folder tree. This area is called the tree view.
User address A user address comprises the name of the user, the national code, the area code and the user-
specific phone number.
Users From DIGSI V4.6 onward , up to 32 compatible SIPROTEC 4 devices can communicate with one
another in an Inter Relay Communication combination. The individual participating devices are
called users.
VD A VD (Virtual Device) includes all communication objects and their properties and states that are
used by a communication user through services. A VD can be a physical device, a module of a
device or a software module.
VD address The VD address is assigned automatically by DIGSI Manager. It exists only once in the entire
project and thus serves to identify unambiguously a real SIPROTEC 4 device. The VD address
assigned by DIGSI Manager must be transferred to the SIPROTEC 4 device in order to allow com-
munication with DIGSI Device Editor.
VFD A VFD (Virtual Field Device) includes all communication objects and their properties and states
that are used by a communication user through services.
Index
D
B
DC voltage 217
Backup Time Overcurrent Protection 97 Definite time very high set current stage I>>> 87
Binary Inputs 217 Defrosting Protection 120
Binary Outputs 197, 217 Defrosting protection 237
Breaker Failure Protection 113 Delay times 114
Bus address 223 Design 226
Detection of the Circuit Breaker Position 188
Device and system logic 266
C Direction check with load current 246
Display Panel 198
C-I/O-7 input/output board 215 Distance Protection 227
Check time synchronization 239 Distance protection 22
Check: Circuit breaker failure protection 244
Check: Current and voltage connection 245
Check: Direction 246
Check: Operator interface 232 E
Check: Service interface 232 Electrical tests 223
Check: Switching states of binary inputs and outputs 241 EMC Tests for InterferenceImmunity (type tests) 223
Check: System connections 234 EMC tests for noise emission (type test) 224
Check: System interface 232
Check: Termination 233
Check: Time synchronization interface 233
Check: Tripping/Closing of the configured operating F
equipment 248 Fast Binary Outputs 197
Check: User-defined functions 247 Fault Indications 30
Check: Voltage transformer miniature circuit breaker (VT Fault indications (buffer: trip log) 199
mcb) 245 Fault Locator 158
Circuit breaker failure protection 115, 237 Fault locator 240
Climatic stress tests 225 Fault logging 244
Climatic tests 225 Fault Recording 45
Command duration 194 Fault recording 20
Command Execution 204 Feedback monitoring 209
Command output 209 Fibre-optic cables 234
Command Path 203 Final Preparation of the Device 250
Command Processing 203 Function modules 241
Command Task 204
Command types 203
Communication 21
Communication interfaces 218
L
Life contact 207 S
Limits for CFC blocks 242 Service / modem interface 219
Limits for User DefinedFunctions 242 Service conditions 225
Setting Groups 38
Setting groups: Changing; Changing setting groups 204
M Settings Group Change Option 38
Single-stage breaker failure protection 115
Measuring the operating time of the circuit breaker 247 Specifications 223
Measuring Transducer Inputs 216 Spontaneous Indications on the Display 30
Mechanical Stress Tests 224 Standard Interlocking 206
MODBUS Optical fibre 221 Start triggering oscillographic recording 248
MODBUS RS485 219 Statistics 244
Monitoring 179 Supply voltage 217
Monitoring with binary input 185 Switchgear interlocking 266
Switching 90
Switching (interlocked/non-interlocked) 205
O Switching test of the configured operating equipment 248
Synchro-check 148
Operating modes 150 Synchronism check 239
Operating time of the circuit breaker 247 Synchronism conditions for automatic reclosure 152
Operational event log buffer 244 Synchronism conditions for manual csure and control
Operational indications (buffer: event log) 199 command 153
Operational measured values 244 System Interface 219
Operator Interface 218
Oscillographic recordings for test 248
T
Terminal Assignment 253
Termination 233
Termination of serial interfaces 208
Test mode 238
Test: System interface 239
Time constant 109
Time Overcurrent Protection 229
Time overcurrent protection 87
Time overcurrent stage I> 89
Time overcurrent stage Ip 89
Time Synchronization Interface 222
Time synchronization interface 233
Transmission block 238
Trip Circuit Supervision 182
Trip circuit supervision 205, 240
Trip dependent indications 30
Trip supervision 118, 240
Tripping logic 90
Tripping logic of the entire device 189
Tripping test with circuit breaker 248
Trips 202
Two-stage breaker failure protection 116
U
User-defined functions 241
V
Vibration and Shock Stress During Steady State Opera-
tion 224
Vibration and shock stress during transport 224
Voltage Inputs 216
Voltage Protection 100
Voltage protection 235
W
Wrong Phase Coupling Protection 67
electrification.mobility@siemens.com
www.siemens.com/rail-electrification
SIPROTEC 7ST6
Manual / Version 4.70
A6Z08100028293 - Order No. E50417-G1176-C251-A6 /
Status: 11.2016
www.siemens.com